Mercurial > vim
annotate runtime/doc/eval.txt @ 7659:07f11de5efca
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/85084ef1e999dcf50e8d466106a33bac24a0febb
Author: Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
Date: Sun Jan 17 22:26:33 2016 +0100
Update help files.
author | Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org> |
---|---|
date | Sun, 17 Jan 2016 22:30:06 +0100 |
parents | d4370fef0175 |
children | 39251e981d1f |
rev | line source |
---|---|
7651
c7575b07de98
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e9b892ebcd8596bf813793a1eed5a460a9495a28
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7629
diff
changeset
|
1 *eval.txt* For Vim version 7.4. Last change: 2016 Jan 17 |
1621 | 2 |
3 | |
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar | |
7 | 5 |
6 | |
7 Expression evaluation *expression* *expr* *E15* *eval* | |
8 | |
9 Using expressions is introduced in chapter 41 of the user manual |usr_41.txt|. | |
10 | |
11 Note: Expression evaluation can be disabled at compile time. If this has been | |
1621 | 12 done, the features in this document are not available. See |+eval| and |
99 | 13 |no-eval-feature|. |
7 | 14 |
85 | 15 1. Variables |variables| |
16 1.1 Variable types | |
87 | 17 1.2 Function references |Funcref| |
161 | 18 1.3 Lists |Lists| |
99 | 19 1.4 Dictionaries |Dictionaries| |
20 1.5 More about variables |more-variables| | |
85 | 21 2. Expression syntax |expression-syntax| |
22 3. Internal variable |internal-variables| | |
23 4. Builtin Functions |functions| | |
24 5. Defining functions |user-functions| | |
25 6. Curly braces names |curly-braces-names| | |
26 7. Commands |expression-commands| | |
27 8. Exception handling |exception-handling| | |
28 9. Examples |eval-examples| | |
29 10. No +eval feature |no-eval-feature| | |
30 11. The sandbox |eval-sandbox| | |
634 | 31 12. Textlock |textlock| |
7 | 32 |
33 {Vi does not have any of these commands} | |
34 | |
35 ============================================================================== | |
36 1. Variables *variables* | |
37 | |
85 | 38 1.1 Variable types ~ |
114 | 39 *E712* |
1621 | 40 There are six types of variables: |
41 | |
3082 | 42 Number A 32 or 64 bit signed number. |expr-number| *Number* |
99 | 43 Examples: -123 0x10 0177 |
44 | |
1621 | 45 Float A floating point number. |floating-point-format| *Float* |
46 {only when compiled with the |+float| feature} | |
47 Examples: 123.456 1.15e-6 -1.1e3 | |
48 | |
99 | 49 String A NUL terminated string of 8-bit unsigned characters (bytes). |
1621 | 50 |expr-string| Examples: "ab\txx\"--" 'x-z''a,c' |
99 | 51 |
52 Funcref A reference to a function |Funcref|. | |
53 Example: function("strlen") | |
54 | |
55 List An ordered sequence of items |List|. | |
56 Example: [1, 2, ['a', 'b']] | |
55 | 57 |
370 | 58 Dictionary An associative, unordered array: Each entry has a key and a |
59 value. |Dictionary| | |
60 Example: {'blue': "#0000ff", 'red': "#ff0000"} | |
61 | |
55 | 62 The Number and String types are converted automatically, depending on how they |
63 are used. | |
7 | 64 |
65 Conversion from a Number to a String is by making the ASCII representation of | |
2581 | 66 the Number. Examples: |
67 Number 123 --> String "123" ~ | |
68 Number 0 --> String "0" ~ | |
69 Number -1 --> String "-1" ~ | |
2152 | 70 *octal* |
7477
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7384
diff
changeset
|
71 Conversion from a String to a Number is done by converting the first digits to |
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7384
diff
changeset
|
72 a number. Hexadecimal "0xf9", Octal "017", and Binary "0b10" numbers are |
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7384
diff
changeset
|
73 recognized. If the String doesn't start with digits, the result is zero. |
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7384
diff
changeset
|
74 Examples: |
2581 | 75 String "456" --> Number 456 ~ |
76 String "6bar" --> Number 6 ~ | |
77 String "foo" --> Number 0 ~ | |
78 String "0xf1" --> Number 241 ~ | |
79 String "0100" --> Number 64 ~ | |
7477
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7384
diff
changeset
|
80 String "0b101" --> Number 5 ~ |
2581 | 81 String "-8" --> Number -8 ~ |
82 String "+8" --> Number 0 ~ | |
7 | 83 |
84 To force conversion from String to Number, add zero to it: > | |
85 :echo "0100" + 0 | |
782 | 86 < 64 ~ |
87 | |
88 To avoid a leading zero to cause octal conversion, or for using a different | |
89 base, use |str2nr()|. | |
7 | 90 |
91 For boolean operators Numbers are used. Zero is FALSE, non-zero is TRUE. | |
92 | |
93 Note that in the command > | |
94 :if "foo" | |
95 "foo" is converted to 0, which means FALSE. To test for a non-empty string, | |
3893 | 96 use empty(): > |
97 :if !empty("foo") | |
153 | 98 < *E745* *E728* *E703* *E729* *E730* *E731* |
99 List, Dictionary and Funcref types are not automatically converted. | |
85 | 100 |
1621 | 101 *E805* *E806* *E808* |
102 When mixing Number and Float the Number is converted to Float. Otherwise | |
103 there is no automatic conversion of Float. You can use str2float() for String | |
104 to Float, printf() for Float to String and float2nr() for Float to Number. | |
105 | |
106 *E706* *sticky-type-checking* | |
85 | 107 You will get an error if you try to change the type of a variable. You need |
108 to |:unlet| it first to avoid this error. String and Number are considered | |
1621 | 109 equivalent though, as well are Float and Number. Consider this sequence of |
110 commands: > | |
85 | 111 :let l = "string" |
87 | 112 :let l = 44 " changes type from String to Number |
1621 | 113 :let l = [1, 2, 3] " error! l is still a Number |
114 :let l = 4.4 " changes type from Number to Float | |
115 :let l = "string" " error! | |
85 | 116 |
117 | |
87 | 118 1.2 Function references ~ |
153 | 119 *Funcref* *E695* *E718* |
1621 | 120 A Funcref variable is obtained with the |function()| function. It can be used |
114 | 121 in an expression in the place of a function name, before the parenthesis |
122 around the arguments, to invoke the function it refers to. Example: > | |
55 | 123 |
124 :let Fn = function("MyFunc") | |
125 :echo Fn() | |
114 | 126 < *E704* *E705* *E707* |
819 | 127 A Funcref variable must start with a capital, "s:", "w:", "t:" or "b:". You |
5340 | 128 can use "g:" but the following name must still start with a capital. You |
819 | 129 cannot have both a Funcref variable and a function with the same name. |
85 | 130 |
114 | 131 A special case is defining a function and directly assigning its Funcref to a |
132 Dictionary entry. Example: > | |
133 :function dict.init() dict | |
134 : let self.val = 0 | |
135 :endfunction | |
136 | |
137 The key of the Dictionary can start with a lower case letter. The actual | |
138 function name is not used here. Also see |numbered-function|. | |
139 | |
140 A Funcref can also be used with the |:call| command: > | |
141 :call Fn() | |
142 :call dict.init() | |
85 | 143 |
144 The name of the referenced function can be obtained with |string()|. > | |
119 | 145 :let func = string(Fn) |
85 | 146 |
147 You can use |call()| to invoke a Funcref and use a list variable for the | |
148 arguments: > | |
119 | 149 :let r = call(Fn, mylist) |
85 | 150 |
151 | |
87 | 152 1.3 Lists ~ |
5814 | 153 *list* *List* *Lists* *E686* |
55 | 154 A List is an ordered sequence of items. An item can be of any type. Items |
1621 | 155 can be accessed by their index number. Items can be added and removed at any |
55 | 156 position in the sequence. |
157 | |
85 | 158 |
159 List creation ~ | |
160 *E696* *E697* | |
55 | 161 A List is created with a comma separated list of items in square brackets. |
85 | 162 Examples: > |
163 :let mylist = [1, two, 3, "four"] | |
164 :let emptylist = [] | |
55 | 165 |
1621 | 166 An item can be any expression. Using a List for an item creates a |
842 | 167 List of Lists: > |
85 | 168 :let nestlist = [[11, 12], [21, 22], [31, 32]] |
55 | 169 |
170 An extra comma after the last item is ignored. | |
171 | |
85 | 172 |
173 List index ~ | |
174 *list-index* *E684* | |
55 | 175 An item in the List can be accessed by putting the index in square brackets |
85 | 176 after the List. Indexes are zero-based, thus the first item has index zero. > |
177 :let item = mylist[0] " get the first item: 1 | |
55 | 178 :let item = mylist[2] " get the third item: 3 |
85 | 179 |
87 | 180 When the resulting item is a list this can be repeated: > |
85 | 181 :let item = nestlist[0][1] " get the first list, second item: 12 |
55 | 182 < |
85 | 183 A negative index is counted from the end. Index -1 refers to the last item in |
184 the List, -2 to the last but one item, etc. > | |
55 | 185 :let last = mylist[-1] " get the last item: "four" |
186 | |
85 | 187 To avoid an error for an invalid index use the |get()| function. When an item |
87 | 188 is not available it returns zero or the default value you specify: > |
85 | 189 :echo get(mylist, idx) |
190 :echo get(mylist, idx, "NONE") | |
191 | |
192 | |
193 List concatenation ~ | |
194 | |
195 Two lists can be concatenated with the "+" operator: > | |
196 :let longlist = mylist + [5, 6] | |
119 | 197 :let mylist += [7, 8] |
85 | 198 |
199 To prepend or append an item turn the item into a list by putting [] around | |
200 it. To change a list in-place see |list-modification| below. | |
201 | |
202 | |
203 Sublist ~ | |
204 | |
55 | 205 A part of the List can be obtained by specifying the first and last index, |
206 separated by a colon in square brackets: > | |
85 | 207 :let shortlist = mylist[2:-1] " get List [3, "four"] |
55 | 208 |
209 Omitting the first index is similar to zero. Omitting the last index is | |
1156 | 210 similar to -1. > |
90 | 211 :let endlist = mylist[2:] " from item 2 to the end: [3, "four"] |
212 :let shortlist = mylist[2:2] " List with one item: [3] | |
213 :let otherlist = mylist[:] " make a copy of the List | |
85 | 214 |
842 | 215 If the first index is beyond the last item of the List or the second item is |
216 before the first item, the result is an empty list. There is no error | |
217 message. | |
218 | |
219 If the second index is equal to or greater than the length of the list the | |
220 length minus one is used: > | |
829 | 221 :let mylist = [0, 1, 2, 3] |
222 :echo mylist[2:8] " result: [2, 3] | |
223 | |
270 | 224 NOTE: mylist[s:e] means using the variable "s:e" as index. Watch out for |
1621 | 225 using a single letter variable before the ":". Insert a space when needed: |
270 | 226 mylist[s : e]. |
227 | |
85 | 228 |
229 List identity ~ | |
99 | 230 *list-identity* |
85 | 231 When variable "aa" is a list and you assign it to another variable "bb", both |
232 variables refer to the same list. Thus changing the list "aa" will also | |
233 change "bb": > | |
234 :let aa = [1, 2, 3] | |
235 :let bb = aa | |
236 :call add(aa, 4) | |
237 :echo bb | |
114 | 238 < [1, 2, 3, 4] |
85 | 239 |
240 Making a copy of a list is done with the |copy()| function. Using [:] also | |
241 works, as explained above. This creates a shallow copy of the list: Changing | |
87 | 242 a list item in the list will also change the item in the copied list: > |
85 | 243 :let aa = [[1, 'a'], 2, 3] |
244 :let bb = copy(aa) | |
114 | 245 :call add(aa, 4) |
85 | 246 :let aa[0][1] = 'aaa' |
247 :echo aa | |
114 | 248 < [[1, aaa], 2, 3, 4] > |
85 | 249 :echo bb |
114 | 250 < [[1, aaa], 2, 3] |
85 | 251 |
87 | 252 To make a completely independent list use |deepcopy()|. This also makes a |
114 | 253 copy of the values in the list, recursively. Up to a hundred levels deep. |
85 | 254 |
255 The operator "is" can be used to check if two variables refer to the same | |
114 | 256 List. "isnot" does the opposite. In contrast "==" compares if two lists have |
87 | 257 the same value. > |
258 :let alist = [1, 2, 3] | |
259 :let blist = [1, 2, 3] | |
260 :echo alist is blist | |
114 | 261 < 0 > |
87 | 262 :echo alist == blist |
114 | 263 < 1 |
85 | 264 |
323 | 265 Note about comparing lists: Two lists are considered equal if they have the |
266 same length and all items compare equal, as with using "==". There is one | |
388 | 267 exception: When comparing a number with a string they are considered |
268 different. There is no automatic type conversion, as with using "==" on | |
269 variables. Example: > | |
270 echo 4 == "4" | |
323 | 271 < 1 > |
388 | 272 echo [4] == ["4"] |
323 | 273 < 0 |
274 | |
388 | 275 Thus comparing Lists is more strict than comparing numbers and strings. You |
1621 | 276 can compare simple values this way too by putting them in a list: > |
388 | 277 |
278 :let a = 5 | |
279 :let b = "5" | |
1621 | 280 :echo a == b |
388 | 281 < 1 > |
1621 | 282 :echo [a] == [b] |
388 | 283 < 0 |
323 | 284 |
85 | 285 |
286 List unpack ~ | |
287 | |
288 To unpack the items in a list to individual variables, put the variables in | |
289 square brackets, like list items: > | |
290 :let [var1, var2] = mylist | |
291 | |
292 When the number of variables does not match the number of items in the list | |
293 this produces an error. To handle any extra items from the list append ";" | |
294 and a variable name: > | |
295 :let [var1, var2; rest] = mylist | |
296 | |
297 This works like: > | |
298 :let var1 = mylist[0] | |
299 :let var2 = mylist[1] | |
95 | 300 :let rest = mylist[2:] |
85 | 301 |
302 Except that there is no error if there are only two items. "rest" will be an | |
303 empty list then. | |
304 | |
305 | |
306 List modification ~ | |
307 *list-modification* | |
87 | 308 To change a specific item of a list use |:let| this way: > |
85 | 309 :let list[4] = "four" |
310 :let listlist[0][3] = item | |
311 | |
87 | 312 To change part of a list you can specify the first and last item to be |
114 | 313 modified. The value must at least have the number of items in the range: > |
87 | 314 :let list[3:5] = [3, 4, 5] |
315 | |
85 | 316 Adding and removing items from a list is done with functions. Here are a few |
317 examples: > | |
318 :call insert(list, 'a') " prepend item 'a' | |
319 :call insert(list, 'a', 3) " insert item 'a' before list[3] | |
320 :call add(list, "new") " append String item | |
114 | 321 :call add(list, [1, 2]) " append a List as one new item |
85 | 322 :call extend(list, [1, 2]) " extend the list with two more items |
323 :let i = remove(list, 3) " remove item 3 | |
108 | 324 :unlet list[3] " idem |
85 | 325 :let l = remove(list, 3, -1) " remove items 3 to last item |
108 | 326 :unlet list[3 : ] " idem |
114 | 327 :call filter(list, 'v:val !~ "x"') " remove items with an 'x' |
328 | |
329 Changing the order of items in a list: > | |
87 | 330 :call sort(list) " sort a list alphabetically |
331 :call reverse(list) " reverse the order of items | |
5747 | 332 :call uniq(sort(list)) " sort and remove duplicates |
87 | 333 |
85 | 334 |
335 For loop ~ | |
336 | |
87 | 337 The |:for| loop executes commands for each item in a list. A variable is set |
338 to each item in the list in sequence. Example: > | |
114 | 339 :for item in mylist |
340 : call Doit(item) | |
85 | 341 :endfor |
342 | |
343 This works like: > | |
344 :let index = 0 | |
345 :while index < len(mylist) | |
114 | 346 : let item = mylist[index] |
347 : :call Doit(item) | |
85 | 348 : let index = index + 1 |
349 :endwhile | |
350 | |
351 Note that all items in the list should be of the same type, otherwise this | |
114 | 352 results in error |E706|. To avoid this |:unlet| the variable at the end of |
87 | 353 the loop. |
85 | 354 |
95 | 355 If all you want to do is modify each item in the list then the |map()| |
114 | 356 function will be a simpler method than a for loop. |
95 | 357 |
1621 | 358 Just like the |:let| command, |:for| also accepts a list of variables. This |
85 | 359 requires the argument to be a list of lists. > |
360 :for [lnum, col] in [[1, 3], [2, 8], [3, 0]] | |
361 : call Doit(lnum, col) | |
362 :endfor | |
363 | |
364 This works like a |:let| command is done for each list item. Again, the types | |
365 must remain the same to avoid an error. | |
366 | |
114 | 367 It is also possible to put remaining items in a List variable: > |
85 | 368 :for [i, j; rest] in listlist |
369 : call Doit(i, j) | |
370 : if !empty(rest) | |
371 : echo "remainder: " . string(rest) | |
372 : endif | |
373 :endfor | |
374 | |
375 | |
376 List functions ~ | |
114 | 377 *E714* |
85 | 378 Functions that are useful with a List: > |
87 | 379 :let r = call(funcname, list) " call a function with an argument list |
85 | 380 :if empty(list) " check if list is empty |
102 | 381 :let l = len(list) " number of items in list |
382 :let big = max(list) " maximum value in list | |
383 :let small = min(list) " minimum value in list | |
87 | 384 :let xs = count(list, 'x') " count nr of times 'x' appears in list |
385 :let i = index(list, 'x') " index of first 'x' in list | |
85 | 386 :let lines = getline(1, 10) " get ten text lines from buffer |
387 :call append('$', lines) " append text lines in buffer | |
95 | 388 :let list = split("a b c") " create list from items in a string |
389 :let string = join(list, ', ') " create string from list items | |
102 | 390 :let s = string(list) " String representation of list |
391 :call map(list, '">> " . v:val') " prepend ">> " to each item | |
99 | 392 |
258 | 393 Don't forget that a combination of features can make things simple. For |
394 example, to add up all the numbers in a list: > | |
395 :exe 'let sum = ' . join(nrlist, '+') | |
396 | |
99 | 397 |
398 1.4 Dictionaries ~ | |
5814 | 399 *dict* *Dictionaries* *Dictionary* |
99 | 400 A Dictionary is an associative array: Each entry has a key and a value. The |
114 | 401 entry can be located with the key. The entries are stored without a specific |
402 ordering. | |
99 | 403 |
404 | |
405 Dictionary creation ~ | |
114 | 406 *E720* *E721* *E722* *E723* |
99 | 407 A Dictionary is created with a comma separated list of entries in curly |
114 | 408 braces. Each entry has a key and a value, separated by a colon. Each key can |
409 only appear once. Examples: > | |
99 | 410 :let mydict = {1: 'one', 2: 'two', 3: 'three'} |
411 :let emptydict = {} | |
114 | 412 < *E713* *E716* *E717* |
99 | 413 A key is always a String. You can use a Number, it will be converted to a |
414 String automatically. Thus the String '4' and the number 4 will find the same | |
1621 | 415 entry. Note that the String '04' and the Number 04 are different, since the |
114 | 416 Number will be converted to the String '4'. |
417 | |
1621 | 418 A value can be any expression. Using a Dictionary for a value creates a |
99 | 419 nested Dictionary: > |
420 :let nestdict = {1: {11: 'a', 12: 'b'}, 2: {21: 'c'}} | |
421 | |
422 An extra comma after the last entry is ignored. | |
423 | |
424 | |
425 Accessing entries ~ | |
426 | |
427 The normal way to access an entry is by putting the key in square brackets: > | |
428 :let val = mydict["one"] | |
429 :let mydict["four"] = 4 | |
430 | |
114 | 431 You can add new entries to an existing Dictionary this way, unlike Lists. |
99 | 432 |
433 For keys that consist entirely of letters, digits and underscore the following | |
434 form can be used |expr-entry|: > | |
435 :let val = mydict.one | |
436 :let mydict.four = 4 | |
437 | |
438 Since an entry can be any type, also a List and a Dictionary, the indexing and | |
439 key lookup can be repeated: > | |
114 | 440 :echo dict.key[idx].key |
99 | 441 |
442 | |
443 Dictionary to List conversion ~ | |
444 | |
1621 | 445 You may want to loop over the entries in a dictionary. For this you need to |
99 | 446 turn the Dictionary into a List and pass it to |:for|. |
447 | |
448 Most often you want to loop over the keys, using the |keys()| function: > | |
449 :for key in keys(mydict) | |
450 : echo key . ': ' . mydict[key] | |
451 :endfor | |
452 | |
453 The List of keys is unsorted. You may want to sort them first: > | |
454 :for key in sort(keys(mydict)) | |
455 | |
456 To loop over the values use the |values()| function: > | |
457 :for v in values(mydict) | |
458 : echo "value: " . v | |
459 :endfor | |
460 | |
461 If you want both the key and the value use the |items()| function. It returns | |
1621 | 462 a List in which each item is a List with two items, the key and the value: > |
1156 | 463 :for [key, value] in items(mydict) |
464 : echo key . ': ' . value | |
99 | 465 :endfor |
466 | |
467 | |
468 Dictionary identity ~ | |
161 | 469 *dict-identity* |
99 | 470 Just like Lists you need to use |copy()| and |deepcopy()| to make a copy of a |
471 Dictionary. Otherwise, assignment results in referring to the same | |
472 Dictionary: > | |
473 :let onedict = {'a': 1, 'b': 2} | |
474 :let adict = onedict | |
475 :let adict['a'] = 11 | |
476 :echo onedict['a'] | |
477 11 | |
478 | |
327 | 479 Two Dictionaries compare equal if all the key-value pairs compare equal. For |
480 more info see |list-identity|. | |
99 | 481 |
482 | |
483 Dictionary modification ~ | |
484 *dict-modification* | |
485 To change an already existing entry of a Dictionary, or to add a new entry, | |
486 use |:let| this way: > | |
487 :let dict[4] = "four" | |
488 :let dict['one'] = item | |
489 | |
108 | 490 Removing an entry from a Dictionary is done with |remove()| or |:unlet|. |
491 Three ways to remove the entry with key "aaa" from dict: > | |
492 :let i = remove(dict, 'aaa') | |
493 :unlet dict.aaa | |
494 :unlet dict['aaa'] | |
99 | 495 |
496 Merging a Dictionary with another is done with |extend()|: > | |
114 | 497 :call extend(adict, bdict) |
498 This extends adict with all entries from bdict. Duplicate keys cause entries | |
499 in adict to be overwritten. An optional third argument can change this. | |
119 | 500 Note that the order of entries in a Dictionary is irrelevant, thus don't |
501 expect ":echo adict" to show the items from bdict after the older entries in | |
502 adict. | |
99 | 503 |
504 Weeding out entries from a Dictionary can be done with |filter()|: > | |
1156 | 505 :call filter(dict, 'v:val =~ "x"') |
114 | 506 This removes all entries from "dict" with a value not matching 'x'. |
102 | 507 |
508 | |
509 Dictionary function ~ | |
4159 | 510 *Dictionary-function* *self* *E725* *E862* |
102 | 511 When a function is defined with the "dict" attribute it can be used in a |
1621 | 512 special way with a dictionary. Example: > |
102 | 513 :function Mylen() dict |
114 | 514 : return len(self.data) |
102 | 515 :endfunction |
114 | 516 :let mydict = {'data': [0, 1, 2, 3], 'len': function("Mylen")} |
517 :echo mydict.len() | |
102 | 518 |
519 This is like a method in object oriented programming. The entry in the | |
520 Dictionary is a |Funcref|. The local variable "self" refers to the dictionary | |
521 the function was invoked from. | |
522 | |
114 | 523 It is also possible to add a function without the "dict" attribute as a |
524 Funcref to a Dictionary, but the "self" variable is not available then. | |
525 | |
819 | 526 *numbered-function* *anonymous-function* |
102 | 527 To avoid the extra name for the function it can be defined and directly |
528 assigned to a Dictionary in this way: > | |
114 | 529 :let mydict = {'data': [0, 1, 2, 3]} |
6741 | 530 :function mydict.len() |
114 | 531 : return len(self.data) |
102 | 532 :endfunction |
114 | 533 :echo mydict.len() |
534 | |
535 The function will then get a number and the value of dict.len is a |Funcref| | |
1621 | 536 that references this function. The function can only be used through a |
114 | 537 |Funcref|. It will automatically be deleted when there is no |Funcref| |
538 remaining that refers to it. | |
539 | |
540 It is not necessary to use the "dict" attribute for a numbered function. | |
102 | 541 |
2488
def0e3934129
Preparations for 7.3d release.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2465
diff
changeset
|
542 If you get an error for a numbered function, you can find out what it is with |
def0e3934129
Preparations for 7.3d release.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2465
diff
changeset
|
543 a trick. Assuming the function is 42, the command is: > |
def0e3934129
Preparations for 7.3d release.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2465
diff
changeset
|
544 :function {42} |
def0e3934129
Preparations for 7.3d release.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2465
diff
changeset
|
545 |
102 | 546 |
547 Functions for Dictionaries ~ | |
114 | 548 *E715* |
549 Functions that can be used with a Dictionary: > | |
102 | 550 :if has_key(dict, 'foo') " TRUE if dict has entry with key "foo" |
551 :if empty(dict) " TRUE if dict is empty | |
552 :let l = len(dict) " number of items in dict | |
553 :let big = max(dict) " maximum value in dict | |
554 :let small = min(dict) " minimum value in dict | |
555 :let xs = count(dict, 'x') " count nr of times 'x' appears in dict | |
556 :let s = string(dict) " String representation of dict | |
557 :call map(dict, '">> " . v:val') " prepend ">> " to each item | |
99 | 558 |
559 | |
560 1.5 More about variables ~ | |
85 | 561 *more-variables* |
7 | 562 If you need to know the type of a variable or expression, use the |type()| |
563 function. | |
564 | |
565 When the '!' flag is included in the 'viminfo' option, global variables that | |
566 start with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase letter, are | |
567 stored in the viminfo file |viminfo-file|. | |
568 | |
569 When the 'sessionoptions' option contains "global", global variables that | |
570 start with an uppercase letter and contain at least one lowercase letter are | |
571 stored in the session file |session-file|. | |
572 | |
573 variable name can be stored where ~ | |
574 my_var_6 not | |
575 My_Var_6 session file | |
576 MY_VAR_6 viminfo file | |
577 | |
578 | |
579 It's possible to form a variable name with curly braces, see | |
580 |curly-braces-names|. | |
581 | |
582 ============================================================================== | |
583 2. Expression syntax *expression-syntax* | |
584 | |
585 Expression syntax summary, from least to most significant: | |
586 | |
587 |expr1| expr2 ? expr1 : expr1 if-then-else | |
588 | |
589 |expr2| expr3 || expr3 .. logical OR | |
590 | |
591 |expr3| expr4 && expr4 .. logical AND | |
592 | |
593 |expr4| expr5 == expr5 equal | |
594 expr5 != expr5 not equal | |
595 expr5 > expr5 greater than | |
596 expr5 >= expr5 greater than or equal | |
597 expr5 < expr5 smaller than | |
598 expr5 <= expr5 smaller than or equal | |
599 expr5 =~ expr5 regexp matches | |
600 expr5 !~ expr5 regexp doesn't match | |
601 | |
602 expr5 ==? expr5 equal, ignoring case | |
603 expr5 ==# expr5 equal, match case | |
604 etc. As above, append ? for ignoring case, # for | |
605 matching case | |
606 | |
685 | 607 expr5 is expr5 same |List| instance |
608 expr5 isnot expr5 different |List| instance | |
79 | 609 |
610 |expr5| expr6 + expr6 .. number addition or list concatenation | |
7 | 611 expr6 - expr6 .. number subtraction |
612 expr6 . expr6 .. string concatenation | |
613 | |
614 |expr6| expr7 * expr7 .. number multiplication | |
615 expr7 / expr7 .. number division | |
616 expr7 % expr7 .. number modulo | |
617 | |
618 |expr7| ! expr7 logical NOT | |
619 - expr7 unary minus | |
620 + expr7 unary plus | |
102 | 621 |
685 | 622 |expr8| expr8[expr1] byte of a String or item of a |List| |
623 expr8[expr1 : expr1] substring of a String or sublist of a |List| | |
624 expr8.name entry in a |Dictionary| | |
625 expr8(expr1, ...) function call with |Funcref| variable | |
102 | 626 |
627 |expr9| number number constant | |
26 | 628 "string" string constant, backslash is special |
99 | 629 'string' string constant, ' is doubled |
685 | 630 [expr1, ...] |List| |
631 {expr1: expr1, ...} |Dictionary| | |
7 | 632 &option option value |
633 (expr1) nested expression | |
634 variable internal variable | |
635 va{ria}ble internal variable with curly braces | |
636 $VAR environment variable | |
637 @r contents of register 'r' | |
638 function(expr1, ...) function call | |
639 func{ti}on(expr1, ...) function call with curly braces | |
640 | |
641 | |
642 ".." indicates that the operations in this level can be concatenated. | |
643 Example: > | |
644 &nu || &list && &shell == "csh" | |
645 | |
646 All expressions within one level are parsed from left to right. | |
647 | |
648 | |
649 expr1 *expr1* *E109* | |
650 ----- | |
651 | |
652 expr2 ? expr1 : expr1 | |
653 | |
654 The expression before the '?' is evaluated to a number. If it evaluates to | |
655 non-zero, the result is the value of the expression between the '?' and ':', | |
656 otherwise the result is the value of the expression after the ':'. | |
657 Example: > | |
658 :echo lnum == 1 ? "top" : lnum | |
659 | |
660 Since the first expression is an "expr2", it cannot contain another ?:. The | |
661 other two expressions can, thus allow for recursive use of ?:. | |
662 Example: > | |
663 :echo lnum == 1 ? "top" : lnum == 1000 ? "last" : lnum | |
664 | |
665 To keep this readable, using |line-continuation| is suggested: > | |
666 :echo lnum == 1 | |
667 :\ ? "top" | |
668 :\ : lnum == 1000 | |
669 :\ ? "last" | |
670 :\ : lnum | |
671 | |
1156 | 672 You should always put a space before the ':', otherwise it can be mistaken for |
673 use in a variable such as "a:1". | |
674 | |
7 | 675 |
676 expr2 and expr3 *expr2* *expr3* | |
677 --------------- | |
678 | |
679 *expr-barbar* *expr-&&* | |
680 The "||" and "&&" operators take one argument on each side. The arguments | |
681 are (converted to) Numbers. The result is: | |
682 | |
683 input output ~ | |
684 n1 n2 n1 || n2 n1 && n2 ~ | |
685 zero zero zero zero | |
686 zero non-zero non-zero zero | |
687 non-zero zero non-zero zero | |
688 non-zero non-zero non-zero non-zero | |
689 | |
690 The operators can be concatenated, for example: > | |
691 | |
692 &nu || &list && &shell == "csh" | |
693 | |
694 Note that "&&" takes precedence over "||", so this has the meaning of: > | |
695 | |
696 &nu || (&list && &shell == "csh") | |
697 | |
698 Once the result is known, the expression "short-circuits", that is, further | |
699 arguments are not evaluated. This is like what happens in C. For example: > | |
700 | |
701 let a = 1 | |
702 echo a || b | |
703 | |
704 This is valid even if there is no variable called "b" because "a" is non-zero, | |
705 so the result must be non-zero. Similarly below: > | |
706 | |
707 echo exists("b") && b == "yes" | |
708 | |
709 This is valid whether "b" has been defined or not. The second clause will | |
710 only be evaluated if "b" has been defined. | |
711 | |
712 | |
713 expr4 *expr4* | |
714 ----- | |
715 | |
716 expr5 {cmp} expr5 | |
717 | |
718 Compare two expr5 expressions, resulting in a 0 if it evaluates to false, or 1 | |
719 if it evaluates to true. | |
720 | |
1621 | 721 *expr-==* *expr-!=* *expr->* *expr->=* |
7 | 722 *expr-<* *expr-<=* *expr-=~* *expr-!~* |
723 *expr-==#* *expr-!=#* *expr->#* *expr->=#* | |
724 *expr-<#* *expr-<=#* *expr-=~#* *expr-!~#* | |
725 *expr-==?* *expr-!=?* *expr->?* *expr->=?* | |
726 *expr-<?* *expr-<=?* *expr-=~?* *expr-!~?* | |
2908 | 727 *expr-is* *expr-isnot* *expr-is#* *expr-isnot#* |
728 *expr-is?* *expr-isnot?* | |
7 | 729 use 'ignorecase' match case ignore case ~ |
730 equal == ==# ==? | |
731 not equal != !=# !=? | |
732 greater than > ># >? | |
733 greater than or equal >= >=# >=? | |
734 smaller than < <# <? | |
735 smaller than or equal <= <=# <=? | |
736 regexp matches =~ =~# =~? | |
737 regexp doesn't match !~ !~# !~? | |
2908 | 738 same instance is is# is? |
739 different instance isnot isnot# isnot? | |
7 | 740 |
741 Examples: | |
742 "abc" ==# "Abc" evaluates to 0 | |
743 "abc" ==? "Abc" evaluates to 1 | |
744 "abc" == "Abc" evaluates to 1 if 'ignorecase' is set, 0 otherwise | |
745 | |
85 | 746 *E691* *E692* |
685 | 747 A |List| can only be compared with a |List| and only "equal", "not equal" and |
748 "is" can be used. This compares the values of the list, recursively. | |
749 Ignoring case means case is ignored when comparing item values. | |
79 | 750 |
114 | 751 *E735* *E736* |
685 | 752 A |Dictionary| can only be compared with a |Dictionary| and only "equal", "not |
753 equal" and "is" can be used. This compares the key/values of the |Dictionary| | |
114 | 754 recursively. Ignoring case means case is ignored when comparing item values. |
755 | |
85 | 756 *E693* *E694* |
685 | 757 A |Funcref| can only be compared with a |Funcref| and only "equal" and "not |
758 equal" can be used. Case is never ignored. | |
759 | |
2908 | 760 When using "is" or "isnot" with a |List| or a |Dictionary| this checks if the |
761 expressions are referring to the same |List| or |Dictionary| instance. A copy | |
762 of a |List| is different from the original |List|. When using "is" without | |
763 a |List| or a |Dictionary| it is equivalent to using "equal", using "isnot" | |
764 equivalent to using "not equal". Except that a different type means the | |
765 values are different: "4 == '4'" is true, "4 is '4'" is false and "0 is []" is | |
3830 | 766 false and not an error. "is#"/"isnot#" and "is?"/"isnot?" can be used to match |
2908 | 767 and ignore case. |
79 | 768 |
7 | 769 When comparing a String with a Number, the String is converted to a Number, |
1621 | 770 and the comparison is done on Numbers. This means that "0 == 'x'" is TRUE, |
7 | 771 because 'x' converted to a Number is zero. |
772 | |
773 When comparing two Strings, this is done with strcmp() or stricmp(). This | |
774 results in the mathematical difference (comparing byte values), not | |
775 necessarily the alphabetical difference in the local language. | |
776 | |
1621 | 777 When using the operators with a trailing '#', or the short version and |
1156 | 778 'ignorecase' is off, the comparing is done with strcmp(): case matters. |
7 | 779 |
780 When using the operators with a trailing '?', or the short version and | |
1156 | 781 'ignorecase' is set, the comparing is done with stricmp(): case is ignored. |
782 | |
783 'smartcase' is not used. | |
7 | 784 |
785 The "=~" and "!~" operators match the lefthand argument with the righthand | |
786 argument, which is used as a pattern. See |pattern| for what a pattern is. | |
787 This matching is always done like 'magic' was set and 'cpoptions' is empty, no | |
788 matter what the actual value of 'magic' or 'cpoptions' is. This makes scripts | |
789 portable. To avoid backslashes in the regexp pattern to be doubled, use a | |
790 single-quote string, see |literal-string|. | |
791 Since a string is considered to be a single line, a multi-line pattern | |
792 (containing \n, backslash-n) will not match. However, a literal NL character | |
793 can be matched like an ordinary character. Examples: | |
794 "foo\nbar" =~ "\n" evaluates to 1 | |
795 "foo\nbar" =~ "\\n" evaluates to 0 | |
796 | |
797 | |
798 expr5 and expr6 *expr5* *expr6* | |
799 --------------- | |
685 | 800 expr6 + expr6 .. Number addition or |List| concatenation *expr-+* |
79 | 801 expr6 - expr6 .. Number subtraction *expr--* |
802 expr6 . expr6 .. String concatenation *expr-.* | |
803 | |
692 | 804 For |Lists| only "+" is possible and then both expr6 must be a list. The |
685 | 805 result is a new list with the two lists Concatenated. |
79 | 806 |
3214 | 807 expr7 * expr7 .. Number multiplication *expr-star* |
808 expr7 / expr7 .. Number division *expr-/* | |
809 expr7 % expr7 .. Number modulo *expr-%* | |
7 | 810 |
811 For all, except ".", Strings are converted to Numbers. | |
3214 | 812 For bitwise operators see |and()|, |or()| and |xor()|. |
7 | 813 |
814 Note the difference between "+" and ".": | |
815 "123" + "456" = 579 | |
816 "123" . "456" = "123456" | |
817 | |
1621 | 818 Since '.' has the same precedence as '+' and '-', you need to read: > |
819 1 . 90 + 90.0 | |
820 As: > | |
821 (1 . 90) + 90.0 | |
822 That works, since the String "190" is automatically converted to the Number | |
823 190, which can be added to the Float 90.0. However: > | |
824 1 . 90 * 90.0 | |
825 Should be read as: > | |
826 1 . (90 * 90.0) | |
827 Since '.' has lower precedence than '*'. This does NOT work, since this | |
828 attempts to concatenate a Float and a String. | |
829 | |
830 When dividing a Number by zero the result depends on the value: | |
831 0 / 0 = -0x80000000 (like NaN for Float) | |
832 >0 / 0 = 0x7fffffff (like positive infinity) | |
833 <0 / 0 = -0x7fffffff (like negative infinity) | |
834 (before Vim 7.2 it was always 0x7fffffff) | |
835 | |
7 | 836 When the righthand side of '%' is zero, the result is 0. |
837 | |
685 | 838 None of these work for |Funcref|s. |
79 | 839 |
1621 | 840 . and % do not work for Float. *E804* |
841 | |
7 | 842 |
843 expr7 *expr7* | |
844 ----- | |
845 ! expr7 logical NOT *expr-!* | |
846 - expr7 unary minus *expr-unary--* | |
847 + expr7 unary plus *expr-unary-+* | |
848 | |
849 For '!' non-zero becomes zero, zero becomes one. | |
850 For '-' the sign of the number is changed. | |
851 For '+' the number is unchanged. | |
852 | |
853 A String will be converted to a Number first. | |
854 | |
1621 | 855 These three can be repeated and mixed. Examples: |
7 | 856 !-1 == 0 |
857 !!8 == 1 | |
858 --9 == 9 | |
859 | |
860 | |
861 expr8 *expr8* | |
862 ----- | |
685 | 863 expr8[expr1] item of String or |List| *expr-[]* *E111* |
102 | 864 |
865 If expr8 is a Number or String this results in a String that contains the | |
866 expr1'th single byte from expr8. expr8 is used as a String, expr1 as a | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
867 Number. This doesn't recognize multi-byte encodings, see |byteidx()| for |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
868 an alternative. |
55 | 869 |
7384
aea5ebf352c4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/256972a9849b5d575b62a6a71be5b6934b5b0e8b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7358
diff
changeset
|
870 Index zero gives the first byte. This is like it works in C. Careful: |
aea5ebf352c4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/256972a9849b5d575b62a6a71be5b6934b5b0e8b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7358
diff
changeset
|
871 text column numbers start with one! Example, to get the byte under the |
55 | 872 cursor: > |
823 | 873 :let c = getline(".")[col(".") - 1] |
7 | 874 |
875 If the length of the String is less than the index, the result is an empty | |
7659
07f11de5efca
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/85084ef1e999dcf50e8d466106a33bac24a0febb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7653
diff
changeset
|
876 String. A negative index always results in an empty string (reason: backward |
55 | 877 compatibility). Use [-1:] to get the last byte. |
878 | |
685 | 879 If expr8 is a |List| then it results the item at index expr1. See |list-index| |
55 | 880 for possible index values. If the index is out of range this results in an |
1621 | 881 error. Example: > |
55 | 882 :let item = mylist[-1] " get last item |
883 | |
685 | 884 Generally, if a |List| index is equal to or higher than the length of the |
885 |List|, or more negative than the length of the |List|, this results in an | |
886 error. | |
55 | 887 |
99 | 888 |
102 | 889 expr8[expr1a : expr1b] substring or sublist *expr-[:]* |
890 | |
891 If expr8 is a Number or String this results in the substring with the bytes | |
892 from expr1a to and including expr1b. expr8 is used as a String, expr1a and | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
893 expr1b are used as a Number. This doesn't recognize multi-byte encodings, see |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
894 |byteidx()| for computing the indexes. |
55 | 895 |
896 If expr1a is omitted zero is used. If expr1b is omitted the length of the | |
897 string minus one is used. | |
898 | |
899 A negative number can be used to measure from the end of the string. -1 is | |
900 the last character, -2 the last but one, etc. | |
901 | |
902 If an index goes out of range for the string characters are omitted. If | |
903 expr1b is smaller than expr1a the result is an empty string. | |
904 | |
905 Examples: > | |
906 :let c = name[-1:] " last byte of a string | |
907 :let c = name[-2:-2] " last but one byte of a string | |
908 :let s = line(".")[4:] " from the fifth byte to the end | |
909 :let s = s[:-3] " remove last two bytes | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
910 < |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
911 *sublist* *slice* |
685 | 912 If expr8 is a |List| this results in a new |List| with the items indicated by |
1621 | 913 the indexes expr1a and expr1b. This works like with a String, as explained |
685 | 914 just above, except that indexes out of range cause an error. Examples: > |
55 | 915 :let l = mylist[:3] " first four items |
916 :let l = mylist[4:4] " List with one item | |
917 :let l = mylist[:] " shallow copy of a List | |
918 | |
685 | 919 Using expr8[expr1] or expr8[expr1a : expr1b] on a |Funcref| results in an |
920 error. | |
921 | |
7615
228ff048db20
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/da440d21a6b94d7f525fa7be9b1417c78dd9aa4c
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7597
diff
changeset
|
922 Watch out for confusion between a namespace and a variable followed by a colon |
228ff048db20
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/da440d21a6b94d7f525fa7be9b1417c78dd9aa4c
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7597
diff
changeset
|
923 for a sublist: > |
228ff048db20
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/da440d21a6b94d7f525fa7be9b1417c78dd9aa4c
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7597
diff
changeset
|
924 mylist[n:] " uses variable n |
228ff048db20
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/da440d21a6b94d7f525fa7be9b1417c78dd9aa4c
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7597
diff
changeset
|
925 mylist[s:] " uses namespace s:, error! |
228ff048db20
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/da440d21a6b94d7f525fa7be9b1417c78dd9aa4c
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7597
diff
changeset
|
926 |
685 | 927 |
928 expr8.name entry in a |Dictionary| *expr-entry* | |
929 | |
930 If expr8 is a |Dictionary| and it is followed by a dot, then the following | |
931 name will be used as a key in the |Dictionary|. This is just like: | |
932 expr8[name]. | |
99 | 933 |
934 The name must consist of alphanumeric characters, just like a variable name, | |
935 but it may start with a number. Curly braces cannot be used. | |
936 | |
937 There must not be white space before or after the dot. | |
938 | |
939 Examples: > | |
940 :let dict = {"one": 1, 2: "two"} | |
941 :echo dict.one | |
942 :echo dict .2 | |
943 | |
944 Note that the dot is also used for String concatenation. To avoid confusion | |
945 always put spaces around the dot for String concatenation. | |
946 | |
947 | |
685 | 948 expr8(expr1, ...) |Funcref| function call |
102 | 949 |
950 When expr8 is a |Funcref| type variable, invoke the function it refers to. | |
951 | |
952 | |
953 | |
954 *expr9* | |
7 | 955 number |
956 ------ | |
3224 | 957 number number constant *expr-number* |
958 *hex-number* *octal-number* | |
7 | 959 |
960 Decimal, Hexadecimal (starting with 0x or 0X), or Octal (starting with 0). | |
961 | |
1621 | 962 *floating-point-format* |
963 Floating point numbers can be written in two forms: | |
964 | |
965 [-+]{N}.{M} | |
6530 | 966 [-+]{N}.{M}[eE][-+]{exp} |
1621 | 967 |
968 {N} and {M} are numbers. Both {N} and {M} must be present and can only | |
969 contain digits. | |
970 [-+] means there is an optional plus or minus sign. | |
971 {exp} is the exponent, power of 10. | |
972 Only a decimal point is accepted, not a comma. No matter what the current | |
973 locale is. | |
974 {only when compiled with the |+float| feature} | |
975 | |
976 Examples: | |
977 123.456 | |
978 +0.0001 | |
979 55.0 | |
980 -0.123 | |
981 1.234e03 | |
982 1.0E-6 | |
983 -3.1416e+88 | |
984 | |
985 These are INVALID: | |
986 3. empty {M} | |
987 1e40 missing .{M} | |
988 | |
1698 | 989 *float-pi* *float-e* |
990 A few useful values to copy&paste: > | |
991 :let pi = 3.14159265359 | |
992 :let e = 2.71828182846 | |
993 | |
1621 | 994 Rationale: |
995 Before floating point was introduced, the text "123.456" was interpreted as | |
996 the two numbers "123" and "456", both converted to a string and concatenated, | |
997 resulting in the string "123456". Since this was considered pointless, and we | |
1698 | 998 could not find it intentionally being used in Vim scripts, this backwards |
1621 | 999 incompatibility was accepted in favor of being able to use the normal notation |
1000 for floating point numbers. | |
1001 | |
1002 *floating-point-precision* | |
1003 The precision and range of floating points numbers depends on what "double" | |
1004 means in the library Vim was compiled with. There is no way to change this at | |
1005 runtime. | |
1006 | |
1007 The default for displaying a |Float| is to use 6 decimal places, like using | |
1008 printf("%g", f). You can select something else when using the |printf()| | |
1009 function. Example: > | |
1010 :echo printf('%.15e', atan(1)) | |
1011 < 7.853981633974483e-01 | |
1012 | |
1013 | |
7 | 1014 |
6884 | 1015 string *string* *String* *expr-string* *E114* |
7 | 1016 ------ |
1017 "string" string constant *expr-quote* | |
1018 | |
1019 Note that double quotes are used. | |
1020 | |
1021 A string constant accepts these special characters: | |
1022 \... three-digit octal number (e.g., "\316") | |
1023 \.. two-digit octal number (must be followed by non-digit) | |
1024 \. one-digit octal number (must be followed by non-digit) | |
1025 \x.. byte specified with two hex numbers (e.g., "\x1f") | |
1026 \x. byte specified with one hex number (must be followed by non-hex char) | |
1027 \X.. same as \x.. | |
1028 \X. same as \x. | |
1621 | 1029 \u.... character specified with up to 4 hex numbers, stored according to the |
7 | 1030 current value of 'encoding' (e.g., "\u02a4") |
6840 | 1031 \U.... same as \u but allows up to 8 hex numbers. |
7 | 1032 \b backspace <BS> |
1033 \e escape <Esc> | |
1034 \f formfeed <FF> | |
1035 \n newline <NL> | |
1036 \r return <CR> | |
1037 \t tab <Tab> | |
1038 \\ backslash | |
1039 \" double quote | |
2152 | 1040 \<xxx> Special key named "xxx". e.g. "\<C-W>" for CTRL-W. This is for use |
1041 in mappings, the 0x80 byte is escaped. Don't use <Char-xxxx> to get a | |
1042 utf-8 character, use \uxxxx as mentioned above. | |
7 | 1043 |
1156 | 1044 Note that "\xff" is stored as the byte 255, which may be invalid in some |
1045 encodings. Use "\u00ff" to store character 255 according to the current value | |
1046 of 'encoding'. | |
1047 | |
7 | 1048 Note that "\000" and "\x00" force the end of the string. |
1049 | |
1050 | |
1051 literal-string *literal-string* *E115* | |
1052 --------------- | |
26 | 1053 'string' string constant *expr-'* |
7 | 1054 |
1055 Note that single quotes are used. | |
1056 | |
1621 | 1057 This string is taken as it is. No backslashes are removed or have a special |
99 | 1058 meaning. The only exception is that two quotes stand for one quote. |
26 | 1059 |
1060 Single quoted strings are useful for patterns, so that backslashes do not need | |
1621 | 1061 to be doubled. These two commands are equivalent: > |
26 | 1062 if a =~ "\\s*" |
1063 if a =~ '\s*' | |
7 | 1064 |
1065 | |
1066 option *expr-option* *E112* *E113* | |
1067 ------ | |
1068 &option option value, local value if possible | |
1069 &g:option global option value | |
1070 &l:option local option value | |
1071 | |
1072 Examples: > | |
1073 echo "tabstop is " . &tabstop | |
1074 if &insertmode | |
1075 | |
1076 Any option name can be used here. See |options|. When using the local value | |
1077 and there is no buffer-local or window-local value, the global value is used | |
1078 anyway. | |
1079 | |
1080 | |
1156 | 1081 register *expr-register* *@r* |
7 | 1082 -------- |
1083 @r contents of register 'r' | |
1084 | |
1085 The result is the contents of the named register, as a single string. | |
1086 Newlines are inserted where required. To get the contents of the unnamed | |
1621 | 1087 register use @" or @@. See |registers| for an explanation of the available |
336 | 1088 registers. |
1089 | |
1090 When using the '=' register you get the expression itself, not what it | |
1091 evaluates to. Use |eval()| to evaluate it. | |
7 | 1092 |
1093 | |
1094 nesting *expr-nesting* *E110* | |
1095 ------- | |
1096 (expr1) nested expression | |
1097 | |
1098 | |
1099 environment variable *expr-env* | |
1100 -------------------- | |
1101 $VAR environment variable | |
1102 | |
1103 The String value of any environment variable. When it is not defined, the | |
1104 result is an empty string. | |
1105 *expr-env-expand* | |
1106 Note that there is a difference between using $VAR directly and using | |
1107 expand("$VAR"). Using it directly will only expand environment variables that | |
1108 are known inside the current Vim session. Using expand() will first try using | |
1109 the environment variables known inside the current Vim session. If that | |
1110 fails, a shell will be used to expand the variable. This can be slow, but it | |
1111 does expand all variables that the shell knows about. Example: > | |
6180 | 1112 :echo $shell |
1113 :echo expand("$shell") | |
1114 The first one probably doesn't echo anything, the second echoes the $shell | |
7 | 1115 variable (if your shell supports it). |
1116 | |
1117 | |
1118 internal variable *expr-variable* | |
1119 ----------------- | |
1120 variable internal variable | |
1121 See below |internal-variables|. | |
1122 | |
1123 | |
170 | 1124 function call *expr-function* *E116* *E118* *E119* *E120* |
7 | 1125 ------------- |
1126 function(expr1, ...) function call | |
1127 See below |functions|. | |
1128 | |
1129 | |
1130 ============================================================================== | |
2596 | 1131 3. Internal variable *internal-variables* *E461* |
1132 | |
7 | 1133 An internal variable name can be made up of letters, digits and '_'. But it |
1134 cannot start with a digit. It's also possible to use curly braces, see | |
1135 |curly-braces-names|. | |
1136 | |
1137 An internal variable is created with the ":let" command |:let|. | |
87 | 1138 An internal variable is explicitly destroyed with the ":unlet" command |
1139 |:unlet|. | |
1140 Using a name that is not an internal variable or refers to a variable that has | |
1141 been destroyed results in an error. | |
7 | 1142 |
1143 There are several name spaces for variables. Which one is to be used is | |
1144 specified by what is prepended: | |
1145 | |
1146 (nothing) In a function: local to a function; otherwise: global | |
1147 |buffer-variable| b: Local to the current buffer. | |
1148 |window-variable| w: Local to the current window. | |
819 | 1149 |tabpage-variable| t: Local to the current tab page. |
7 | 1150 |global-variable| g: Global. |
1151 |local-variable| l: Local to a function. | |
1152 |script-variable| s: Local to a |:source|'ed Vim script. | |
1153 |function-argument| a: Function argument (only inside a function). | |
5815 | 1154 |vim-variable| v: Global, predefined by Vim. |
7 | 1155 |
685 | 1156 The scope name by itself can be used as a |Dictionary|. For example, to |
1157 delete all script-local variables: > | |
133 | 1158 :for k in keys(s:) |
1159 : unlet s:[k] | |
1160 :endfor | |
1161 < | |
4358 | 1162 *buffer-variable* *b:var* *b:* |
7 | 1163 A variable name that is preceded with "b:" is local to the current buffer. |
1164 Thus you can have several "b:foo" variables, one for each buffer. | |
1165 This kind of variable is deleted when the buffer is wiped out or deleted with | |
1166 |:bdelete|. | |
1167 | |
1168 One local buffer variable is predefined: | |
4264 | 1169 *b:changedtick* *changetick* |
7 | 1170 b:changedtick The total number of changes to the current buffer. It is |
1171 incremented for each change. An undo command is also a change | |
1172 in this case. This can be used to perform an action only when | |
1173 the buffer has changed. Example: > | |
1174 :if my_changedtick != b:changedtick | |
1621 | 1175 : let my_changedtick = b:changedtick |
1176 : call My_Update() | |
7 | 1177 :endif |
1178 < | |
4358 | 1179 *window-variable* *w:var* *w:* |
7 | 1180 A variable name that is preceded with "w:" is local to the current window. It |
1181 is deleted when the window is closed. | |
1182 | |
4437 | 1183 *tabpage-variable* *t:var* *t:* |
819 | 1184 A variable name that is preceded with "t:" is local to the current tab page, |
1185 It is deleted when the tab page is closed. {not available when compiled | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2569
diff
changeset
|
1186 without the |+windows| feature} |
819 | 1187 |
4358 | 1188 *global-variable* *g:var* *g:* |
7 | 1189 Inside functions global variables are accessed with "g:". Omitting this will |
1621 | 1190 access a variable local to a function. But "g:" can also be used in any other |
7 | 1191 place if you like. |
1192 | |
4358 | 1193 *local-variable* *l:var* *l:* |
7 | 1194 Inside functions local variables are accessed without prepending anything. |
1156 | 1195 But you can also prepend "l:" if you like. However, without prepending "l:" |
1196 you may run into reserved variable names. For example "count". By itself it | |
1197 refers to "v:count". Using "l:count" you can have a local variable with the | |
1198 same name. | |
7 | 1199 |
1200 *script-variable* *s:var* | |
1201 In a Vim script variables starting with "s:" can be used. They cannot be | |
1202 accessed from outside of the scripts, thus are local to the script. | |
1203 | |
1204 They can be used in: | |
1205 - commands executed while the script is sourced | |
1206 - functions defined in the script | |
1207 - autocommands defined in the script | |
1208 - functions and autocommands defined in functions and autocommands which were | |
1209 defined in the script (recursively) | |
1210 - user defined commands defined in the script | |
1211 Thus not in: | |
1212 - other scripts sourced from this one | |
1213 - mappings | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
1214 - menus |
7 | 1215 - etc. |
1216 | |
1156 | 1217 Script variables can be used to avoid conflicts with global variable names. |
1218 Take this example: > | |
7 | 1219 |
1220 let s:counter = 0 | |
1221 function MyCounter() | |
1222 let s:counter = s:counter + 1 | |
1223 echo s:counter | |
1224 endfunction | |
1225 command Tick call MyCounter() | |
1226 | |
1227 You can now invoke "Tick" from any script, and the "s:counter" variable in | |
1228 that script will not be changed, only the "s:counter" in the script where | |
1229 "Tick" was defined is used. | |
1230 | |
1231 Another example that does the same: > | |
1232 | |
1233 let s:counter = 0 | |
1234 command Tick let s:counter = s:counter + 1 | echo s:counter | |
1235 | |
1236 When calling a function and invoking a user-defined command, the context for | |
9 | 1237 script variables is set to the script where the function or command was |
7 | 1238 defined. |
1239 | |
1240 The script variables are also available when a function is defined inside a | |
1241 function that is defined in a script. Example: > | |
1242 | |
1243 let s:counter = 0 | |
1244 function StartCounting(incr) | |
1245 if a:incr | |
1246 function MyCounter() | |
1247 let s:counter = s:counter + 1 | |
1248 endfunction | |
1249 else | |
1250 function MyCounter() | |
1251 let s:counter = s:counter - 1 | |
1252 endfunction | |
1253 endif | |
1254 endfunction | |
1255 | |
1256 This defines the MyCounter() function either for counting up or counting down | |
1257 when calling StartCounting(). It doesn't matter from where StartCounting() is | |
1258 called, the s:counter variable will be accessible in MyCounter(). | |
1259 | |
1260 When the same script is sourced again it will use the same script variables. | |
1261 They will remain valid as long as Vim is running. This can be used to | |
1262 maintain a counter: > | |
1263 | |
1264 if !exists("s:counter") | |
1265 let s:counter = 1 | |
1266 echo "script executed for the first time" | |
1267 else | |
1268 let s:counter = s:counter + 1 | |
1269 echo "script executed " . s:counter . " times now" | |
1270 endif | |
1271 | |
1272 Note that this means that filetype plugins don't get a different set of script | |
1273 variables for each buffer. Use local buffer variables instead |b:var|. | |
1274 | |
1275 | |
4358 | 1276 Predefined Vim variables: *vim-variable* *v:var* *v:* |
7 | 1277 |
189 | 1278 *v:beval_col* *beval_col-variable* |
1279 v:beval_col The number of the column, over which the mouse pointer is. | |
1280 This is the byte index in the |v:beval_lnum| line. | |
1281 Only valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option. | |
1282 | |
1283 *v:beval_bufnr* *beval_bufnr-variable* | |
1284 v:beval_bufnr The number of the buffer, over which the mouse pointer is. Only | |
1285 valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option. | |
1286 | |
1287 *v:beval_lnum* *beval_lnum-variable* | |
1288 v:beval_lnum The number of the line, over which the mouse pointer is. Only | |
1289 valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option. | |
1290 | |
1291 *v:beval_text* *beval_text-variable* | |
374 | 1292 v:beval_text The text under or after the mouse pointer. Usually a word as |
1293 it is useful for debugging a C program. 'iskeyword' applies, | |
1294 but a dot and "->" before the position is included. When on a | |
1295 ']' the text before it is used, including the matching '[' and | |
189 | 1296 word before it. When on a Visual area within one line the |
1297 highlighted text is used. | |
1298 Only valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option. | |
1299 | |
1300 *v:beval_winnr* *beval_winnr-variable* | |
1301 v:beval_winnr The number of the window, over which the mouse pointer is. Only | |
2709 | 1302 valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option. The first |
1303 window has number zero (unlike most other places where a | |
1304 window gets a number). | |
189 | 1305 |
844 | 1306 *v:char* *char-variable* |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
1307 v:char Argument for evaluating 'formatexpr' and used for the typed |
2249
6d3d35ff2c2b
Use full path in undofile(). Updated docs.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2236
diff
changeset
|
1308 character when using <expr> in an abbreviation |:map-<expr>|. |
4502
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4437
diff
changeset
|
1309 It is also used by the |InsertCharPre| and |InsertEnter| events. |
844 | 1310 |
7 | 1311 *v:charconvert_from* *charconvert_from-variable* |
1312 v:charconvert_from | |
1313 The name of the character encoding of a file to be converted. | |
1314 Only valid while evaluating the 'charconvert' option. | |
1315 | |
1316 *v:charconvert_to* *charconvert_to-variable* | |
1317 v:charconvert_to | |
1318 The name of the character encoding of a file after conversion. | |
1319 Only valid while evaluating the 'charconvert' option. | |
1320 | |
1321 *v:cmdarg* *cmdarg-variable* | |
1322 v:cmdarg This variable is used for two purposes: | |
1323 1. The extra arguments given to a file read/write command. | |
1324 Currently these are "++enc=" and "++ff=". This variable is | |
1325 set before an autocommand event for a file read/write | |
1326 command is triggered. There is a leading space to make it | |
1327 possible to append this variable directly after the | |
1621 | 1328 read/write command. Note: The "+cmd" argument isn't |
7 | 1329 included here, because it will be executed anyway. |
1330 2. When printing a PostScript file with ":hardcopy" this is | |
1331 the argument for the ":hardcopy" command. This can be used | |
1332 in 'printexpr'. | |
1333 | |
1334 *v:cmdbang* *cmdbang-variable* | |
1335 v:cmdbang Set like v:cmdarg for a file read/write command. When a "!" | |
1336 was used the value is 1, otherwise it is 0. Note that this | |
1337 can only be used in autocommands. For user commands |<bang>| | |
1338 can be used. | |
1339 | |
6909 | 1340 *v:completed_item* *completed_item-variable* |
1341 v:completed_item | |
1342 |Dictionary| containing the |complete-items| for the most | |
1343 recently completed word after |CompleteDone|. The | |
1344 |Dictionary| is empty if the completion failed. | |
1345 | |
7 | 1346 *v:count* *count-variable* |
1347 v:count The count given for the last Normal mode command. Can be used | |
1621 | 1348 to get the count before a mapping. Read-only. Example: > |
7 | 1349 :map _x :<C-U>echo "the count is " . v:count<CR> |
1350 < Note: The <C-U> is required to remove the line range that you | |
1351 get when typing ':' after a count. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
1352 When there are two counts, as in "3d2w", they are multiplied, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
1353 just like what happens in the command, "d6w" for the example. |
667 | 1354 Also used for evaluating the 'formatexpr' option. |
7 | 1355 "count" also works, for backwards compatibility. |
1356 | |
1357 *v:count1* *count1-variable* | |
1358 v:count1 Just like "v:count", but defaults to one when no count is | |
1359 used. | |
1360 | |
1361 *v:ctype* *ctype-variable* | |
1362 v:ctype The current locale setting for characters of the runtime | |
1363 environment. This allows Vim scripts to be aware of the | |
1364 current locale encoding. Technical: it's the value of | |
1365 LC_CTYPE. When not using a locale the value is "C". | |
1366 This variable can not be set directly, use the |:language| | |
1367 command. | |
1368 See |multi-lang|. | |
1369 | |
1370 *v:dying* *dying-variable* | |
1621 | 1371 v:dying Normally zero. When a deadly signal is caught it's set to |
7 | 1372 one. When multiple signals are caught the number increases. |
1373 Can be used in an autocommand to check if Vim didn't | |
1374 terminate normally. {only works on Unix} | |
1375 Example: > | |
1376 :au VimLeave * if v:dying | echo "\nAAAAaaaarrrggghhhh!!!\n" | endif | |
2226
36a9ac99e1ca
Don't execute some autocommands when v:dying is 2 or more.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
1377 < Note: if another deadly signal is caught when v:dying is one, |
36a9ac99e1ca
Don't execute some autocommands when v:dying is 2 or more.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
1378 VimLeave autocommands will not be executed. |
36a9ac99e1ca
Don't execute some autocommands when v:dying is 2 or more.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
1379 |
7 | 1380 *v:errmsg* *errmsg-variable* |
1381 v:errmsg Last given error message. It's allowed to set this variable. | |
1382 Example: > | |
1383 :let v:errmsg = "" | |
1384 :silent! next | |
1385 :if v:errmsg != "" | |
1386 : ... handle error | |
1387 < "errmsg" also works, for backwards compatibility. | |
1388 | |
7277
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
1389 *v:errors* *errors-variable* |
7279
b5e9810b389d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/683fa185a4b4ed7595e5942901548b8239ed5cdb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7277
diff
changeset
|
1390 v:errors Errors found by assert functions, such as |assert_true()|. |
7277
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
1391 This is a list of strings. |
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
1392 The assert functions append an item when an assert fails. |
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
1393 To remove old results make it empty: > |
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
1394 :let v:errors = [] |
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
1395 < If v:errors is set to anything but a list it is made an empty |
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
1396 list by the assert function. |
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
1397 |
7 | 1398 *v:exception* *exception-variable* |
1399 v:exception The value of the exception most recently caught and not | |
1400 finished. See also |v:throwpoint| and |throw-variables|. | |
1401 Example: > | |
1402 :try | |
1403 : throw "oops" | |
1404 :catch /.*/ | |
1405 : echo "caught" v:exception | |
1406 :endtry | |
1407 < Output: "caught oops". | |
1408 | |
179 | 1409 *v:fcs_reason* *fcs_reason-variable* |
1410 v:fcs_reason The reason why the |FileChangedShell| event was triggered. | |
1411 Can be used in an autocommand to decide what to do and/or what | |
1412 to set v:fcs_choice to. Possible values: | |
1413 deleted file no longer exists | |
1414 conflict file contents, mode or timestamp was | |
1415 changed and buffer is modified | |
1416 changed file contents has changed | |
1417 mode mode of file changed | |
1418 time only file timestamp changed | |
1419 | |
1420 *v:fcs_choice* *fcs_choice-variable* | |
1421 v:fcs_choice What should happen after a |FileChangedShell| event was | |
1422 triggered. Can be used in an autocommand to tell Vim what to | |
1423 do with the affected buffer: | |
1424 reload Reload the buffer (does not work if | |
1425 the file was deleted). | |
1426 ask Ask the user what to do, as if there | |
1427 was no autocommand. Except that when | |
1428 only the timestamp changed nothing | |
1429 will happen. | |
1430 <empty> Nothing, the autocommand should do | |
1431 everything that needs to be done. | |
1432 The default is empty. If another (invalid) value is used then | |
1433 Vim behaves like it is empty, there is no warning message. | |
1434 | |
7 | 1435 *v:fname_in* *fname_in-variable* |
579 | 1436 v:fname_in The name of the input file. Valid while evaluating: |
7 | 1437 option used for ~ |
1438 'charconvert' file to be converted | |
1439 'diffexpr' original file | |
1440 'patchexpr' original file | |
1441 'printexpr' file to be printed | |
593 | 1442 And set to the swap file name for |SwapExists|. |
7 | 1443 |
1444 *v:fname_out* *fname_out-variable* | |
1445 v:fname_out The name of the output file. Only valid while | |
1446 evaluating: | |
1447 option used for ~ | |
1448 'charconvert' resulting converted file (*) | |
1449 'diffexpr' output of diff | |
1450 'patchexpr' resulting patched file | |
1451 (*) When doing conversion for a write command (e.g., ":w | |
1621 | 1452 file") it will be equal to v:fname_in. When doing conversion |
7 | 1453 for a read command (e.g., ":e file") it will be a temporary |
1454 file and different from v:fname_in. | |
1455 | |
1456 *v:fname_new* *fname_new-variable* | |
1457 v:fname_new The name of the new version of the file. Only valid while | |
1458 evaluating 'diffexpr'. | |
1459 | |
1460 *v:fname_diff* *fname_diff-variable* | |
1461 v:fname_diff The name of the diff (patch) file. Only valid while | |
1462 evaluating 'patchexpr'. | |
1463 | |
1464 *v:folddashes* *folddashes-variable* | |
1465 v:folddashes Used for 'foldtext': dashes representing foldlevel of a closed | |
1466 fold. | |
29 | 1467 Read-only in the |sandbox|. |fold-foldtext| |
7 | 1468 |
1469 *v:foldlevel* *foldlevel-variable* | |
1470 v:foldlevel Used for 'foldtext': foldlevel of closed fold. | |
29 | 1471 Read-only in the |sandbox|. |fold-foldtext| |
7 | 1472 |
1473 *v:foldend* *foldend-variable* | |
1474 v:foldend Used for 'foldtext': last line of closed fold. | |
29 | 1475 Read-only in the |sandbox|. |fold-foldtext| |
7 | 1476 |
1477 *v:foldstart* *foldstart-variable* | |
1478 v:foldstart Used for 'foldtext': first line of closed fold. | |
29 | 1479 Read-only in the |sandbox|. |fold-foldtext| |
7 | 1480 |
5460 | 1481 *v:hlsearch* *hlsearch-variable* |
6413 | 1482 v:hlsearch Variable that indicates whether search highlighting is on. |
1483 Setting it makes sense only if 'hlsearch' is enabled which | |
1484 requires |+extra_search|. Setting this variable to zero acts | |
1485 the like |:nohlsearch| command, setting it to one acts like > | |
5460 | 1486 let &hlsearch = &hlsearch |
6918 | 1487 < Note that the value is restored when returning from a |
1488 function. |function-search-undo|. | |
1489 | |
11 | 1490 *v:insertmode* *insertmode-variable* |
1491 v:insertmode Used for the |InsertEnter| and |InsertChange| autocommand | |
1492 events. Values: | |
1493 i Insert mode | |
1494 r Replace mode | |
1495 v Virtual Replace mode | |
1496 | |
102 | 1497 *v:key* *key-variable* |
685 | 1498 v:key Key of the current item of a |Dictionary|. Only valid while |
102 | 1499 evaluating the expression used with |map()| and |filter()|. |
1500 Read-only. | |
1501 | |
7 | 1502 *v:lang* *lang-variable* |
1503 v:lang The current locale setting for messages of the runtime | |
1504 environment. This allows Vim scripts to be aware of the | |
1505 current language. Technical: it's the value of LC_MESSAGES. | |
1506 The value is system dependent. | |
1507 This variable can not be set directly, use the |:language| | |
1508 command. | |
1509 It can be different from |v:ctype| when messages are desired | |
1510 in a different language than what is used for character | |
1511 encoding. See |multi-lang|. | |
1512 | |
1513 *v:lc_time* *lc_time-variable* | |
1514 v:lc_time The current locale setting for time messages of the runtime | |
1515 environment. This allows Vim scripts to be aware of the | |
1516 current language. Technical: it's the value of LC_TIME. | |
1517 This variable can not be set directly, use the |:language| | |
1518 command. See |multi-lang|. | |
1519 | |
1520 *v:lnum* *lnum-variable* | |
2350
06feaf4fe36a
Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2345
diff
changeset
|
1521 v:lnum Line number for the 'foldexpr' |fold-expr|, 'formatexpr' and |
06feaf4fe36a
Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2345
diff
changeset
|
1522 'indentexpr' expressions, tab page number for 'guitablabel' |
06feaf4fe36a
Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2345
diff
changeset
|
1523 and 'guitabtooltip'. Only valid while one of these |
06feaf4fe36a
Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2345
diff
changeset
|
1524 expressions is being evaluated. Read-only when in the |
06feaf4fe36a
Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2345
diff
changeset
|
1525 |sandbox|. |
7 | 1526 |
1029 | 1527 *v:mouse_win* *mouse_win-variable* |
1528 v:mouse_win Window number for a mouse click obtained with |getchar()|. | |
1529 First window has number 1, like with |winnr()|. The value is | |
1530 zero when there was no mouse button click. | |
1531 | |
1532 *v:mouse_lnum* *mouse_lnum-variable* | |
1533 v:mouse_lnum Line number for a mouse click obtained with |getchar()|. | |
1534 This is the text line number, not the screen line number. The | |
1535 value is zero when there was no mouse button click. | |
1536 | |
1537 *v:mouse_col* *mouse_col-variable* | |
1538 v:mouse_col Column number for a mouse click obtained with |getchar()|. | |
1539 This is the screen column number, like with |virtcol()|. The | |
1540 value is zero when there was no mouse button click. | |
1541 | |
1733 | 1542 *v:oldfiles* *oldfiles-variable* |
1543 v:oldfiles List of file names that is loaded from the |viminfo| file on | |
1544 startup. These are the files that Vim remembers marks for. | |
1545 The length of the List is limited by the ' argument of the | |
1546 'viminfo' option (default is 100). | |
5618 | 1547 When the |viminfo| file is not used the List is empty. |
1733 | 1548 Also see |:oldfiles| and |c_#<|. |
1549 The List can be modified, but this has no effect on what is | |
1550 stored in the |viminfo| file later. If you use values other | |
1551 than String this will cause trouble. | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2569
diff
changeset
|
1552 {only when compiled with the |+viminfo| feature} |
1733 | 1553 |
6935 | 1554 *v:option_new* |
1555 v:option_new New value of the option. Valid while executing an |OptionSet| | |
1556 autocommand. | |
1557 *v:option_old* | |
1558 v:option_old Old value of the option. Valid while executing an |OptionSet| | |
1559 autocommand. | |
1560 *v:option_type* | |
1561 v:option_type Scope of the set command. Valid while executing an | |
1562 |OptionSet| autocommand. Can be either "global" or "local" | |
1490 | 1563 *v:operator* *operator-variable* |
1564 v:operator The last operator given in Normal mode. This is a single | |
1565 character except for commands starting with <g> or <z>, | |
1566 in which case it is two characters. Best used alongside | |
1567 |v:prevcount| and |v:register|. Useful if you want to cancel | |
1568 Operator-pending mode and then use the operator, e.g.: > | |
1569 :omap O <Esc>:call MyMotion(v:operator)<CR> | |
1570 < The value remains set until another operator is entered, thus | |
1571 don't expect it to be empty. | |
1572 v:operator is not set for |:delete|, |:yank| or other Ex | |
1573 commands. | |
1574 Read-only. | |
1575 | |
7 | 1576 *v:prevcount* *prevcount-variable* |
1577 v:prevcount The count given for the last but one Normal mode command. | |
1578 This is the v:count value of the previous command. Useful if | |
1490 | 1579 you want to cancel Visual or Operator-pending mode and then |
1580 use the count, e.g.: > | |
7 | 1581 :vmap % <Esc>:call MyFilter(v:prevcount)<CR> |
1582 < Read-only. | |
1583 | |
170 | 1584 *v:profiling* *profiling-variable* |
1621 | 1585 v:profiling Normally zero. Set to one after using ":profile start". |
170 | 1586 See |profiling|. |
1587 | |
7 | 1588 *v:progname* *progname-variable* |
1589 v:progname Contains the name (with path removed) with which Vim was | |
3492 | 1590 invoked. Allows you to do special initialisations for |view|, |
1591 |evim| etc., or any other name you might symlink to Vim. | |
7 | 1592 Read-only. |
1593 | |
5780 | 1594 *v:progpath* *progpath-variable* |
1595 v:progpath Contains the command with which Vim was invoked, including the | |
1596 path. Useful if you want to message a Vim server using a | |
1597 |--remote-expr|. | |
5782 | 1598 To get the full path use: > |
1599 echo exepath(v:progpath) | |
1600 < NOTE: This does not work when the command is a relative path | |
1601 and the current directory has changed. | |
5780 | 1602 Read-only. |
1603 | |
7 | 1604 *v:register* *register-variable* |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
1605 v:register The name of the register in effect for the current normal mode |
3492 | 1606 command (regardless of whether that command actually used a |
1607 register). Or for the currently executing normal mode mapping | |
1608 (use this in custom commands that take a register). | |
1609 If none is supplied it is the default register '"', unless | |
1610 'clipboard' contains "unnamed" or "unnamedplus", then it is | |
1611 '*' or '+'. | |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
1612 Also see |getreg()| and |setreg()| |
7 | 1613 |
540 | 1614 *v:scrollstart* *scrollstart-variable* |
1615 v:scrollstart String describing the script or function that caused the | |
1616 screen to scroll up. It's only set when it is empty, thus the | |
1617 first reason is remembered. It is set to "Unknown" for a | |
1618 typed command. | |
1619 This can be used to find out why your script causes the | |
1620 hit-enter prompt. | |
1621 | |
7 | 1622 *v:servername* *servername-variable* |
1623 v:servername The resulting registered |x11-clientserver| name if any. | |
1624 Read-only. | |
1625 | |
1621 | 1626 |
1627 v:searchforward *v:searchforward* *searchforward-variable* | |
1628 Search direction: 1 after a forward search, 0 after a | |
1629 backward search. It is reset to forward when directly setting | |
1630 the last search pattern, see |quote/|. | |
1631 Note that the value is restored when returning from a | |
1632 function. |function-search-undo|. | |
1633 Read-write. | |
1634 | |
7 | 1635 *v:shell_error* *shell_error-variable* |
1636 v:shell_error Result of the last shell command. When non-zero, the last | |
1637 shell command had an error. When zero, there was no problem. | |
1638 This only works when the shell returns the error code to Vim. | |
1639 The value -1 is often used when the command could not be | |
1640 executed. Read-only. | |
1641 Example: > | |
1642 :!mv foo bar | |
1643 :if v:shell_error | |
1644 : echo 'could not rename "foo" to "bar"!' | |
1645 :endif | |
1646 < "shell_error" also works, for backwards compatibility. | |
1647 | |
1648 *v:statusmsg* *statusmsg-variable* | |
1649 v:statusmsg Last given status message. It's allowed to set this variable. | |
1650 | |
579 | 1651 *v:swapname* *swapname-variable* |
1652 v:swapname Only valid when executing |SwapExists| autocommands: Name of | |
1653 the swap file found. Read-only. | |
1654 | |
1655 *v:swapchoice* *swapchoice-variable* | |
1656 v:swapchoice |SwapExists| autocommands can set this to the selected choice | |
1657 for handling an existing swap file: | |
1658 'o' Open read-only | |
1659 'e' Edit anyway | |
1660 'r' Recover | |
1661 'd' Delete swapfile | |
1662 'q' Quit | |
1663 'a' Abort | |
1621 | 1664 The value should be a single-character string. An empty value |
579 | 1665 results in the user being asked, as would happen when there is |
1666 no SwapExists autocommand. The default is empty. | |
1667 | |
590 | 1668 *v:swapcommand* *swapcommand-variable* |
625 | 1669 v:swapcommand Normal mode command to be executed after a file has been |
590 | 1670 opened. Can be used for a |SwapExists| autocommand to have |
1621 | 1671 another Vim open the file and jump to the right place. For |
590 | 1672 example, when jumping to a tag the value is ":tag tagname\r". |
716 | 1673 For ":edit +cmd file" the value is ":cmd\r". |
590 | 1674 |
7 | 1675 *v:termresponse* *termresponse-variable* |
1676 v:termresponse The escape sequence returned by the terminal for the |t_RV| | |
1621 | 1677 termcap entry. It is set when Vim receives an escape sequence |
7 | 1678 that starts with ESC [ or CSI and ends in a 'c', with only |
1679 digits, ';' and '.' in between. | |
1680 When this option is set, the TermResponse autocommand event is | |
1681 fired, so that you can react to the response from the | |
1682 terminal. | |
1683 The response from a new xterm is: "<Esc>[ Pp ; Pv ; Pc c". Pp | |
1684 is the terminal type: 0 for vt100 and 1 for vt220. Pv is the | |
1685 patch level (since this was introduced in patch 95, it's | |
1686 always 95 or bigger). Pc is always zero. | |
1687 {only when compiled with |+termresponse| feature} | |
1688 | |
1689 *v:this_session* *this_session-variable* | |
1690 v:this_session Full filename of the last loaded or saved session file. See | |
1691 |:mksession|. It is allowed to set this variable. When no | |
1692 session file has been saved, this variable is empty. | |
1693 "this_session" also works, for backwards compatibility. | |
1694 | |
1695 *v:throwpoint* *throwpoint-variable* | |
1696 v:throwpoint The point where the exception most recently caught and not | |
1621 | 1697 finished was thrown. Not set when commands are typed. See |
7 | 1698 also |v:exception| and |throw-variables|. |
1699 Example: > | |
1700 :try | |
1701 : throw "oops" | |
1702 :catch /.*/ | |
1703 : echo "Exception from" v:throwpoint | |
1704 :endtry | |
1705 < Output: "Exception from test.vim, line 2" | |
1706 | |
102 | 1707 *v:val* *val-variable* |
1621 | 1708 v:val Value of the current item of a |List| or |Dictionary|. Only |
685 | 1709 valid while evaluating the expression used with |map()| and |
102 | 1710 |filter()|. Read-only. |
1711 | |
7 | 1712 *v:version* *version-variable* |
1713 v:version Version number of Vim: Major version number times 100 plus | |
1714 minor version number. Version 5.0 is 500. Version 5.1 (5.01) | |
1715 is 501. Read-only. "version" also works, for backwards | |
1716 compatibility. | |
1717 Use |has()| to check if a certain patch was included, e.g.: > | |
5786 | 1718 if has("patch-7.4.123") |
7 | 1719 < Note that patch numbers are specific to the version, thus both |
1720 version 5.0 and 5.1 may have a patch 123, but these are | |
1721 completely different. | |
1722 | |
1723 *v:warningmsg* *warningmsg-variable* | |
1724 v:warningmsg Last given warning message. It's allowed to set this variable. | |
1725 | |
2609 | 1726 *v:windowid* *windowid-variable* |
1727 v:windowid When any X11 based GUI is running or when running in a | |
1728 terminal and Vim connects to the X server (|-X|) this will be | |
2616 | 1729 set to the window ID. |
1730 When an MS-Windows GUI is running this will be set to the | |
1731 window handle. | |
1732 Otherwise the value is zero. | |
1733 Note: for windows inside Vim use |winnr()|. | |
2609 | 1734 |
7 | 1735 ============================================================================== |
1736 4. Builtin Functions *functions* | |
1737 | |
1738 See |function-list| for a list grouped by what the function is used for. | |
1739 | |
236 | 1740 (Use CTRL-] on the function name to jump to the full explanation.) |
7 | 1741 |
1742 USAGE RESULT DESCRIPTION ~ | |
1743 | |
1621 | 1744 abs( {expr}) Float or Number absolute value of {expr} |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
1745 acos( {expr}) Float arc cosine of {expr} |
685 | 1746 add( {list}, {item}) List append {item} to |List| {list} |
7557
502ca0a62fd8
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/acb4f221c715a333f4c49a2235a8006c6ac6e4d5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7513
diff
changeset
|
1747 alloc_fail( {id}, {countdown}, {repeat}) |
502ca0a62fd8
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/acb4f221c715a333f4c49a2235a8006c6ac6e4d5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7513
diff
changeset
|
1748 none make memory allocation fail |
3214 | 1749 and( {expr}, {expr}) Number bitwise AND |
55 | 1750 append( {lnum}, {string}) Number append {string} below line {lnum} |
161 | 1751 append( {lnum}, {list}) Number append lines {list} below line {lnum} |
7 | 1752 argc() Number number of files in the argument list |
55 | 1753 argidx() Number current index in the argument list |
7279
b5e9810b389d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/683fa185a4b4ed7595e5942901548b8239ed5cdb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7277
diff
changeset
|
1754 arglistid( [{winnr} [, {tabnr}]]) |
5942 | 1755 Number argument list id |
7 | 1756 argv( {nr}) String {nr} entry of the argument list |
818 | 1757 argv( ) List the argument list |
7584
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
1758 assert_equal( {exp}, {act} [, {msg}]) none assert {exp} equals {act} |
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
1759 assert_exception({error} [, {msg}]) none assert {error} is in v:exception |
7593
87e607fb6853
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a260b87d9da17f605666630f18c1ed909c2b8bae
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7584
diff
changeset
|
1760 assert_fails( {cmd} [, {error}]) none assert {cmd} fails |
7584
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
1761 assert_false( {actual} [, {msg}]) none assert {actual} is false |
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
1762 assert_true( {actual} [, {msg}]) none assert {actual} is true |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
1763 asin( {expr}) Float arc sine of {expr} |
1621 | 1764 atan( {expr}) Float arc tangent of {expr} |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
1765 atan2( {expr}, {expr}) Float arc tangent of {expr1} / {expr2} |
7 | 1766 browse( {save}, {title}, {initdir}, {default}) |
1767 String put up a file requester | |
1621 | 1768 browsedir( {title}, {initdir}) String put up a directory requester |
7 | 1769 bufexists( {expr}) Number TRUE if buffer {expr} exists |
55 | 1770 buflisted( {expr}) Number TRUE if buffer {expr} is listed |
1771 bufloaded( {expr}) Number TRUE if buffer {expr} is loaded | |
7 | 1772 bufname( {expr}) String Name of the buffer {expr} |
7100
f717d96a39b3
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/12969c04fe7bd27dc0cbf37709eb40a86d4a27f9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7013
diff
changeset
|
1773 bufnr( {expr} [, {create}]) Number Number of the buffer {expr} |
7 | 1774 bufwinnr( {expr}) Number window number of buffer {expr} |
1775 byte2line( {byte}) Number line number at byte count {byte} | |
55 | 1776 byteidx( {expr}, {nr}) Number byte index of {nr}'th char in {expr} |
5413 | 1777 byteidxcomp( {expr}, {nr}) Number byte index of {nr}'th char in {expr} |
102 | 1778 call( {func}, {arglist} [, {dict}]) |
1779 any call {func} with arguments {arglist} | |
1621 | 1780 ceil( {expr}) Float round {expr} up |
1781 changenr() Number current change number | |
4051 | 1782 char2nr( {expr}[, {utf8}]) Number ASCII/UTF8 value of first char in {expr} |
55 | 1783 cindent( {lnum}) Number C indent for line {lnum} |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
1784 clearmatches() none clear all matches |
7 | 1785 col( {expr}) Number column nr of cursor or mark |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
1786 complete( {startcol}, {matches}) none set Insert mode completion |
464 | 1787 complete_add( {expr}) Number add completion match |
1621 | 1788 complete_check() Number check for key typed during completion |
7 | 1789 confirm( {msg} [, {choices} [, {default} [, {type}]]]) |
1790 Number number of choice picked by user | |
55 | 1791 copy( {expr}) any make a shallow copy of {expr} |
1621 | 1792 cos( {expr}) Float cosine of {expr} |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
1793 cosh( {expr}) Float hyperbolic cosine of {expr} |
6259 | 1794 count( {list}, {expr} [, {ic} [, {start}]]) |
95 | 1795 Number count how many {expr} are in {list} |
7 | 1796 cscope_connection( [{num} , {dbpath} [, {prepend}]]) |
1797 Number checks existence of cscope connection | |
6385 | 1798 cursor( {lnum}, {col} [, {off}]) |
1799 Number move cursor to {lnum}, {col}, {off} | |
703 | 1800 cursor( {list}) Number move cursor to position in {list} |
5663
1dea14d4c738
Update runtime files. Add support for systemverilog.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5618
diff
changeset
|
1801 deepcopy( {expr} [, {noref}]) any make a full copy of {expr} |
7615
228ff048db20
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/da440d21a6b94d7f525fa7be9b1417c78dd9aa4c
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7597
diff
changeset
|
1802 delete( {fname} [, {flags}]) Number delete the file or directory {fname} |
7 | 1803 did_filetype() Number TRUE if FileType autocommand event used |
55 | 1804 diff_filler( {lnum}) Number diff filler lines about {lnum} |
1805 diff_hlID( {lnum}, {col}) Number diff highlighting at {lnum}/{col} | |
85 | 1806 empty( {expr}) Number TRUE if {expr} is empty |
7 | 1807 escape( {string}, {chars}) String escape {chars} in {string} with '\' |
205 | 1808 eval( {string}) any evaluate {string} into its value |
55 | 1809 eventhandler( ) Number TRUE if inside an event handler |
7 | 1810 executable( {expr}) Number 1 if executable {expr} exists |
5782 | 1811 exepath( {expr}) String full path of the command {expr} |
7 | 1812 exists( {expr}) Number TRUE if {expr} exists |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
1813 extend( {expr1}, {expr2} [, {expr3}]) |
824 | 1814 List/Dict insert items of {expr2} into {expr1} |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
1815 exp( {expr}) Float exponential of {expr} |
3398 | 1816 expand( {expr} [, {nosuf} [, {list}]]) |
1817 any expand special keywords in {expr} | |
1621 | 1818 feedkeys( {string} [, {mode}]) Number add key sequence to typeahead buffer |
7 | 1819 filereadable( {file}) Number TRUE if {file} is a readable file |
824 | 1820 filewritable( {file}) Number TRUE if {file} is a writable file |
102 | 1821 filter( {expr}, {string}) List/Dict remove items from {expr} where |
1822 {string} is 0 | |
95 | 1823 finddir( {name}[, {path}[, {count}]]) |
824 | 1824 String find directory {name} in {path} |
19 | 1825 findfile( {name}[, {path}[, {count}]]) |
824 | 1826 String find file {name} in {path} |
1621 | 1827 float2nr( {expr}) Number convert Float {expr} to a Number |
1828 floor( {expr}) Float round {expr} down | |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
1829 fmod( {expr1}, {expr2}) Float remainder of {expr1} / {expr2} |
1586 | 1830 fnameescape( {fname}) String escape special characters in {fname} |
7 | 1831 fnamemodify( {fname}, {mods}) String modify file name |
55 | 1832 foldclosed( {lnum}) Number first line of fold at {lnum} if closed |
1833 foldclosedend( {lnum}) Number last line of fold at {lnum} if closed | |
7 | 1834 foldlevel( {lnum}) Number fold level at {lnum} |
55 | 1835 foldtext( ) String line displayed for closed fold |
824 | 1836 foldtextresult( {lnum}) String text for closed fold at {lnum} |
7 | 1837 foreground( ) Number bring the Vim window to the foreground |
55 | 1838 function( {name}) Funcref reference to function {name} |
3224 | 1839 garbagecollect( [{atexit}]) none free memory, breaking cyclic references |
82 | 1840 get( {list}, {idx} [, {def}]) any get item {idx} from {list} or {def} |
102 | 1841 get( {dict}, {key} [, {def}]) any get item {key} from {dict} or {def} |
435 | 1842 getbufline( {expr}, {lnum} [, {end}]) |
1843 List lines {lnum} to {end} of buffer {expr} | |
4157 | 1844 getbufvar( {expr}, {varname} [, {def}]) |
1845 any variable {varname} in buffer {expr} | |
55 | 1846 getchar( [expr]) Number get one character from the user |
1847 getcharmod( ) Number modifiers for the last typed character | |
7013 | 1848 getcharsearch() Dict last character search |
7 | 1849 getcmdline() String return the current command-line |
1850 getcmdpos() Number return cursor position in command-line | |
6153 | 1851 getcmdtype() String return current command-line type |
1852 getcmdwintype() String return current command-line window type | |
5944 | 1853 getcurpos() List position of the cursor |
7653
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
1854 getcwd( [{winnr} [, {tabnr}]]) String get the current working directory |
5944 | 1855 getfontname( [{name}]) String name of font being used |
20 | 1856 getfperm( {fname}) String file permissions of file {fname} |
1857 getfsize( {fname}) Number size in bytes of file {fname} | |
7 | 1858 getftime( {fname}) Number last modification time of file |
20 | 1859 getftype( {fname}) String description of type of file {fname} |
161 | 1860 getline( {lnum}) String line {lnum} of current buffer |
1861 getline( {lnum}, {end}) List lines {lnum} to {end} of current buffer | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
1862 getloclist( {nr}) List list of location list items |
1326 | 1863 getmatches() List list of current matches |
1548 | 1864 getpid() Number process ID of Vim |
703 | 1865 getpos( {expr}) List position of cursor, mark, etc. |
230 | 1866 getqflist() List list of quickfix items |
5796 | 1867 getreg( [{regname} [, 1 [, {list}]]]) |
1868 String or List contents of register | |
55 | 1869 getregtype( [{regname}]) String type of register |
4157 | 1870 gettabvar( {nr}, {varname} [, {def}]) |
1871 any variable {varname} in tab {nr} or {def} | |
1872 gettabwinvar( {tabnr}, {winnr}, {name} [, {def}]) | |
831 | 1873 any {name} in {winnr} in tab page {tabnr} |
7 | 1874 getwinposx() Number X coord in pixels of GUI Vim window |
1875 getwinposy() Number Y coord in pixels of GUI Vim window | |
4157 | 1876 getwinvar( {nr}, {varname} [, {def}]) |
1877 any variable {varname} in window {nr} | |
6663 | 1878 glob( {expr} [, {nosuf} [, {list} [, {alllinks}]]]) |
3398 | 1879 any expand file wildcards in {expr} |
6697 | 1880 glob2regpat( {expr}) String convert a glob pat into a search pat |
6663 | 1881 globpath( {path}, {expr} [, {nosuf} [, {list} [, {alllinks}]]]) |
1754 | 1882 String do glob({expr}) for all dirs in {path} |
7 | 1883 has( {feature}) Number TRUE if feature {feature} supported |
102 | 1884 has_key( {dict}, {key}) Number TRUE if {dict} has entry {key} |
7653
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
1885 haslocaldir( [{winnr} [, {tabnr}]]) |
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
1886 Number TRUE if the window executed |:lcd| |
782 | 1887 hasmapto( {what} [, {mode} [, {abbr}]]) |
1888 Number TRUE if mapping to {what} exists | |
7 | 1889 histadd( {history},{item}) String add an item to a history |
1890 histdel( {history} [, {item}]) String remove an item from a history | |
1891 histget( {history} [, {index}]) String get the item {index} from a history | |
1892 histnr( {history}) Number highest index of a history | |
1893 hlexists( {name}) Number TRUE if highlight group {name} exists | |
1894 hlID( {name}) Number syntax ID of highlight group {name} | |
1895 hostname() String name of the machine Vim is running on | |
55 | 1896 iconv( {expr}, {from}, {to}) String convert encoding of {expr} |
1897 indent( {lnum}) Number indent of line {lnum} | |
95 | 1898 index( {list}, {expr} [, {start} [, {ic}]]) |
1899 Number index in {list} where {expr} appears | |
531 | 1900 input( {prompt} [, {text} [, {completion}]]) |
1901 String get input from the user | |
7 | 1902 inputdialog( {p} [, {t} [, {c}]]) String like input() but in a GUI dialog |
824 | 1903 inputlist( {textlist}) Number let the user pick from a choice list |
55 | 1904 inputrestore() Number restore typeahead |
1905 inputsave() Number save and clear typeahead | |
7 | 1906 inputsecret( {prompt} [, {text}]) String like input() but hiding the text |
55 | 1907 insert( {list}, {item} [, {idx}]) List insert {item} in {list} [before {idx}] |
3214 | 1908 invert( {expr}) Number bitwise invert |
7 | 1909 isdirectory( {directory}) Number TRUE if {directory} is a directory |
148 | 1910 islocked( {expr}) Number TRUE if {expr} is locked |
685 | 1911 items( {dict}) List key-value pairs in {dict} |
95 | 1912 join( {list} [, {sep}]) String join {list} items into one String |
685 | 1913 keys( {dict}) List keys in {dict} |
55 | 1914 len( {expr}) Number the length of {expr} |
1915 libcall( {lib}, {func}, {arg}) String call {func} in library {lib} with {arg} | |
7 | 1916 libcallnr( {lib}, {func}, {arg}) Number idem, but return a Number |
1917 line( {expr}) Number line nr of cursor, last line or mark | |
1918 line2byte( {lnum}) Number byte count of line {lnum} | |
55 | 1919 lispindent( {lnum}) Number Lisp indent for line {lnum} |
7 | 1920 localtime() Number current time |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
1921 log( {expr}) Float natural logarithm (base e) of {expr} |
1621 | 1922 log10( {expr}) Float logarithm of Float {expr} to base 10 |
3492 | 1923 luaeval( {expr}[, {expr}]) any evaluate |Lua| expression |
102 | 1924 map( {expr}, {string}) List/Dict change each item in {expr} to {expr} |
2610 | 1925 maparg( {name}[, {mode} [, {abbr} [, {dict}]]]) |
3224 | 1926 String or Dict |
1927 rhs of mapping {name} in mode {mode} | |
782 | 1928 mapcheck( {name}[, {mode} [, {abbr}]]) |
1929 String check for mappings matching {name} | |
19 | 1930 match( {expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) |
7 | 1931 Number position where {pat} matches in {expr} |
1326 | 1932 matchadd( {group}, {pattern}[, {priority}[, {id}]]) |
1933 Number highlight {pattern} with {group} | |
5979 | 1934 matchaddpos( {group}, {list}[, {priority}[, {id}]]) |
1935 Number highlight positions with {group} | |
819 | 1936 matcharg( {nr}) List arguments of |:match| |
1326 | 1937 matchdelete( {id}) Number delete match identified by {id} |
19 | 1938 matchend( {expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) |
7 | 1939 Number position where {pat} ends in {expr} |
158 | 1940 matchlist( {expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) |
1941 List match and submatches of {pat} in {expr} | |
19 | 1942 matchstr( {expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) |
1943 String {count}'th match of {pat} in {expr} | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
1944 max( {list}) Number maximum value of items in {list} |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
1945 min( {list}) Number minimum value of items in {list} |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
1946 mkdir( {name} [, {path} [, {prot}]]) |
168 | 1947 Number create directory {name} |
1621 | 1948 mode( [expr]) String current editing mode |
2050
afcf9db31561
updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2033
diff
changeset
|
1949 mzeval( {expr}) any evaluate |MzScheme| expression |
7 | 1950 nextnonblank( {lnum}) Number line nr of non-blank line >= {lnum} |
4051 | 1951 nr2char( {expr}[, {utf8}]) String single char with ASCII/UTF8 value {expr} |
3214 | 1952 or( {expr}, {expr}) Number bitwise OR |
819 | 1953 pathshorten( {expr}) String shorten directory names in a path |
7651
c7575b07de98
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e9b892ebcd8596bf813793a1eed5a460a9495a28
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7629
diff
changeset
|
1954 perleval( {expr}) any evaluate |Perl| expression |
1621 | 1955 pow( {x}, {y}) Float {x} to the power of {y} |
7 | 1956 prevnonblank( {lnum}) Number line nr of non-blank line <= {lnum} |
1621 | 1957 printf( {fmt}, {expr1}...) String format text |
1958 pumvisible() Number whether popup menu is visible | |
3682 | 1959 pyeval( {expr}) any evaluate |Python| expression |
1960 py3eval( {expr}) any evaluate |python3| expression | |
99 | 1961 range( {expr} [, {max} [, {stride}]]) |
1962 List items from {expr} to {max} | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
1963 readfile( {fname} [, {binary} [, {max}]]) |
168 | 1964 List get list of lines from file {fname} |
794 | 1965 reltime( [{start} [, {end}]]) List get time value |
1966 reltimestr( {time}) String turn time value into a String | |
7 | 1967 remote_expr( {server}, {string} [, {idvar}]) |
1968 String send expression | |
1969 remote_foreground( {server}) Number bring Vim server to the foreground | |
1970 remote_peek( {serverid} [, {retvar}]) | |
1971 Number check for reply string | |
1972 remote_read( {serverid}) String read reply string | |
1973 remote_send( {server}, {string} [, {idvar}]) | |
1974 String send key sequence | |
79 | 1975 remove( {list}, {idx} [, {end}]) any remove items {idx}-{end} from {list} |
856 | 1976 remove( {dict}, {key}) any remove entry {key} from {dict} |
55 | 1977 rename( {from}, {to}) Number rename (move) file from {from} to {to} |
1978 repeat( {expr}, {count}) String repeat {expr} {count} times | |
1979 resolve( {filename}) String get filename a shortcut points to | |
82 | 1980 reverse( {list}) List reverse {list} in-place |
1621 | 1981 round( {expr}) Float round off {expr} |
4835
4db0bf9f1b44
updated for version 7.3.1164
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
1982 screenattr( {row}, {col}) Number attribute at screen position |
4db0bf9f1b44
updated for version 7.3.1164
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
1983 screenchar( {row}, {col}) Number character at screen position |
3986 | 1984 screencol() Number current cursor column |
1985 screenrow() Number current cursor row | |
1496 | 1986 search( {pattern} [, {flags} [, {stopline} [, {timeout}]]]) |
1987 Number search for {pattern} | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
1988 searchdecl( {name} [, {global} [, {thisblock}]]) |
1621 | 1989 Number search for variable declaration |
1496 | 1990 searchpair( {start}, {middle}, {end} [, {flags} [, {skip} [...]]]) |
55 | 1991 Number search for other end of start/end pair |
1496 | 1992 searchpairpos( {start}, {middle}, {end} [, {flags} [, {skip} [...]]]) |
667 | 1993 List search for other end of start/end pair |
1496 | 1994 searchpos( {pattern} [, {flags} [, {stopline} [, {timeout}]]]) |
667 | 1995 List search for {pattern} |
7 | 1996 server2client( {clientid}, {string}) |
1997 Number send reply string | |
1998 serverlist() String get a list of available servers | |
1999 setbufvar( {expr}, {varname}, {val}) set {varname} in buffer {expr} to {val} | |
6991 | 2000 setcharsearch( {dict}) Dict set character search from {dict} |
7 | 2001 setcmdpos( {pos}) Number set cursor position in command-line |
2002 setline( {lnum}, {line}) Number set line {lnum} to {line} | |
647 | 2003 setloclist( {nr}, {list}[, {action}]) |
2004 Number modify location list using {list} | |
1326 | 2005 setmatches( {list}) Number restore a list of matches |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
2006 setpos( {expr}, {list}) Number set the {expr} position to {list} |
647 | 2007 setqflist( {list}[, {action}]) Number modify quickfix list using {list} |
55 | 2008 setreg( {n}, {v}[, {opt}]) Number set register to value and type |
2207
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2206
diff
changeset
|
2009 settabvar( {nr}, {varname}, {val}) set {varname} in tab page {nr} to {val} |
831 | 2010 settabwinvar( {tabnr}, {winnr}, {varname}, {val}) set {varname} in window |
2011 {winnr} in tab page {tabnr} to {val} | |
7 | 2012 setwinvar( {nr}, {varname}, {val}) set {varname} in window {nr} to {val} |
4126 | 2013 sha256( {string}) String SHA256 checksum of {string} |
1661 | 2014 shellescape( {string} [, {special}]) |
2015 String escape {string} for use as shell | |
985 | 2016 command argument |
3875 | 2017 shiftwidth() Number effective value of 'shiftwidth' |
55 | 2018 simplify( {filename}) String simplify filename as much as possible |
1621 | 2019 sin( {expr}) Float sine of {expr} |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2020 sinh( {expr}) Float hyperbolic sine of {expr} |
2902 | 2021 sort( {list} [, {func} [, {dict}]]) |
2022 List sort {list}, using {func} to compare | |
374 | 2023 soundfold( {word}) String sound-fold {word} |
344 | 2024 spellbadword() String badly spelled word at cursor |
537 | 2025 spellsuggest( {word} [, {max} [, {capital}]]) |
2026 List spelling suggestions | |
282 | 2027 split( {expr} [, {pat} [, {keepempty}]]) |
685 | 2028 List make |List| from {pat} separated {expr} |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
2029 sqrt( {expr}) Float square root of {expr} |
1621 | 2030 str2float( {expr}) Float convert String to Float |
2031 str2nr( {expr} [, {base}]) Number convert String to Number | |
6870 | 2032 strchars( {expr} [, {skipcc}]) Number character length of the String {expr} |
2339
01e4b4d37842
Added strdisplaywidth() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2338
diff
changeset
|
2033 strdisplaywidth( {expr} [, {col}]) Number display length of the String {expr} |
7 | 2034 strftime( {format}[, {time}]) String time in specified format |
133 | 2035 stridx( {haystack}, {needle}[, {start}]) |
2036 Number index of {needle} in {haystack} | |
95 | 2037 string( {expr}) String String representation of {expr} value |
7 | 2038 strlen( {expr}) Number length of the String {expr} |
2039 strpart( {src}, {start}[, {len}]) | |
2040 String {len} characters of {src} at {start} | |
140 | 2041 strridx( {haystack}, {needle} [, {start}]) |
2042 Number last index of {needle} in {haystack} | |
7 | 2043 strtrans( {expr}) String translate string to make it printable |
2338
da6ec32d8d8f
Added strwidth() and strchars() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
2044 strwidth( {expr}) Number display cell length of the String {expr} |
5794 | 2045 submatch( {nr}[, {list}]) String or List |
2046 specific match in ":s" or substitute() | |
7 | 2047 substitute( {expr}, {pat}, {sub}, {flags}) |
2048 String all {pat} in {expr} replaced with {sub} | |
32 | 2049 synID( {lnum}, {col}, {trans}) Number syntax ID at {lnum} and {col} |
7 | 2050 synIDattr( {synID}, {what} [, {mode}]) |
2051 String attribute {what} of syntax ID {synID} | |
2052 synIDtrans( {synID}) Number translated syntax ID of {synID} | |
2608
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
2053 synconcealed( {lnum}, {col}) List info about concealing |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
2054 synstack( {lnum}, {col}) List stack of syntax IDs at {lnum} and {col} |
24 | 2055 system( {expr} [, {input}]) String output of shell command/filter {expr} |
5808 | 2056 systemlist( {expr} [, {input}]) List output of shell command/filter {expr} |
677 | 2057 tabpagebuflist( [{arg}]) List list of buffer numbers in tab page |
2058 tabpagenr( [{arg}]) Number number of current or last tab page | |
2059 tabpagewinnr( {tabarg}[, {arg}]) | |
2060 Number number of current window in tab page | |
2061 taglist( {expr}) List list of tags matching {expr} | |
1621 | 2062 tagfiles() List tags files used |
7 | 2063 tempname() String name for a temporary file |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2064 tan( {expr}) Float tangent of {expr} |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2065 tanh( {expr}) Float hyperbolic tangent of {expr} |
7 | 2066 tolower( {expr}) String the String {expr} switched to lowercase |
2067 toupper( {expr}) String the String {expr} switched to uppercase | |
15 | 2068 tr( {src}, {fromstr}, {tostr}) String translate chars of {src} in {fromstr} |
2069 to chars in {tostr} | |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
2070 trunc( {expr}) Float truncate Float {expr} |
7 | 2071 type( {name}) Number type of variable {name} |
2236
dc2e5ec0500d
Added the undofile() function. Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2226
diff
changeset
|
2072 undofile( {name}) String undo file name for {name} |
2280
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
2073 undotree() List undo file tree |
5747 | 2074 uniq( {list} [, {func} [, {dict}]]) |
2075 List remove adjacent duplicates from a list | |
685 | 2076 values( {dict}) List values in {dict} |
7 | 2077 virtcol( {expr}) Number screen column of cursor or mark |
2078 visualmode( [expr]) String last visual mode used | |
4151 | 2079 wildmenumode() Number whether 'wildmenu' mode is active |
7 | 2080 winbufnr( {nr}) Number buffer number of window {nr} |
2081 wincol() Number window column of the cursor | |
2082 winheight( {nr}) Number height of window {nr} | |
2083 winline() Number window line of the cursor | |
674 | 2084 winnr( [{expr}]) Number number of current window |
55 | 2085 winrestcmd() String returns command to restore window sizes |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
2086 winrestview( {dict}) none restore view of current window |
712 | 2087 winsaveview() Dict save view of current window |
7 | 2088 winwidth( {nr}) Number width of window {nr} |
7480
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
2089 wordcount() Dict get byte/char/word statistics |
6341 | 2090 writefile( {list}, {fname} [, {flags}]) |
158 | 2091 Number write list of lines to file {fname} |
3214 | 2092 xor( {expr}, {expr}) Number bitwise XOR |
7 | 2093 |
1621 | 2094 abs({expr}) *abs()* |
2095 Return the absolute value of {expr}. When {expr} evaluates to | |
2096 a |Float| abs() returns a |Float|. When {expr} can be | |
2097 converted to a |Number| abs() returns a |Number|. Otherwise | |
2098 abs() gives an error message and returns -1. | |
2099 Examples: > | |
2100 echo abs(1.456) | |
2101 < 1.456 > | |
2102 echo abs(-5.456) | |
2103 < 5.456 > | |
2104 echo abs(-4) | |
2105 < 4 | |
2106 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} | |
2107 | |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2108 |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2109 acos({expr}) *acos()* |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2110 Return the arc cosine of {expr} measured in radians, as a |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
2111 |Float| in the range of [0, pi]. |
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
2112 {expr} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number| in the range |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2113 [-1, 1]. |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2114 Examples: > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2115 :echo acos(0) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2116 < 1.570796 > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2117 :echo acos(-0.5) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2118 < 2.094395 |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2569
diff
changeset
|
2119 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2120 |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2121 |
82 | 2122 add({list}, {expr}) *add()* |
685 | 2123 Append the item {expr} to |List| {list}. Returns the |
2124 resulting |List|. Examples: > | |
82 | 2125 :let alist = add([1, 2, 3], item) |
2126 :call add(mylist, "woodstock") | |
685 | 2127 < Note that when {expr} is a |List| it is appended as a single |
692 | 2128 item. Use |extend()| to concatenate |Lists|. |
85 | 2129 Use |insert()| to add an item at another position. |
55 | 2130 |
82 | 2131 |
7513
37e061ec063c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/75bdf6aa30a5c99d67c42886cf7a4a000bbaa422
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7480
diff
changeset
|
2132 alloc_fail({id}, {countdown}, {repeat}) *alloc_fail()* |
37e061ec063c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/75bdf6aa30a5c99d67c42886cf7a4a000bbaa422
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7480
diff
changeset
|
2133 This is for testing: If the memory allocation with {id} is |
37e061ec063c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/75bdf6aa30a5c99d67c42886cf7a4a000bbaa422
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7480
diff
changeset
|
2134 called, then decrement {countdown}, and when it reaches zero |
37e061ec063c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/75bdf6aa30a5c99d67c42886cf7a4a000bbaa422
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7480
diff
changeset
|
2135 let memory allocation fail {repeat} times. When {repeat} is |
37e061ec063c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/75bdf6aa30a5c99d67c42886cf7a4a000bbaa422
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7480
diff
changeset
|
2136 smaller than one it fails one time. |
37e061ec063c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/75bdf6aa30a5c99d67c42886cf7a4a000bbaa422
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7480
diff
changeset
|
2137 |
37e061ec063c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/75bdf6aa30a5c99d67c42886cf7a4a000bbaa422
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7480
diff
changeset
|
2138 |
3214 | 2139 and({expr}, {expr}) *and()* |
2140 Bitwise AND on the two arguments. The arguments are converted | |
2141 to a number. A List, Dict or Float argument causes an error. | |
2142 Example: > | |
2143 :let flag = and(bits, 0x80) | |
2144 | |
2145 | |
82 | 2146 append({lnum}, {expr}) *append()* |
685 | 2147 When {expr} is a |List|: Append each item of the |List| as a |
2148 text line below line {lnum} in the current buffer. | |
153 | 2149 Otherwise append {expr} as one text line below line {lnum} in |
2150 the current buffer. | |
2151 {lnum} can be zero to insert a line before the first one. | |
82 | 2152 Returns 1 for failure ({lnum} out of range or out of memory), |
1621 | 2153 0 for success. Example: > |
55 | 2154 :let failed = append(line('$'), "# THE END") |
82 | 2155 :let failed = append(0, ["Chapter 1", "the beginning"]) |
55 | 2156 < |
7 | 2157 *argc()* |
2158 argc() The result is the number of files in the argument list of the | |
2159 current window. See |arglist|. | |
2160 | |
2161 *argidx()* | |
2162 argidx() The result is the current index in the argument list. 0 is | |
2163 the first file. argc() - 1 is the last one. See |arglist|. | |
2164 | |
5942 | 2165 *arglistid()* |
2166 arglistid([{winnr}, [ {tabnr} ]]) | |
2167 Return the argument list ID. This is a number which | |
2168 identifies the argument list being used. Zero is used for the | |
6153 | 2169 global argument list. See |arglist|. |
2170 Return -1 if the arguments are invalid. | |
5942 | 2171 |
2172 Without arguments use the current window. | |
2173 With {winnr} only use this window in the current tab page. | |
2174 With {winnr} and {tabnr} use the window in the specified tab | |
2175 page. | |
2176 | |
7 | 2177 *argv()* |
818 | 2178 argv([{nr}]) The result is the {nr}th file in the argument list of the |
7 | 2179 current window. See |arglist|. "argv(0)" is the first one. |
2180 Example: > | |
2181 :let i = 0 | |
2182 :while i < argc() | |
1621 | 2183 : let f = escape(fnameescape(argv(i)), '.') |
7 | 2184 : exe 'amenu Arg.' . f . ' :e ' . f . '<CR>' |
2185 : let i = i + 1 | |
2186 :endwhile | |
818 | 2187 < Without the {nr} argument a |List| with the whole |arglist| is |
2188 returned. | |
2189 | |
7279
b5e9810b389d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/683fa185a4b4ed7595e5942901548b8239ed5cdb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7277
diff
changeset
|
2190 *assert_equal()* |
7584
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2191 assert_equal({expected}, {actual} [, {msg}]) |
7277
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
2192 When {expected} and {actual} are not equal an error message is |
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
2193 added to |v:errors|. |
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
2194 There is no automatic conversion, the String "4" is different |
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
2195 from the Number 4. And the number 4 is different from the |
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
2196 Float 4.0. The value of 'ignorecase' is not used here, case |
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
2197 always matters. |
7279
b5e9810b389d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/683fa185a4b4ed7595e5942901548b8239ed5cdb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7277
diff
changeset
|
2198 When {msg} is omitted an error in the form "Expected |
b5e9810b389d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/683fa185a4b4ed7595e5942901548b8239ed5cdb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7277
diff
changeset
|
2199 {expected} but got {actual}" is produced. |
7277
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
2200 Example: > |
7279
b5e9810b389d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/683fa185a4b4ed7595e5942901548b8239ed5cdb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7277
diff
changeset
|
2201 assert_equal('foo', 'bar') |
7277
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
2202 < Will result in a string to be added to |v:errors|: |
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
2203 test.vim line 12: Expected 'foo' but got 'bar' ~ |
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
2204 |
7584
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2205 assert_exception({error} [, {msg}]) *assert_exception()* |
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2206 When v:exception does not contain the string {error} an error |
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2207 message is added to |v:errors|. |
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2208 This can be used to assert that a command throws an exception. |
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2209 Using the error number, followed by a colon, avoids problems |
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2210 with translations: > |
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2211 try |
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2212 commandthatfails |
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2213 call assert_false(1, 'command should have failed') |
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2214 catch |
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2215 call assert_exception('E492:') |
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2216 endtry |
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2217 |
7593
87e607fb6853
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a260b87d9da17f605666630f18c1ed909c2b8bae
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7584
diff
changeset
|
2218 assert_fails({cmd} [, {error}]) *assert_fails()* |
87e607fb6853
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a260b87d9da17f605666630f18c1ed909c2b8bae
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7584
diff
changeset
|
2219 Run {cmd} and add an error message to |v:errors| if it does |
87e607fb6853
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a260b87d9da17f605666630f18c1ed909c2b8bae
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7584
diff
changeset
|
2220 NOT produce an error. |
87e607fb6853
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a260b87d9da17f605666630f18c1ed909c2b8bae
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7584
diff
changeset
|
2221 When {error} is given it must match |v:errmsg|. |
87e607fb6853
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a260b87d9da17f605666630f18c1ed909c2b8bae
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7584
diff
changeset
|
2222 |
7584
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2223 assert_false({actual} [, {msg}]) *assert_false()* |
7277
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
2224 When {actual} is not false an error message is added to |
7584
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2225 |v:errors|, like with |assert_equal()|. |
7277
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
2226 A value is false when it is zero. When "{actual}" is not a |
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
2227 number the assert fails. |
7279
b5e9810b389d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/683fa185a4b4ed7595e5942901548b8239ed5cdb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7277
diff
changeset
|
2228 When {msg} is omitted an error in the form "Expected False but |
b5e9810b389d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/683fa185a4b4ed7595e5942901548b8239ed5cdb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7277
diff
changeset
|
2229 got {actual}" is produced. |
b5e9810b389d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/683fa185a4b4ed7595e5942901548b8239ed5cdb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7277
diff
changeset
|
2230 |
7584
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2231 assert_true({actual} [, {msg}]) *assert_true()* |
7277
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
2232 When {actual} is not true an error message is added to |
7584
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2233 |v:errors|, like with |assert_equal()|. |
9b7de205336d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/a803c7f94070f94b831fdfd1984f288c8b825b5d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7557
diff
changeset
|
2234 A value is true when it is a non-zero number. When {actual} |
7277
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
2235 is not a number the assert fails. |
7279
b5e9810b389d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/683fa185a4b4ed7595e5942901548b8239ed5cdb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7277
diff
changeset
|
2236 When {msg} is omitted an error in the form "Expected True but |
b5e9810b389d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/683fa185a4b4ed7595e5942901548b8239ed5cdb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7277
diff
changeset
|
2237 got {actual}" is produced. |
7277
6600871bb38c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43345546ae63710441f066648b8485fb545b3801
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
2238 |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2239 asin({expr}) *asin()* |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
2240 Return the arc sine of {expr} measured in radians, as a |Float| |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2241 in the range of [-pi/2, pi/2]. |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
2242 {expr} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number| in the range |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2243 [-1, 1]. |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2244 Examples: > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2245 :echo asin(0.8) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2246 < 0.927295 > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2247 :echo asin(-0.5) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2248 < -0.523599 |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2569
diff
changeset
|
2249 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2250 |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2251 |
1621 | 2252 atan({expr}) *atan()* |
2253 Return the principal value of the arc tangent of {expr}, in | |
2254 the range [-pi/2, +pi/2] radians, as a |Float|. | |
2255 {expr} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number|. | |
2256 Examples: > | |
2257 :echo atan(100) | |
2258 < 1.560797 > | |
2259 :echo atan(-4.01) | |
2260 < -1.326405 | |
2261 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} | |
2262 | |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2263 |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2264 atan2({expr1}, {expr2}) *atan2()* |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2265 Return the arc tangent of {expr1} / {expr2}, measured in |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
2266 radians, as a |Float| in the range [-pi, pi]. |
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
2267 {expr1} and {expr2} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number|. |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2268 Examples: > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2269 :echo atan2(-1, 1) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2270 < -0.785398 > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2271 :echo atan2(1, -1) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2272 < 2.356194 |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2569
diff
changeset
|
2273 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2274 |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2275 |
7 | 2276 *browse()* |
2277 browse({save}, {title}, {initdir}, {default}) | |
2278 Put up a file requester. This only works when "has("browse")" | |
2279 returns non-zero (only in some GUI versions). | |
2280 The input fields are: | |
2281 {save} when non-zero, select file to write | |
2282 {title} title for the requester | |
2283 {initdir} directory to start browsing in | |
2284 {default} default file name | |
2285 When the "Cancel" button is hit, something went wrong, or | |
2286 browsing is not possible, an empty string is returned. | |
2287 | |
29 | 2288 *browsedir()* |
2289 browsedir({title}, {initdir}) | |
2290 Put up a directory requester. This only works when | |
2291 "has("browse")" returns non-zero (only in some GUI versions). | |
2292 On systems where a directory browser is not supported a file | |
2293 browser is used. In that case: select a file in the directory | |
2294 to be used. | |
2295 The input fields are: | |
2296 {title} title for the requester | |
2297 {initdir} directory to start browsing in | |
2298 When the "Cancel" button is hit, something went wrong, or | |
2299 browsing is not possible, an empty string is returned. | |
2300 | |
7 | 2301 bufexists({expr}) *bufexists()* |
2302 The result is a Number, which is non-zero if a buffer called | |
2303 {expr} exists. | |
9 | 2304 If the {expr} argument is a number, buffer numbers are used. |
7 | 2305 If the {expr} argument is a string it must match a buffer name |
9 | 2306 exactly. The name can be: |
2307 - Relative to the current directory. | |
2308 - A full path. | |
1621 | 2309 - The name of a buffer with 'buftype' set to "nofile". |
9 | 2310 - A URL name. |
7 | 2311 Unlisted buffers will be found. |
2312 Note that help files are listed by their short name in the | |
2313 output of |:buffers|, but bufexists() requires using their | |
2314 long name to be able to find them. | |
1621 | 2315 bufexists() may report a buffer exists, but to use the name |
2316 with a |:buffer| command you may need to use |expand()|. Esp | |
2317 for MS-Windows 8.3 names in the form "c:\DOCUME~1" | |
7 | 2318 Use "bufexists(0)" to test for the existence of an alternate |
2319 file name. | |
2320 *buffer_exists()* | |
2321 Obsolete name: buffer_exists(). | |
2322 | |
2323 buflisted({expr}) *buflisted()* | |
2324 The result is a Number, which is non-zero if a buffer called | |
2325 {expr} exists and is listed (has the 'buflisted' option set). | |
9 | 2326 The {expr} argument is used like with |bufexists()|. |
7 | 2327 |
2328 bufloaded({expr}) *bufloaded()* | |
2329 The result is a Number, which is non-zero if a buffer called | |
2330 {expr} exists and is loaded (shown in a window or hidden). | |
9 | 2331 The {expr} argument is used like with |bufexists()|. |
7 | 2332 |
2333 bufname({expr}) *bufname()* | |
2334 The result is the name of a buffer, as it is displayed by the | |
2335 ":ls" command. | |
2336 If {expr} is a Number, that buffer number's name is given. | |
2337 Number zero is the alternate buffer for the current window. | |
2338 If {expr} is a String, it is used as a |file-pattern| to match | |
1621 | 2339 with the buffer names. This is always done like 'magic' is |
7 | 2340 set and 'cpoptions' is empty. When there is more than one |
2341 match an empty string is returned. | |
2342 "" or "%" can be used for the current buffer, "#" for the | |
2343 alternate buffer. | |
2344 A full match is preferred, otherwise a match at the start, end | |
1156 | 2345 or middle of the buffer name is accepted. If you only want a |
2346 full match then put "^" at the start and "$" at the end of the | |
2347 pattern. | |
7 | 2348 Listed buffers are found first. If there is a single match |
2349 with a listed buffer, that one is returned. Next unlisted | |
2350 buffers are searched for. | |
2351 If the {expr} is a String, but you want to use it as a buffer | |
2352 number, force it to be a Number by adding zero to it: > | |
2353 :echo bufname("3" + 0) | |
2354 < If the buffer doesn't exist, or doesn't have a name, an empty | |
2355 string is returned. > | |
2356 bufname("#") alternate buffer name | |
2357 bufname(3) name of buffer 3 | |
2358 bufname("%") name of current buffer | |
2359 bufname("file2") name of buffer where "file2" matches. | |
2360 < *buffer_name()* | |
2361 Obsolete name: buffer_name(). | |
2362 | |
2363 *bufnr()* | |
707 | 2364 bufnr({expr} [, {create}]) |
2365 The result is the number of a buffer, as it is displayed by | |
7 | 2366 the ":ls" command. For the use of {expr}, see |bufname()| |
707 | 2367 above. |
2368 If the buffer doesn't exist, -1 is returned. Or, if the | |
2369 {create} argument is present and not zero, a new, unlisted, | |
2370 buffer is created and its number is returned. | |
7 | 2371 bufnr("$") is the last buffer: > |
2372 :let last_buffer = bufnr("$") | |
2373 < The result is a Number, which is the highest buffer number | |
2374 of existing buffers. Note that not all buffers with a smaller | |
2375 number necessarily exist, because ":bwipeout" may have removed | |
2376 them. Use bufexists() to test for the existence of a buffer. | |
2377 *buffer_number()* | |
2378 Obsolete name: buffer_number(). | |
2379 *last_buffer_nr()* | |
2380 Obsolete name for bufnr("$"): last_buffer_nr(). | |
2381 | |
2382 bufwinnr({expr}) *bufwinnr()* | |
2383 The result is a Number, which is the number of the first | |
2384 window associated with buffer {expr}. For the use of {expr}, | |
1621 | 2385 see |bufname()| above. If buffer {expr} doesn't exist or |
7 | 2386 there is no such window, -1 is returned. Example: > |
2387 | |
2388 echo "A window containing buffer 1 is " . (bufwinnr(1)) | |
2389 | |
2390 < The number can be used with |CTRL-W_w| and ":wincmd w" | |
2391 |:wincmd|. | |
1156 | 2392 Only deals with the current tab page. |
7 | 2393 |
2394 | |
2395 byte2line({byte}) *byte2line()* | |
2396 Return the line number that contains the character at byte | |
2397 count {byte} in the current buffer. This includes the | |
2398 end-of-line character, depending on the 'fileformat' option | |
2399 for the current buffer. The first character has byte count | |
2400 one. | |
2401 Also see |line2byte()|, |go| and |:goto|. | |
2402 {not available when compiled without the |+byte_offset| | |
2403 feature} | |
2404 | |
18 | 2405 byteidx({expr}, {nr}) *byteidx()* |
2406 Return byte index of the {nr}'th character in the string | |
2407 {expr}. Use zero for the first character, it returns zero. | |
2408 This function is only useful when there are multibyte | |
2409 characters, otherwise the returned value is equal to {nr}. | |
5413 | 2410 Composing characters are not counted separately, their byte |
2411 length is added to the preceding base character. See | |
2412 |byteidxcomp()| below for counting composing characters | |
2413 separately. | |
18 | 2414 Example : > |
2415 echo matchstr(str, ".", byteidx(str, 3)) | |
2416 < will display the fourth character. Another way to do the | |
2417 same: > | |
2418 let s = strpart(str, byteidx(str, 3)) | |
2419 echo strpart(s, 0, byteidx(s, 1)) | |
2420 < If there are less than {nr} characters -1 is returned. | |
2421 If there are exactly {nr} characters the length of the string | |
5413 | 2422 in bytes is returned. |
2423 | |
2424 byteidxcomp({expr}, {nr}) *byteidxcomp()* | |
2425 Like byteidx(), except that a composing character is counted | |
2426 as a separate character. Example: > | |
2427 let s = 'e' . nr2char(0x301) | |
2428 echo byteidx(s, 1) | |
2429 echo byteidxcomp(s, 1) | |
2430 echo byteidxcomp(s, 2) | |
2431 < The first and third echo result in 3 ('e' plus composing | |
2432 character is 3 bytes), the second echo results in 1 ('e' is | |
2433 one byte). | |
2434 Only works different from byteidx() when 'encoding' is set to | |
2435 a Unicode encoding. | |
18 | 2436 |
102 | 2437 call({func}, {arglist} [, {dict}]) *call()* *E699* |
685 | 2438 Call function {func} with the items in |List| {arglist} as |
79 | 2439 arguments. |
685 | 2440 {func} can either be a |Funcref| or the name of a function. |
79 | 2441 a:firstline and a:lastline are set to the cursor line. |
2442 Returns the return value of the called function. | |
102 | 2443 {dict} is for functions with the "dict" attribute. It will be |
2444 used to set the local variable "self". |Dictionary-function| | |
79 | 2445 |
1621 | 2446 ceil({expr}) *ceil()* |
2447 Return the smallest integral value greater than or equal to | |
2448 {expr} as a |Float| (round up). | |
2449 {expr} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number|. | |
2450 Examples: > | |
2451 echo ceil(1.456) | |
2452 < 2.0 > | |
2453 echo ceil(-5.456) | |
2454 < -5.0 > | |
2455 echo ceil(4.0) | |
2456 < 4.0 | |
2457 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} | |
2458 | |
777 | 2459 changenr() *changenr()* |
2460 Return the number of the most recent change. This is the same | |
2461 number as what is displayed with |:undolist| and can be used | |
2462 with the |:undo| command. | |
2463 When a change was made it is the number of that change. After | |
2464 redo it is the number of the redone change. After undo it is | |
2465 one less than the number of the undone change. | |
2466 | |
4051 | 2467 char2nr({expr}[, {utf8}]) *char2nr()* |
7 | 2468 Return number value of the first char in {expr}. Examples: > |
2469 char2nr(" ") returns 32 | |
2470 char2nr("ABC") returns 65 | |
4051 | 2471 < When {utf8} is omitted or zero, the current 'encoding' is used. |
2472 Example for "utf-8": > | |
1156 | 2473 char2nr("á") returns 225 |
2474 char2nr("á"[0]) returns 195 | |
4051 | 2475 < With {utf8} set to 1, always treat as utf-8 characters. |
2476 A combining character is a separate character. | |
2965 | 2477 |nr2char()| does the opposite. |
7 | 2478 |
2479 cindent({lnum}) *cindent()* | |
2480 Get the amount of indent for line {lnum} according the C | |
2481 indenting rules, as with 'cindent'. | |
2482 The indent is counted in spaces, the value of 'tabstop' is | |
2483 relevant. {lnum} is used just like in |getline()|. | |
2484 When {lnum} is invalid or Vim was not compiled the |+cindent| | |
2485 feature, -1 is returned. | |
548 | 2486 See |C-indenting|. |
7 | 2487 |
1326 | 2488 clearmatches() *clearmatches()* |
2489 Clears all matches previously defined by |matchadd()| and the | |
2490 |:match| commands. | |
2491 | |
7 | 2492 *col()* |
24 | 2493 col({expr}) The result is a Number, which is the byte index of the column |
7 | 2494 position given with {expr}. The accepted positions are: |
2495 . the cursor position | |
2496 $ the end of the cursor line (the result is the | |
3513 | 2497 number of bytes in the cursor line plus one) |
7 | 2498 'x position of mark x (if the mark is not set, 0 is |
2499 returned) | |
6447 | 2500 v In Visual mode: the start of the Visual area (the |
2501 cursor is the end). When not in Visual mode | |
2502 returns the cursor position. Differs from |'<| in | |
2503 that it's updated right away. | |
1317 | 2504 Additionally {expr} can be [lnum, col]: a |List| with the line |
2505 and column number. Most useful when the column is "$", to get | |
1621 | 2506 the last column of a specific line. When "lnum" or "col" is |
1317 | 2507 out of range then col() returns zero. |
1156 | 2508 To get the line number use |line()|. To get both use |
703 | 2509 |getpos()|. |
7 | 2510 For the screen column position use |virtcol()|. |
2511 Note that only marks in the current file can be used. | |
2512 Examples: > | |
2513 col(".") column of cursor | |
2514 col("$") length of cursor line plus one | |
2515 col("'t") column of mark t | |
2516 col("'" . markname) column of mark markname | |
1621 | 2517 < The first column is 1. 0 is returned for an error. |
1156 | 2518 For an uppercase mark the column may actually be in another |
2519 buffer. | |
7 | 2520 For the cursor position, when 'virtualedit' is active, the |
2521 column is one higher if the cursor is after the end of the | |
2522 line. This can be used to obtain the column in Insert mode: > | |
2523 :imap <F2> <C-O>:let save_ve = &ve<CR> | |
2524 \<C-O>:set ve=all<CR> | |
2525 \<C-O>:echo col(".") . "\n" <Bar> | |
2526 \let &ve = save_ve<CR> | |
2527 < | |
464 | 2528 |
724 | 2529 complete({startcol}, {matches}) *complete()* *E785* |
2530 Set the matches for Insert mode completion. | |
2531 Can only be used in Insert mode. You need to use a mapping | |
1156 | 2532 with CTRL-R = |i_CTRL-R|. It does not work after CTRL-O or |
2533 with an expression mapping. | |
724 | 2534 {startcol} is the byte offset in the line where the completed |
2535 text start. The text up to the cursor is the original text | |
2536 that will be replaced by the matches. Use col('.') for an | |
2537 empty string. "col('.') - 1" will replace one character by a | |
2538 match. | |
2539 {matches} must be a |List|. Each |List| item is one match. | |
2540 See |complete-items| for the kind of items that are possible. | |
2541 Note that the after calling this function you need to avoid | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
2542 inserting anything that would cause completion to stop. |
724 | 2543 The match can be selected with CTRL-N and CTRL-P as usual with |
2544 Insert mode completion. The popup menu will appear if | |
2545 specified, see |ins-completion-menu|. | |
2546 Example: > | |
1156 | 2547 inoremap <F5> <C-R>=ListMonths()<CR> |
724 | 2548 |
2549 func! ListMonths() | |
2550 call complete(col('.'), ['January', 'February', 'March', | |
2551 \ 'April', 'May', 'June', 'July', 'August', 'September', | |
2552 \ 'October', 'November', 'December']) | |
2553 return '' | |
2554 endfunc | |
2555 < This isn't very useful, but it shows how it works. Note that | |
2556 an empty string is returned to avoid a zero being inserted. | |
2557 | |
464 | 2558 complete_add({expr}) *complete_add()* |
2559 Add {expr} to the list of matches. Only to be used by the | |
2560 function specified with the 'completefunc' option. | |
2561 Returns 0 for failure (empty string or out of memory), | |
2562 1 when the match was added, 2 when the match was already in | |
2563 the list. | |
1621 | 2564 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of {expr}. It is |
786 | 2565 the same as one item in the list that 'omnifunc' would return. |
464 | 2566 |
2567 complete_check() *complete_check()* | |
2568 Check for a key typed while looking for completion matches. | |
2569 This is to be used when looking for matches takes some time. | |
2570 Returns non-zero when searching for matches is to be aborted, | |
2571 zero otherwise. | |
2572 Only to be used by the function specified with the | |
2573 'completefunc' option. | |
2574 | |
7 | 2575 *confirm()* |
2576 confirm({msg} [, {choices} [, {default} [, {type}]]]) | |
2577 Confirm() offers the user a dialog, from which a choice can be | |
2578 made. It returns the number of the choice. For the first | |
2579 choice this is 1. | |
2580 Note: confirm() is only supported when compiled with dialog | |
2581 support, see |+dialog_con| and |+dialog_gui|. | |
2280
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
2582 |
7 | 2583 {msg} is displayed in a |dialog| with {choices} as the |
2584 alternatives. When {choices} is missing or empty, "&OK" is | |
2585 used (and translated). | |
2586 {msg} is a String, use '\n' to include a newline. Only on | |
2587 some systems the string is wrapped when it doesn't fit. | |
2280
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
2588 |
7 | 2589 {choices} is a String, with the individual choices separated |
2590 by '\n', e.g. > | |
2591 confirm("Save changes?", "&Yes\n&No\n&Cancel") | |
2592 < The letter after the '&' is the shortcut key for that choice. | |
2593 Thus you can type 'c' to select "Cancel". The shortcut does | |
2594 not need to be the first letter: > | |
2595 confirm("file has been modified", "&Save\nSave &All") | |
2596 < For the console, the first letter of each choice is used as | |
2597 the default shortcut key. | |
2280
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
2598 |
7 | 2599 The optional {default} argument is the number of the choice |
2600 that is made if the user hits <CR>. Use 1 to make the first | |
2601 choice the default one. Use 0 to not set a default. If | |
2602 {default} is omitted, 1 is used. | |
2280
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
2603 |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
2604 The optional {type} argument gives the type of dialog. This |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
2605 is only used for the icon of the GTK, Mac, Motif and Win32 |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
2606 GUI. It can be one of these values: "Error", "Question", |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
2607 "Info", "Warning" or "Generic". Only the first character is |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
2608 relevant. When {type} is omitted, "Generic" is used. |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
2609 |
7 | 2610 If the user aborts the dialog by pressing <Esc>, CTRL-C, |
2611 or another valid interrupt key, confirm() returns 0. | |
2612 | |
2613 An example: > | |
2614 :let choice = confirm("What do you want?", "&Apples\n&Oranges\n&Bananas", 2) | |
2615 :if choice == 0 | |
2616 : echo "make up your mind!" | |
2617 :elseif choice == 3 | |
2618 : echo "tasteful" | |
2619 :else | |
2620 : echo "I prefer bananas myself." | |
2621 :endif | |
2622 < In a GUI dialog, buttons are used. The layout of the buttons | |
2623 depends on the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'. If it is included, | |
1621 | 2624 the buttons are always put vertically. Otherwise, confirm() |
7 | 2625 tries to put the buttons in one horizontal line. If they |
2626 don't fit, a vertical layout is used anyway. For some systems | |
2627 the horizontal layout is always used. | |
2628 | |
55 | 2629 *copy()* |
1621 | 2630 copy({expr}) Make a copy of {expr}. For Numbers and Strings this isn't |
55 | 2631 different from using {expr} directly. |
685 | 2632 When {expr} is a |List| a shallow copy is created. This means |
2633 that the original |List| can be changed without changing the | |
1621 | 2634 copy, and vice versa. But the items are identical, thus |
2635 changing an item changes the contents of both |Lists|. Also | |
685 | 2636 see |deepcopy()|. |
55 | 2637 |
1621 | 2638 cos({expr}) *cos()* |
2639 Return the cosine of {expr}, measured in radians, as a |Float|. | |
2640 {expr} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number|. | |
2641 Examples: > | |
2642 :echo cos(100) | |
2643 < 0.862319 > | |
2644 :echo cos(-4.01) | |
2645 < -0.646043 | |
2646 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} | |
2647 | |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2648 |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2649 cosh({expr}) *cosh()* |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
2650 Return the hyperbolic cosine of {expr} as a |Float| in the range |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2651 [1, inf]. |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
2652 {expr} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number|. |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2653 Examples: > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2654 :echo cosh(0.5) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2655 < 1.127626 > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2656 :echo cosh(-0.5) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2657 < -1.127626 |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2569
diff
changeset
|
2658 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2659 |
1621 | 2660 |
102 | 2661 count({comp}, {expr} [, {ic} [, {start}]]) *count()* |
79 | 2662 Return the number of times an item with value {expr} appears |
685 | 2663 in |List| or |Dictionary| {comp}. |
102 | 2664 If {start} is given then start with the item with this index. |
685 | 2665 {start} can only be used with a |List|. |
79 | 2666 When {ic} is given and it's non-zero then case is ignored. |
2667 | |
2668 | |
7 | 2669 *cscope_connection()* |
2670 cscope_connection([{num} , {dbpath} [, {prepend}]]) | |
2671 Checks for the existence of a |cscope| connection. If no | |
2672 parameters are specified, then the function returns: | |
2673 0, if cscope was not available (not compiled in), or | |
2674 if there are no cscope connections; | |
2675 1, if there is at least one cscope connection. | |
2676 | |
2677 If parameters are specified, then the value of {num} | |
2678 determines how existence of a cscope connection is checked: | |
2679 | |
2680 {num} Description of existence check | |
2681 ----- ------------------------------ | |
2682 0 Same as no parameters (e.g., "cscope_connection()"). | |
2683 1 Ignore {prepend}, and use partial string matches for | |
2684 {dbpath}. | |
2685 2 Ignore {prepend}, and use exact string matches for | |
2686 {dbpath}. | |
2687 3 Use {prepend}, use partial string matches for both | |
2688 {dbpath} and {prepend}. | |
2689 4 Use {prepend}, use exact string matches for both | |
2690 {dbpath} and {prepend}. | |
2691 | |
2692 Note: All string comparisons are case sensitive! | |
2693 | |
2694 Examples. Suppose we had the following (from ":cs show"): > | |
2695 | |
2696 # pid database name prepend path | |
2697 0 27664 cscope.out /usr/local | |
2698 < | |
2699 Invocation Return Val ~ | |
2700 ---------- ---------- > | |
2701 cscope_connection() 1 | |
2702 cscope_connection(1, "out") 1 | |
2703 cscope_connection(2, "out") 0 | |
2704 cscope_connection(3, "out") 0 | |
2705 cscope_connection(3, "out", "local") 1 | |
2706 cscope_connection(4, "out") 0 | |
2707 cscope_connection(4, "out", "local") 0 | |
2708 cscope_connection(4, "cscope.out", "/usr/local") 1 | |
2709 < | |
703 | 2710 cursor({lnum}, {col} [, {off}]) *cursor()* |
2711 cursor({list}) | |
1156 | 2712 Positions the cursor at the column (byte count) {col} in the |
2713 line {lnum}. The first column is one. | |
5938 | 2714 |
703 | 2715 When there is one argument {list} this is used as a |List| |
5938 | 2716 with two, three or four item: |
2717 [{lnum}, {col}, {off}] | |
2718 [{lnum}, {col}, {off}, {curswant}] | |
6009 | 2719 This is like the return value of |getpos()| or |getcurpos()|, |
5944 | 2720 but without the first item. |
5938 | 2721 |
7 | 2722 Does not change the jumplist. |
2723 If {lnum} is greater than the number of lines in the buffer, | |
2724 the cursor will be positioned at the last line in the buffer. | |
2725 If {lnum} is zero, the cursor will stay in the current line. | |
493 | 2726 If {col} is greater than the number of bytes in the line, |
7 | 2727 the cursor will be positioned at the last character in the |
2728 line. | |
2729 If {col} is zero, the cursor will stay in the current column. | |
5944 | 2730 If {curswant} is given it is used to set the preferred column |
6180 | 2731 for vertical movement. Otherwise {col} is used. |
6385 | 2732 |
703 | 2733 When 'virtualedit' is used {off} specifies the offset in |
2734 screen columns from the start of the character. E.g., a | |
1266 | 2735 position within a <Tab> or after the last character. |
1851 | 2736 Returns 0 when the position could be set, -1 otherwise. |
7 | 2737 |
55 | 2738 |
164 | 2739 deepcopy({expr}[, {noref}]) *deepcopy()* *E698* |
1621 | 2740 Make a copy of {expr}. For Numbers and Strings this isn't |
55 | 2741 different from using {expr} directly. |
685 | 2742 When {expr} is a |List| a full copy is created. This means |
2743 that the original |List| can be changed without changing the | |
1621 | 2744 copy, and vice versa. When an item is a |List|, a copy for it |
55 | 2745 is made, recursively. Thus changing an item in the copy does |
685 | 2746 not change the contents of the original |List|. |
2747 When {noref} is omitted or zero a contained |List| or | |
2748 |Dictionary| is only copied once. All references point to | |
2749 this single copy. With {noref} set to 1 every occurrence of a | |
2750 |List| or |Dictionary| results in a new copy. This also means | |
2751 that a cyclic reference causes deepcopy() to fail. | |
114 | 2752 *E724* |
2753 Nesting is possible up to 100 levels. When there is an item | |
164 | 2754 that refers back to a higher level making a deep copy with |
2755 {noref} set to 1 will fail. | |
55 | 2756 Also see |copy()|. |
2757 | |
7615
228ff048db20
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/da440d21a6b94d7f525fa7be9b1417c78dd9aa4c
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7597
diff
changeset
|
2758 delete({fname} [, {flags}]) *delete()* |
228ff048db20
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/da440d21a6b94d7f525fa7be9b1417c78dd9aa4c
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7597
diff
changeset
|
2759 Without {flags} or with {flags} empty: Deletes the file by the |
7629
befbed72da87
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43a34f9f74fdce462fa250baab620264c28b6165
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7615
diff
changeset
|
2760 name {fname}. This also works when {fname} is a symbolic link. |
7615
228ff048db20
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/da440d21a6b94d7f525fa7be9b1417c78dd9aa4c
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7597
diff
changeset
|
2761 |
228ff048db20
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/da440d21a6b94d7f525fa7be9b1417c78dd9aa4c
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7597
diff
changeset
|
2762 When {flags} is "d": Deletes the directory by the name |
7629
befbed72da87
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43a34f9f74fdce462fa250baab620264c28b6165
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7615
diff
changeset
|
2763 {fname}. This fails when directory {fname} is not empty. |
7615
228ff048db20
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/da440d21a6b94d7f525fa7be9b1417c78dd9aa4c
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7597
diff
changeset
|
2764 |
228ff048db20
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/da440d21a6b94d7f525fa7be9b1417c78dd9aa4c
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7597
diff
changeset
|
2765 When {flags} is "rf": Deletes the directory by the name |
7629
befbed72da87
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43a34f9f74fdce462fa250baab620264c28b6165
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7615
diff
changeset
|
2766 {fname} and everything in it, recursively. BE CAREFUL! |
befbed72da87
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/43a34f9f74fdce462fa250baab620264c28b6165
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7615
diff
changeset
|
2767 A symbolic link itself is deleted, not what it points to. |
7615
228ff048db20
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/da440d21a6b94d7f525fa7be9b1417c78dd9aa4c
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7597
diff
changeset
|
2768 |
228ff048db20
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/da440d21a6b94d7f525fa7be9b1417c78dd9aa4c
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7597
diff
changeset
|
2769 The result is a Number, which is 0 if the delete operation was |
228ff048db20
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/da440d21a6b94d7f525fa7be9b1417c78dd9aa4c
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7597
diff
changeset
|
2770 successful and -1 when the deletion failed or partly failed. |
228ff048db20
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/da440d21a6b94d7f525fa7be9b1417c78dd9aa4c
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7597
diff
changeset
|
2771 |
685 | 2772 Use |remove()| to delete an item from a |List|. |
4229 | 2773 To delete a line from the buffer use |:delete|. Use |:exe| |
2774 when the line number is in a variable. | |
7 | 2775 |
2776 *did_filetype()* | |
2777 did_filetype() Returns non-zero when autocommands are being executed and the | |
2778 FileType event has been triggered at least once. Can be used | |
2779 to avoid triggering the FileType event again in the scripts | |
2780 that detect the file type. |FileType| | |
2781 When editing another file, the counter is reset, thus this | |
2782 really checks if the FileType event has been triggered for the | |
2783 current buffer. This allows an autocommand that starts | |
2784 editing another buffer to set 'filetype' and load a syntax | |
2785 file. | |
2786 | |
32 | 2787 diff_filler({lnum}) *diff_filler()* |
2788 Returns the number of filler lines above line {lnum}. | |
2789 These are the lines that were inserted at this point in | |
2790 another diff'ed window. These filler lines are shown in the | |
2791 display but don't exist in the buffer. | |
2792 {lnum} is used like with |getline()|. Thus "." is the current | |
2793 line, "'m" mark m, etc. | |
2794 Returns 0 if the current window is not in diff mode. | |
2795 | |
2796 diff_hlID({lnum}, {col}) *diff_hlID()* | |
2797 Returns the highlight ID for diff mode at line {lnum} column | |
2798 {col} (byte index). When the current line does not have a | |
2799 diff change zero is returned. | |
2800 {lnum} is used like with |getline()|. Thus "." is the current | |
2801 line, "'m" mark m, etc. | |
2802 {col} is 1 for the leftmost column, {lnum} is 1 for the first | |
2803 line. | |
2804 The highlight ID can be used with |synIDattr()| to obtain | |
2805 syntax information about the highlighting. | |
2806 | |
85 | 2807 empty({expr}) *empty()* |
2808 Return the Number 1 if {expr} is empty, zero otherwise. | |
685 | 2809 A |List| or |Dictionary| is empty when it does not have any |
1621 | 2810 items. A Number is empty when its value is zero. |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
2811 For a long |List| this is much faster than comparing the |
685 | 2812 length with zero. |
85 | 2813 |
7 | 2814 escape({string}, {chars}) *escape()* |
2815 Escape the characters in {chars} that occur in {string} with a | |
2816 backslash. Example: > | |
2817 :echo escape('c:\program files\vim', ' \') | |
2818 < results in: > | |
2819 c:\\program\ files\\vim | |
1621 | 2820 < Also see |shellescape()|. |
2821 | |
2822 *eval()* | |
95 | 2823 eval({string}) Evaluate {string} and return the result. Especially useful to |
2824 turn the result of |string()| back into the original value. | |
1621 | 2825 This works for Numbers, Floats, Strings and composites of |
2826 them. Also works for |Funcref|s that refer to existing | |
2827 functions. | |
95 | 2828 |
7 | 2829 eventhandler() *eventhandler()* |
2830 Returns 1 when inside an event handler. That is that Vim got | |
2831 interrupted while waiting for the user to type a character, | |
2832 e.g., when dropping a file on Vim. This means interactive | |
2833 commands cannot be used. Otherwise zero is returned. | |
2834 | |
2835 executable({expr}) *executable()* | |
2836 This function checks if an executable with the name {expr} | |
2837 exists. {expr} must be the name of the program without any | |
10 | 2838 arguments. |
2839 executable() uses the value of $PATH and/or the normal | |
2840 searchpath for programs. *PATHEXT* | |
2841 On MS-DOS and MS-Windows the ".exe", ".bat", etc. can | |
2842 optionally be included. Then the extensions in $PATHEXT are | |
1621 | 2843 tried. Thus if "foo.exe" does not exist, "foo.exe.bat" can be |
2844 found. If $PATHEXT is not set then ".exe;.com;.bat;.cmd" is | |
10 | 2845 used. A dot by itself can be used in $PATHEXT to try using |
1621 | 2846 the name without an extension. When 'shell' looks like a |
10 | 2847 Unix shell, then the name is also tried without adding an |
2848 extension. | |
2849 On MS-DOS and MS-Windows it only checks if the file exists and | |
2850 is not a directory, not if it's really executable. | |
819 | 2851 On MS-Windows an executable in the same directory as Vim is |
2852 always found. Since this directory is added to $PATH it | |
2853 should also work to execute it |win32-PATH|. | |
7 | 2854 The result is a Number: |
2855 1 exists | |
2856 0 does not exist | |
2857 -1 not implemented on this system | |
2858 | |
5782 | 2859 exepath({expr}) *exepath()* |
2860 If {expr} is an executable and is either an absolute path, a | |
2861 relative path or found in $PATH, return the full path. | |
2862 Note that the current directory is used when {expr} starts | |
2863 with "./", which may be a problem for Vim: > | |
2864 echo exepath(v:progpath) | |
5814 | 2865 < If {expr} cannot be found in $PATH or is not executable then |
5782 | 2866 an empty string is returned. |
2867 | |
7 | 2868 *exists()* |
2869 exists({expr}) The result is a Number, which is non-zero if {expr} is | |
2870 defined, zero otherwise. The {expr} argument is a string, | |
2871 which contains one of these: | |
2872 &option-name Vim option (only checks if it exists, | |
2873 not if it really works) | |
2874 +option-name Vim option that works. | |
2875 $ENVNAME environment variable (could also be | |
2876 done by comparing with an empty | |
2877 string) | |
2878 *funcname built-in function (see |functions|) | |
2879 or user defined function (see | |
5862 | 2880 |user-functions|). Also works for a |
2881 variable that is a Funcref. | |
7 | 2882 varname internal variable (see |
1621 | 2883 |internal-variables|). Also works |
685 | 2884 for |curly-braces-names|, |Dictionary| |
2885 entries, |List| items, etc. Beware | |
1668 | 2886 that evaluating an index may cause an |
2887 error message for an invalid | |
2888 expression. E.g.: > | |
2889 :let l = [1, 2, 3] | |
2890 :echo exists("l[5]") | |
2891 < 0 > | |
2892 :echo exists("l[xx]") | |
2893 < E121: Undefined variable: xx | |
2894 0 | |
7 | 2895 :cmdname Ex command: built-in command, user |
2896 command or command modifier |:command|. | |
2897 Returns: | |
2898 1 for match with start of a command | |
2899 2 full match with a command | |
2900 3 matches several user commands | |
2901 To check for a supported command | |
2902 always check the return value to be 2. | |
864 | 2903 :2match The |:2match| command. |
2904 :3match The |:3match| command. | |
7 | 2905 #event autocommand defined for this event |
2906 #event#pattern autocommand defined for this event and | |
2907 pattern (the pattern is taken | |
2908 literally and compared to the | |
2909 autocommand patterns character by | |
2910 character) | |
613 | 2911 #group autocommand group exists |
2912 #group#event autocommand defined for this group and | |
2913 event. | |
2914 #group#event#pattern | |
856 | 2915 autocommand defined for this group, |
613 | 2916 event and pattern. |
615 | 2917 ##event autocommand for this event is |
2918 supported. | |
7 | 2919 For checking for a supported feature use |has()|. |
2920 | |
2921 Examples: > | |
2922 exists("&shortname") | |
2923 exists("$HOSTNAME") | |
2924 exists("*strftime") | |
2925 exists("*s:MyFunc") | |
2926 exists("bufcount") | |
2927 exists(":Make") | |
613 | 2928 exists("#CursorHold") |
7 | 2929 exists("#BufReadPre#*.gz") |
613 | 2930 exists("#filetypeindent") |
2931 exists("#filetypeindent#FileType") | |
2932 exists("#filetypeindent#FileType#*") | |
615 | 2933 exists("##ColorScheme") |
7 | 2934 < There must be no space between the symbol (&/$/*/#) and the |
2935 name. | |
867 | 2936 There must be no extra characters after the name, although in |
2937 a few cases this is ignored. That may become more strict in | |
2938 the future, thus don't count on it! | |
2939 Working example: > | |
2940 exists(":make") | |
2941 < NOT working example: > | |
2942 exists(":make install") | |
859 | 2943 |
2944 < Note that the argument must be a string, not the name of the | |
2945 variable itself. For example: > | |
7 | 2946 exists(bufcount) |
2947 < This doesn't check for existence of the "bufcount" variable, | |
853 | 2948 but gets the value of "bufcount", and checks if that exists. |
7 | 2949 |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2950 exp({expr}) *exp()* |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
2951 Return the exponential of {expr} as a |Float| in the range |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2952 [0, inf]. |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
2953 {expr} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number|. |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2954 Examples: > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2955 :echo exp(2) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2956 < 7.389056 > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2957 :echo exp(-1) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2958 < 0.367879 |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2569
diff
changeset
|
2959 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2960 |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2961 |
3410
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
2962 expand({expr} [, {nosuf} [, {list}]]) *expand()* |
7 | 2963 Expand wildcards and the following special keywords in {expr}. |
3410
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
2964 'wildignorecase' applies. |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
2965 |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
2966 If {list} is given and it is non-zero, a List will be returned. |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
2967 Otherwise the result is a String and when there are several |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
2968 matches, they are separated by <NL> characters. [Note: in |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
2969 version 5.0 a space was used, which caused problems when a |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
2970 file name contains a space] |
7 | 2971 |
1621 | 2972 If the expansion fails, the result is an empty string. A name |
4869 | 2973 for a non-existing file is not included, unless {expr} does |
2974 not start with '%', '#' or '<', see below. | |
7 | 2975 |
2976 When {expr} starts with '%', '#' or '<', the expansion is done | |
2977 like for the |cmdline-special| variables with their associated | |
2978 modifiers. Here is a short overview: | |
2979 | |
2980 % current file name | |
2981 # alternate file name | |
2982 #n alternate file name n | |
2983 <cfile> file name under the cursor | |
2984 <afile> autocmd file name | |
2985 <abuf> autocmd buffer number (as a String!) | |
2986 <amatch> autocmd matched name | |
5734 | 2987 <sfile> sourced script file or function name |
2662 | 2988 <slnum> sourced script file line number |
7 | 2989 <cword> word under the cursor |
2990 <cWORD> WORD under the cursor | |
2991 <client> the {clientid} of the last received | |
2992 message |server2client()| | |
2993 Modifiers: | |
2994 :p expand to full path | |
2995 :h head (last path component removed) | |
2996 :t tail (last path component only) | |
2997 :r root (one extension removed) | |
2998 :e extension only | |
2999 | |
3000 Example: > | |
3001 :let &tags = expand("%:p:h") . "/tags" | |
3002 < Note that when expanding a string that starts with '%', '#' or | |
3003 '<', any following text is ignored. This does NOT work: > | |
3004 :let doesntwork = expand("%:h.bak") | |
3005 < Use this: > | |
3006 :let doeswork = expand("%:h") . ".bak" | |
3007 < Also note that expanding "<cfile>" and others only returns the | |
3008 referenced file name without further expansion. If "<cfile>" | |
3009 is "~/.cshrc", you need to do another expand() to have the | |
3010 "~/" expanded into the path of the home directory: > | |
3011 :echo expand(expand("<cfile>")) | |
3012 < | |
3013 There cannot be white space between the variables and the | |
3014 following modifier. The |fnamemodify()| function can be used | |
3015 to modify normal file names. | |
3016 | |
3017 When using '%' or '#', and the current or alternate file name | |
3018 is not defined, an empty string is used. Using "%:p" in a | |
3019 buffer with no name, results in the current directory, with a | |
3020 '/' added. | |
3021 | |
3022 When {expr} does not start with '%', '#' or '<', it is | |
3023 expanded like a file name is expanded on the command line. | |
3024 'suffixes' and 'wildignore' are used, unless the optional | |
3398 | 3025 {nosuf} argument is given and it is non-zero. |
3026 Names for non-existing files are included. The "**" item can | |
3027 be used to search in a directory tree. For example, to find | |
3028 all "README" files in the current directory and below: > | |
444 | 3029 :echo expand("**/README") |
3030 < | |
7 | 3031 Expand() can also be used to expand variables and environment |
3032 variables that are only known in a shell. But this can be | |
6180 | 3033 slow, because a shell may be used to do the expansion. See |
3034 |expr-env-expand|. | |
7 | 3035 The expanded variable is still handled like a list of file |
1621 | 3036 names. When an environment variable cannot be expanded, it is |
7 | 3037 left unchanged. Thus ":echo expand('$FOOBAR')" results in |
3038 "$FOOBAR". | |
3039 | |
3040 See |glob()| for finding existing files. See |system()| for | |
3041 getting the raw output of an external command. | |
3042 | |
102 | 3043 extend({expr1}, {expr2} [, {expr3}]) *extend()* |
692 | 3044 {expr1} and {expr2} must be both |Lists| or both |
3045 |Dictionaries|. | |
3046 | |
3047 If they are |Lists|: Append {expr2} to {expr1}. | |
102 | 3048 If {expr3} is given insert the items of {expr2} before item |
3049 {expr3} in {expr1}. When {expr3} is zero insert before the | |
3050 first item. When {expr3} is equal to len({expr1}) then | |
3051 {expr2} is appended. | |
79 | 3052 Examples: > |
3053 :echo sort(extend(mylist, [7, 5])) | |
3054 :call extend(mylist, [2, 3], 1) | |
1699 | 3055 < When {expr1} is the same List as {expr2} then the number of |
3056 items copied is equal to the original length of the List. | |
3057 E.g., when {expr3} is 1 you get N new copies of the first item | |
3058 (where N is the original length of the List). | |
3059 Use |add()| to concatenate one item to a list. To concatenate | |
82 | 3060 two lists into a new list use the + operator: > |
79 | 3061 :let newlist = [1, 2, 3] + [4, 5] |
102 | 3062 < |
692 | 3063 If they are |Dictionaries|: |
102 | 3064 Add all entries from {expr2} to {expr1}. |
3065 If a key exists in both {expr1} and {expr2} then {expr3} is | |
3066 used to decide what to do: | |
3067 {expr3} = "keep": keep the value of {expr1} | |
3068 {expr3} = "force": use the value of {expr2} | |
856 | 3069 {expr3} = "error": give an error message *E737* |
102 | 3070 When {expr3} is omitted then "force" is assumed. |
3071 | |
3072 {expr1} is changed when {expr2} is not empty. If necessary | |
3073 make a copy of {expr1} first. | |
3074 {expr2} remains unchanged. | |
6823 | 3075 When {expr1} is locked and {expr2} is not empty the operation |
3076 fails. | |
102 | 3077 Returns {expr1}. |
3078 | |
79 | 3079 |
842 | 3080 feedkeys({string} [, {mode}]) *feedkeys()* |
3081 Characters in {string} are queued for processing as if they | |
6549 | 3082 come from a mapping or were typed by the user. |
3083 By default the string is added to the end of the typeahead | |
3084 buffer, thus if a mapping is still being executed the | |
3085 characters come after them. Use the 'i' flag to insert before | |
3086 other characters, they will be executed next, before any | |
3087 characters from a mapping. | |
842 | 3088 The function does not wait for processing of keys contained in |
3089 {string}. | |
3090 To include special keys into {string}, use double-quotes | |
3091 and "\..." notation |expr-quote|. For example, | |
1215 | 3092 feedkeys("\<CR>") simulates pressing of the <Enter> key. But |
842 | 3093 feedkeys('\<CR>') pushes 5 characters. |
3094 If {mode} is absent, keys are remapped. | |
3095 {mode} is a String, which can contain these character flags: | |
843 | 3096 'm' Remap keys. This is default. |
3097 'n' Do not remap keys. | |
3098 't' Handle keys as if typed; otherwise they are handled as | |
3099 if coming from a mapping. This matters for undo, | |
3100 opening folds, etc. | |
6549 | 3101 'i' Insert the string instead of appending (see above). |
842 | 3102 Return value is always 0. |
3103 | |
7 | 3104 filereadable({file}) *filereadable()* |
3105 The result is a Number, which is TRUE when a file with the | |
3106 name {file} exists, and can be read. If {file} doesn't exist, | |
3107 or is a directory, the result is FALSE. {file} is any | |
3108 expression, which is used as a String. | |
1156 | 3109 If you don't care about the file being readable you can use |
3110 |glob()|. | |
7 | 3111 *file_readable()* |
3112 Obsolete name: file_readable(). | |
3113 | |
95 | 3114 |
1156 | 3115 filewritable({file}) *filewritable()* |
3116 The result is a Number, which is 1 when a file with the | |
3117 name {file} exists, and can be written. If {file} doesn't | |
1621 | 3118 exist, or is not writable, the result is 0. If {file} is a |
1156 | 3119 directory, and we can write to it, the result is 2. |
3120 | |
3121 | |
102 | 3122 filter({expr}, {string}) *filter()* |
685 | 3123 {expr} must be a |List| or a |Dictionary|. |
102 | 3124 For each item in {expr} evaluate {string} and when the result |
685 | 3125 is zero remove the item from the |List| or |Dictionary|. |
102 | 3126 Inside {string} |v:val| has the value of the current item. |
685 | 3127 For a |Dictionary| |v:key| has the key of the current item. |
102 | 3128 Examples: > |
3129 :call filter(mylist, 'v:val !~ "OLD"') | |
3130 < Removes the items where "OLD" appears. > | |
3131 :call filter(mydict, 'v:key >= 8') | |
3132 < Removes the items with a key below 8. > | |
3133 :call filter(var, 0) | |
685 | 3134 < Removes all the items, thus clears the |List| or |Dictionary|. |
99 | 3135 |
102 | 3136 Note that {string} is the result of expression and is then |
3137 used as an expression again. Often it is good to use a | |
3138 |literal-string| to avoid having to double backslashes. | |
3139 | |
685 | 3140 The operation is done in-place. If you want a |List| or |
3141 |Dictionary| to remain unmodified make a copy first: > | |
650 | 3142 :let l = filter(copy(mylist), 'v:val =~ "KEEP"') |
102 | 3143 |
685 | 3144 < Returns {expr}, the |List| or |Dictionary| that was filtered. |
648 | 3145 When an error is encountered while evaluating {string} no |
3146 further items in {expr} are processed. | |
95 | 3147 |
3148 | |
19 | 3149 finddir({name}[, {path}[, {count}]]) *finddir()* |
1095 | 3150 Find directory {name} in {path}. Supports both downwards and |
3151 upwards recursive directory searches. See |file-searching| | |
3152 for the syntax of {path}. | |
3153 Returns the path of the first found match. When the found | |
3154 directory is below the current directory a relative path is | |
3155 returned. Otherwise a full path is returned. | |
19 | 3156 If {path} is omitted or empty then 'path' is used. |
3157 If the optional {count} is given, find {count}'s occurrence of | |
794 | 3158 {name} in {path} instead of the first one. |
809 | 3159 When {count} is negative return all the matches in a |List|. |
19 | 3160 This is quite similar to the ex-command |:find|. |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2569
diff
changeset
|
3161 {only available when compiled with the |+file_in_path| |
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2569
diff
changeset
|
3162 feature} |
794 | 3163 |
3164 findfile({name}[, {path}[, {count}]]) *findfile()* | |
3165 Just like |finddir()|, but find a file instead of a directory. | |
3166 Uses 'suffixesadd'. | |
19 | 3167 Example: > |
3168 :echo findfile("tags.vim", ".;") | |
1156 | 3169 < Searches from the directory of the current file upwards until |
3170 it finds the file "tags.vim". | |
7 | 3171 |
1621 | 3172 float2nr({expr}) *float2nr()* |
3173 Convert {expr} to a Number by omitting the part after the | |
3174 decimal point. | |
3175 {expr} must evaluate to a |Float| or a Number. | |
3176 When the value of {expr} is out of range for a |Number| the | |
3177 result is truncated to 0x7fffffff or -0x7fffffff. NaN results | |
3178 in -0x80000000. | |
3179 Examples: > | |
3180 echo float2nr(3.95) | |
3181 < 3 > | |
3182 echo float2nr(-23.45) | |
3183 < -23 > | |
3184 echo float2nr(1.0e100) | |
3185 < 2147483647 > | |
3186 echo float2nr(-1.0e150) | |
3187 < -2147483647 > | |
3188 echo float2nr(1.0e-100) | |
3189 < 0 | |
3190 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} | |
3191 | |
3192 | |
3193 floor({expr}) *floor()* | |
3194 Return the largest integral value less than or equal to | |
3195 {expr} as a |Float| (round down). | |
3196 {expr} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number|. | |
3197 Examples: > | |
3198 echo floor(1.856) | |
3199 < 1.0 > | |
3200 echo floor(-5.456) | |
3201 < -6.0 > | |
3202 echo floor(4.0) | |
3203 < 4.0 | |
3204 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} | |
3205 | |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3206 |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3207 fmod({expr1}, {expr2}) *fmod()* |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3208 Return the remainder of {expr1} / {expr2}, even if the |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3209 division is not representable. Returns {expr1} - i * {expr2} |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3210 for some integer i such that if {expr2} is non-zero, the |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3211 result has the same sign as {expr1} and magnitude less than |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3212 the magnitude of {expr2}. If {expr2} is zero, the value |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
3213 returned is zero. The value returned is a |Float|. |
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
3214 {expr1} and {expr2} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number|. |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3215 Examples: > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3216 :echo fmod(12.33, 1.22) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3217 < 0.13 > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3218 :echo fmod(-12.33, 1.22) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3219 < -0.13 |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2569
diff
changeset
|
3220 {only available when compiled with |+float| feature} |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3221 |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3222 |
1586 | 3223 fnameescape({string}) *fnameescape()* |
1621 | 3224 Escape {string} for use as file name command argument. All |
1586 | 3225 characters that have a special meaning, such as '%' and '|' |
3226 are escaped with a backslash. | |
1621 | 3227 For most systems the characters escaped are |
3228 " \t\n*?[{`$\\%#'\"|!<". For systems where a backslash | |
3229 appears in a filename, it depends on the value of 'isfname'. | |
1700 | 3230 A leading '+' and '>' is also escaped (special after |:edit| |
3231 and |:write|). And a "-" by itself (special after |:cd|). | |
1586 | 3232 Example: > |
1700 | 3233 :let fname = '+some str%nge|name' |
1586 | 3234 :exe "edit " . fnameescape(fname) |
3235 < results in executing: > | |
1700 | 3236 edit \+some\ str\%nge\|name |
1586 | 3237 |
7 | 3238 fnamemodify({fname}, {mods}) *fnamemodify()* |
3239 Modify file name {fname} according to {mods}. {mods} is a | |
3240 string of characters like it is used for file names on the | |
3241 command line. See |filename-modifiers|. | |
3242 Example: > | |
3243 :echo fnamemodify("main.c", ":p:h") | |
3244 < results in: > | |
3245 /home/mool/vim/vim/src | |
1621 | 3246 < Note: Environment variables don't work in {fname}, use |
7 | 3247 |expand()| first then. |
3248 | |
3249 foldclosed({lnum}) *foldclosed()* | |
3250 The result is a Number. If the line {lnum} is in a closed | |
3251 fold, the result is the number of the first line in that fold. | |
3252 If the line {lnum} is not in a closed fold, -1 is returned. | |
3253 | |
3254 foldclosedend({lnum}) *foldclosedend()* | |
3255 The result is a Number. If the line {lnum} is in a closed | |
3256 fold, the result is the number of the last line in that fold. | |
3257 If the line {lnum} is not in a closed fold, -1 is returned. | |
3258 | |
3259 foldlevel({lnum}) *foldlevel()* | |
3260 The result is a Number, which is the foldlevel of line {lnum} | |
1621 | 3261 in the current buffer. For nested folds the deepest level is |
7 | 3262 returned. If there is no fold at line {lnum}, zero is |
3263 returned. It doesn't matter if the folds are open or closed. | |
3264 When used while updating folds (from 'foldexpr') -1 is | |
3265 returned for lines where folds are still to be updated and the | |
3266 foldlevel is unknown. As a special case the level of the | |
3267 previous line is usually available. | |
3268 | |
3269 *foldtext()* | |
3270 foldtext() Returns a String, to be displayed for a closed fold. This is | |
3271 the default function used for the 'foldtext' option and should | |
3272 only be called from evaluating 'foldtext'. It uses the | |
3273 |v:foldstart|, |v:foldend| and |v:folddashes| variables. | |
3274 The returned string looks like this: > | |
3275 +-- 45 lines: abcdef | |
1621 | 3276 < The number of dashes depends on the foldlevel. The "45" is |
7 | 3277 the number of lines in the fold. "abcdef" is the text in the |
3278 first non-blank line of the fold. Leading white space, "//" | |
3279 or "/*" and the text from the 'foldmarker' and 'commentstring' | |
3280 options is removed. | |
3281 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| feature} | |
3282 | |
29 | 3283 foldtextresult({lnum}) *foldtextresult()* |
3284 Returns the text that is displayed for the closed fold at line | |
3285 {lnum}. Evaluates 'foldtext' in the appropriate context. | |
3286 When there is no closed fold at {lnum} an empty string is | |
3287 returned. | |
3288 {lnum} is used like with |getline()|. Thus "." is the current | |
3289 line, "'m" mark m, etc. | |
3290 Useful when exporting folded text, e.g., to HTML. | |
3291 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| feature} | |
3292 | |
7 | 3293 *foreground()* |
1621 | 3294 foreground() Move the Vim window to the foreground. Useful when sent from |
7 | 3295 a client to a Vim server. |remote_send()| |
3296 On Win32 systems this might not work, the OS does not always | |
3297 allow a window to bring itself to the foreground. Use | |
3298 |remote_foreground()| instead. | |
3299 {only in the Win32, Athena, Motif and GTK GUI versions and the | |
3300 Win32 console version} | |
3301 | |
82 | 3302 |
85 | 3303 function({name}) *function()* *E700* |
685 | 3304 Return a |Funcref| variable that refers to function {name}. |
55 | 3305 {name} can be a user defined function or an internal function. |
3306 | |
82 | 3307 |
3224 | 3308 garbagecollect([{atexit}]) *garbagecollect()* |
692 | 3309 Cleanup unused |Lists| and |Dictionaries| that have circular |
370 | 3310 references. There is hardly ever a need to invoke this |
3311 function, as it is automatically done when Vim runs out of | |
3312 memory or is waiting for the user to press a key after | |
3313 'updatetime'. Items without circular references are always | |
3314 freed when they become unused. | |
685 | 3315 This is useful if you have deleted a very big |List| and/or |
3316 |Dictionary| with circular references in a script that runs | |
3317 for a long time. | |
3224 | 3318 When the optional {atexit} argument is one, garbage |
1405 | 3319 collection will also be done when exiting Vim, if it wasn't |
3320 done before. This is useful when checking for memory leaks. | |
370 | 3321 |
140 | 3322 get({list}, {idx} [, {default}]) *get()* |
685 | 3323 Get item {idx} from |List| {list}. When this item is not |
82 | 3324 available return {default}. Return zero when {default} is |
3325 omitted. | |
102 | 3326 get({dict}, {key} [, {default}]) |
685 | 3327 Get item with key {key} from |Dictionary| {dict}. When this |
102 | 3328 item is not available return {default}. Return zero when |
3329 {default} is omitted. | |
3330 | |
435 | 3331 *getbufline()* |
3332 getbufline({expr}, {lnum} [, {end}]) | |
685 | 3333 Return a |List| with the lines starting from {lnum} to {end} |
3334 (inclusive) in the buffer {expr}. If {end} is omitted, a | |
3335 |List| with only the line {lnum} is returned. | |
435 | 3336 |
3337 For the use of {expr}, see |bufname()| above. | |
3338 | |
448 | 3339 For {lnum} and {end} "$" can be used for the last line of the |
3340 buffer. Otherwise a number must be used. | |
435 | 3341 |
3342 When {lnum} is smaller than 1 or bigger than the number of | |
685 | 3343 lines in the buffer, an empty |List| is returned. |
435 | 3344 |
3345 When {end} is greater than the number of lines in the buffer, | |
3346 it is treated as {end} is set to the number of lines in the | |
685 | 3347 buffer. When {end} is before {lnum} an empty |List| is |
435 | 3348 returned. |
3349 | |
448 | 3350 This function works only for loaded buffers. For unloaded and |
685 | 3351 non-existing buffers, an empty |List| is returned. |
435 | 3352 |
3353 Example: > | |
3354 :let lines = getbufline(bufnr("myfile"), 1, "$") | |
82 | 3355 |
4157 | 3356 getbufvar({expr}, {varname} [, {def}]) *getbufvar()* |
82 | 3357 The result is the value of option or local buffer variable |
3358 {varname} in buffer {expr}. Note that the name without "b:" | |
3359 must be used. | |
1668 | 3360 When {varname} is empty returns a dictionary with all the |
3361 buffer-local variables. | |
216 | 3362 This also works for a global or buffer-local option, but it |
3363 doesn't work for a global variable, window-local variable or | |
3364 window-local option. | |
82 | 3365 For the use of {expr}, see |bufname()| above. |
4157 | 3366 When the buffer or variable doesn't exist {def} or an empty |
3367 string is returned, there is no error message. | |
82 | 3368 Examples: > |
3369 :let bufmodified = getbufvar(1, "&mod") | |
3370 :echo "todo myvar = " . getbufvar("todo", "myvar") | |
3371 < | |
7 | 3372 getchar([expr]) *getchar()* |
867 | 3373 Get a single character from the user or input stream. |
7 | 3374 If [expr] is omitted, wait until a character is available. |
3375 If [expr] is 0, only get a character when one is available. | |
867 | 3376 Return zero otherwise. |
7 | 3377 If [expr] is 1, only check if a character is available, it is |
867 | 3378 not consumed. Return zero if no character available. |
3379 | |
5555 | 3380 Without [expr] and when [expr] is 0 a whole character or |
867 | 3381 special key is returned. If it is an 8-bit character, the |
3382 result is a number. Use nr2char() to convert it to a String. | |
3383 Otherwise a String is returned with the encoded character. | |
3384 For a special key it's a sequence of bytes starting with 0x80 | |
872 | 3385 (decimal: 128). This is the same value as the string |
3386 "\<Key>", e.g., "\<Left>". The returned value is also a | |
3387 String when a modifier (shift, control, alt) was used that is | |
3388 not included in the character. | |
867 | 3389 |
5968 | 3390 When [expr] is 0 and Esc is typed, there will be a short delay |
3391 while Vim waits to see if this is the start of an escape | |
3392 sequence. | |
3393 | |
5555 | 3394 When [expr] is 1 only the first byte is returned. For a |
872 | 3395 one-byte character it is the character itself as a number. |
3396 Use nr2char() to convert it to a String. | |
867 | 3397 |
3224 | 3398 Use getcharmod() to obtain any additional modifiers. |
3399 | |
1029 | 3400 When the user clicks a mouse button, the mouse event will be |
3401 returned. The position can then be found in |v:mouse_col|, | |
3402 |v:mouse_lnum| and |v:mouse_win|. This example positions the | |
3403 mouse as it would normally happen: > | |
3404 let c = getchar() | |
1621 | 3405 if c == "\<LeftMouse>" && v:mouse_win > 0 |
1029 | 3406 exe v:mouse_win . "wincmd w" |
3407 exe v:mouse_lnum | |
3408 exe "normal " . v:mouse_col . "|" | |
3409 endif | |
3410 < | |
7 | 3411 There is no prompt, you will somehow have to make clear to the |
3412 user that a character has to be typed. | |
3413 There is no mapping for the character. | |
3414 Key codes are replaced, thus when the user presses the <Del> | |
3415 key you get the code for the <Del> key, not the raw character | |
3416 sequence. Examples: > | |
3417 getchar() == "\<Del>" | |
3418 getchar() == "\<S-Left>" | |
3419 < This example redefines "f" to ignore case: > | |
3420 :nmap f :call FindChar()<CR> | |
3421 :function FindChar() | |
3422 : let c = nr2char(getchar()) | |
3423 : while col('.') < col('$') - 1 | |
3424 : normal l | |
3425 : if getline('.')[col('.') - 1] ==? c | |
3426 : break | |
3427 : endif | |
3428 : endwhile | |
3429 :endfunction | |
6421 | 3430 < |
6647 | 3431 You may also receive synthetic characters, such as |
6421 | 3432 |<CursorHold>|. Often you will want to ignore this and get |
3433 another character: > | |
3434 :function GetKey() | |
3435 : let c = getchar() | |
3436 : while c == "\<CursorHold>" | |
3437 : let c = getchar() | |
3438 : endwhile | |
3439 : return c | |
3440 :endfunction | |
7 | 3441 |
3442 getcharmod() *getcharmod()* | |
3443 The result is a Number which is the state of the modifiers for | |
3444 the last obtained character with getchar() or in another way. | |
3445 These values are added together: | |
3446 2 shift | |
3447 4 control | |
3448 8 alt (meta) | |
3224 | 3449 16 meta (when it's different from ALT) |
3450 32 mouse double click | |
3451 64 mouse triple click | |
3452 96 mouse quadruple click (== 32 + 64) | |
3453 128 command (Macintosh only) | |
7 | 3454 Only the modifiers that have not been included in the |
1621 | 3455 character itself are obtained. Thus Shift-a results in "A" |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
3456 without a modifier. |
7 | 3457 |
6991 | 3458 getcharsearch() *getcharsearch()* |
3459 Return the current character search information as a {dict} | |
3460 with the following entries: | |
3461 | |
3462 char character previously used for a character | |
3463 search (|t|, |f|, |T|, or |F|); empty string | |
3464 if no character search has been performed | |
3465 forward direction of character search; 1 for forward, | |
3466 0 for backward | |
3467 until type of character search; 1 for a |t| or |T| | |
3468 character search, 0 for an |f| or |F| | |
3469 character search | |
3470 | |
3471 This can be useful to always have |;| and |,| search | |
3472 forward/backward regardless of the direction of the previous | |
3473 character search: > | |
3474 :nnoremap <expr> ; getcharsearch().forward ? ';' : ',' | |
3475 :nnoremap <expr> , getcharsearch().forward ? ',' : ';' | |
3476 < Also see |setcharsearch()|. | |
3477 | |
7 | 3478 getcmdline() *getcmdline()* |
3479 Return the current command-line. Only works when the command | |
3480 line is being edited, thus requires use of |c_CTRL-\_e| or | |
3481 |c_CTRL-R_=|. | |
3482 Example: > | |
3483 :cmap <F7> <C-\>eescape(getcmdline(), ' \')<CR> | |
531 | 3484 < Also see |getcmdtype()|, |getcmdpos()| and |setcmdpos()|. |
7 | 3485 |
95 | 3486 getcmdpos() *getcmdpos()* |
7 | 3487 Return the position of the cursor in the command line as a |
3488 byte count. The first column is 1. | |
3489 Only works when editing the command line, thus requires use of | |
3456 | 3490 |c_CTRL-\_e| or |c_CTRL-R_=| or an expression mapping. |
3491 Returns 0 otherwise. | |
531 | 3492 Also see |getcmdtype()|, |setcmdpos()| and |getcmdline()|. |
3493 | |
3494 getcmdtype() *getcmdtype()* | |
3495 Return the current command-line type. Possible return values | |
3496 are: | |
532 | 3497 : normal Ex command |
3498 > debug mode command |debug-mode| | |
3499 / forward search command | |
3500 ? backward search command | |
3501 @ |input()| command | |
3502 - |:insert| or |:append| command | |
6213 | 3503 = |i_CTRL-R_=| |
531 | 3504 Only works when editing the command line, thus requires use of |
3456 | 3505 |c_CTRL-\_e| or |c_CTRL-R_=| or an expression mapping. |
3506 Returns an empty string otherwise. | |
531 | 3507 Also see |getcmdpos()|, |setcmdpos()| and |getcmdline()|. |
7 | 3508 |
6153 | 3509 getcmdwintype() *getcmdwintype()* |
3510 Return the current |command-line-window| type. Possible return | |
3511 values are the same as |getcmdtype()|. Returns an empty string | |
3512 when not in the command-line window. | |
3513 | |
5944 | 3514 *getcurpos()* |
3515 getcurpos() Get the position of the cursor. This is like getpos('.'), but | |
3516 includes an extra item in the list: | |
7597
3012eaddb6b2
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/345efa013dc6d1754ba06e5596a26c48c9935937
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7593
diff
changeset
|
3517 [bufnum, lnum, col, off, curswant] ~ |
5944 | 3518 The "curswant" number is the preferred column when moving the |
3519 cursor vertically. | |
3520 This can be used to save and restore the cursor position: > | |
3521 let save_cursor = getcurpos() | |
3522 MoveTheCursorAround | |
3523 call setpos('.', save_cursor) | |
6153 | 3524 < |
7 | 3525 *getcwd()* |
7653
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
3526 getcwd([{winnr} [, {tabnr}]]) |
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
3527 The result is a String, which is the name of the current |
7 | 3528 working directory. |
7653
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
3529 Without arguments, for the current window. |
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
3530 |
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
3531 With {winnr} return the local current directory of this window |
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
3532 in the current tab page. |
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
3533 With {winnr} and {tabnr} return the local current directory of |
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
3534 the window in the specified tab page. |
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
3535 Return an empty string if the arguments are invalid. |
7 | 3536 |
3537 getfsize({fname}) *getfsize()* | |
3538 The result is a Number, which is the size in bytes of the | |
3539 given file {fname}. | |
3540 If {fname} is a directory, 0 is returned. | |
3541 If the file {fname} can't be found, -1 is returned. | |
1293 | 3542 If the size of {fname} is too big to fit in a Number then -2 |
3543 is returned. | |
7 | 3544 |
37 | 3545 getfontname([{name}]) *getfontname()* |
3546 Without an argument returns the name of the normal font being | |
3547 used. Like what is used for the Normal highlight group | |
3548 |hl-Normal|. | |
3549 With an argument a check is done whether {name} is a valid | |
3550 font name. If not then an empty string is returned. | |
3551 Otherwise the actual font name is returned, or {name} if the | |
3552 GUI does not support obtaining the real name. | |
824 | 3553 Only works when the GUI is running, thus not in your vimrc or |
819 | 3554 gvimrc file. Use the |GUIEnter| autocommand to use this |
3555 function just after the GUI has started. | |
37 | 3556 Note that the GTK 2 GUI accepts any font name, thus checking |
3557 for a valid name does not work. | |
3558 | |
20 | 3559 getfperm({fname}) *getfperm()* |
3560 The result is a String, which is the read, write, and execute | |
3561 permissions of the given file {fname}. | |
3562 If {fname} does not exist or its directory cannot be read, an | |
3563 empty string is returned. | |
3564 The result is of the form "rwxrwxrwx", where each group of | |
3565 "rwx" flags represent, in turn, the permissions of the owner | |
3566 of the file, the group the file belongs to, and other users. | |
3567 If a user does not have a given permission the flag for this | |
3750 | 3568 is replaced with the string "-". Examples: > |
20 | 3569 :echo getfperm("/etc/passwd") |
3750 | 3570 :echo getfperm(expand("~/.vimrc")) |
20 | 3571 < This will hopefully (from a security point of view) display |
3572 the string "rw-r--r--" or even "rw-------". | |
205 | 3573 |
7 | 3574 getftime({fname}) *getftime()* |
3575 The result is a Number, which is the last modification time of | |
3576 the given file {fname}. The value is measured as seconds | |
3577 since 1st Jan 1970, and may be passed to strftime(). See also | |
3578 |localtime()| and |strftime()|. | |
3579 If the file {fname} can't be found -1 is returned. | |
3580 | |
20 | 3581 getftype({fname}) *getftype()* |
3582 The result is a String, which is a description of the kind of | |
3583 file of the given file {fname}. | |
3584 If {fname} does not exist an empty string is returned. | |
3585 Here is a table over different kinds of files and their | |
3586 results: | |
3587 Normal file "file" | |
3588 Directory "dir" | |
3589 Symbolic link "link" | |
3590 Block device "bdev" | |
3591 Character device "cdev" | |
3592 Socket "socket" | |
3593 FIFO "fifo" | |
3594 All other "other" | |
3595 Example: > | |
3596 getftype("/home") | |
3597 < Note that a type such as "link" will only be returned on | |
3598 systems that support it. On some systems only "dir" and | |
3599 "file" are returned. | |
3600 | |
7 | 3601 *getline()* |
82 | 3602 getline({lnum} [, {end}]) |
3603 Without {end} the result is a String, which is line {lnum} | |
3604 from the current buffer. Example: > | |
7 | 3605 getline(1) |
3606 < When {lnum} is a String that doesn't start with a | |
3607 digit, line() is called to translate the String into a Number. | |
3608 To get the line under the cursor: > | |
3609 getline(".") | |
3610 < When {lnum} is smaller than 1 or bigger than the number of | |
3611 lines in the buffer, an empty string is returned. | |
3612 | |
685 | 3613 When {end} is given the result is a |List| where each item is |
3614 a line from the current buffer in the range {lnum} to {end}, | |
82 | 3615 including line {end}. |
3616 {end} is used in the same way as {lnum}. | |
3617 Non-existing lines are silently omitted. | |
685 | 3618 When {end} is before {lnum} an empty |List| is returned. |
82 | 3619 Example: > |
3620 :let start = line('.') | |
3621 :let end = search("^$") - 1 | |
3622 :let lines = getline(start, end) | |
3623 | |
1156 | 3624 < To get lines from another buffer see |getbufline()| |
3625 | |
647 | 3626 getloclist({nr}) *getloclist()* |
3627 Returns a list with all the entries in the location list for | |
3628 window {nr}. When {nr} is zero the current window is used. | |
3629 For a location list window, the displayed location list is | |
648 | 3630 returned. For an invalid window number {nr}, an empty list is |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
3631 returned. Otherwise, same as |getqflist()|. |
82 | 3632 |
1326 | 3633 getmatches() *getmatches()* |
3634 Returns a |List| with all matches previously defined by | |
3635 |matchadd()| and the |:match| commands. |getmatches()| is | |
3636 useful in combination with |setmatches()|, as |setmatches()| | |
3637 can restore a list of matches saved by |getmatches()|. | |
3638 Example: > | |
3639 :echo getmatches() | |
3640 < [{'group': 'MyGroup1', 'pattern': 'TODO', | |
3641 'priority': 10, 'id': 1}, {'group': 'MyGroup2', | |
3642 'pattern': 'FIXME', 'priority': 10, 'id': 2}] > | |
3643 :let m = getmatches() | |
3644 :call clearmatches() | |
3645 :echo getmatches() | |
3646 < [] > | |
3647 :call setmatches(m) | |
3648 :echo getmatches() | |
3649 < [{'group': 'MyGroup1', 'pattern': 'TODO', | |
3650 'priority': 10, 'id': 1}, {'group': 'MyGroup2', | |
3651 'pattern': 'FIXME', 'priority': 10, 'id': 2}] > | |
3652 :unlet m | |
3653 < | |
5968 | 3654 *getpid()* |
3655 getpid() Return a Number which is the process ID of the Vim process. | |
3656 On Unix and MS-Windows this is a unique number, until Vim | |
3657 exits. On MS-DOS it's always zero. | |
3658 | |
3659 *getpos()* | |
3660 getpos({expr}) Get the position for {expr}. For possible values of {expr} | |
3661 see |line()|. For getting the cursor position see | |
3662 |getcurpos()|. | |
3663 The result is a |List| with four numbers: | |
3664 [bufnum, lnum, col, off] | |
3665 "bufnum" is zero, unless a mark like '0 or 'A is used, then it | |
3666 is the buffer number of the mark. | |
3667 "lnum" and "col" are the position in the buffer. The first | |
3668 column is 1. | |
3669 The "off" number is zero, unless 'virtualedit' is used. Then | |
3670 it is the offset in screen columns from the start of the | |
3671 character. E.g., a position within a <Tab> or after the last | |
3672 character. | |
3673 Note that for '< and '> Visual mode matters: when it is "V" | |
3674 (visual line mode) the column of '< is zero and the column of | |
3675 '> is a large number. | |
3676 This can be used to save and restore the position of a mark: > | |
3677 let save_a_mark = getpos("'a") | |
3678 ... | |
6421 | 3679 call setpos("'a", save_a_mark) |
5968 | 3680 < Also see |getcurpos()| and |setpos()|. |
3681 | |
1326 | 3682 |
230 | 3683 getqflist() *getqflist()* |
3684 Returns a list with all the current quickfix errors. Each | |
3685 list item is a dictionary with these entries: | |
3686 bufnr number of buffer that has the file name, use | |
3687 bufname() to get the name | |
3688 lnum line number in the buffer (first line is 1) | |
3689 col column number (first column is 1) | |
233 | 3690 vcol non-zero: "col" is visual column |
3691 zero: "col" is byte index | |
230 | 3692 nr error number |
1065 | 3693 pattern search pattern used to locate the error |
230 | 3694 text description of the error |
3695 type type of the error, 'E', '1', etc. | |
3696 valid non-zero: recognized error message | |
3697 | |
515 | 3698 When there is no error list or it's empty an empty list is |
1065 | 3699 returned. Quickfix list entries with non-existing buffer |
3700 number are returned with "bufnr" set to zero. | |
515 | 3701 |
230 | 3702 Useful application: Find pattern matches in multiple files and |
3703 do something with them: > | |
3704 :vimgrep /theword/jg *.c | |
3705 :for d in getqflist() | |
3706 : echo bufname(d.bufnr) ':' d.lnum '=' d.text | |
3707 :endfor | |
3708 | |
3709 | |
5796 | 3710 getreg([{regname} [, 1 [, {list}]]]) *getreg()* |
7 | 3711 The result is a String, which is the contents of register |
236 | 3712 {regname}. Example: > |
7 | 3713 :let cliptext = getreg('*') |
3714 < getreg('=') returns the last evaluated value of the expression | |
236 | 3715 register. (For use in maps.) |
282 | 3716 getreg('=', 1) returns the expression itself, so that it can |
3717 be restored with |setreg()|. For other registers the extra | |
3718 argument is ignored, thus you can always give it. | |
5796 | 3719 If {list} is present and non-zero result type is changed to |
3720 |List|. Each list item is one text line. Use it if you care | |
3721 about zero bytes possibly present inside register: without | |
3722 third argument both NLs and zero bytes are represented as NLs | |
3723 (see |NL-used-for-Nul|). | |
7 | 3724 If {regname} is not specified, |v:register| is used. |
3725 | |
82 | 3726 |
7 | 3727 getregtype([{regname}]) *getregtype()* |
3728 The result is a String, which is type of register {regname}. | |
3729 The value will be one of: | |
3730 "v" for |characterwise| text | |
3731 "V" for |linewise| text | |
3732 "<CTRL-V>{width}" for |blockwise-visual| text | |
5596 | 3733 "" for an empty or unknown register |
7 | 3734 <CTRL-V> is one character with value 0x16. |
3735 If {regname} is not specified, |v:register| is used. | |
3736 | |
4157 | 3737 gettabvar({tabnr}, {varname} [, {def}]) *gettabvar()* |
2207
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2206
diff
changeset
|
3738 Get the value of a tab-local variable {varname} in tab page |
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2206
diff
changeset
|
3739 {tabnr}. |t:var| |
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2206
diff
changeset
|
3740 Tabs are numbered starting with one. |
6197 | 3741 When {varname} is empty a dictionary with all tab-local |
3742 variables is returned. | |
2207
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2206
diff
changeset
|
3743 Note that the name without "t:" must be used. |
4157 | 3744 When the tab or variable doesn't exist {def} or an empty |
3745 string is returned, there is no error message. | |
3746 | |
3747 gettabwinvar({tabnr}, {winnr}, {varname} [, {def}]) *gettabwinvar()* | |
1156 | 3748 Get the value of window-local variable {varname} in window |
3749 {winnr} in tab page {tabnr}. | |
3750 When {varname} starts with "&" get the value of a window-local | |
3751 option. | |
4157 | 3752 When {varname} is empty a dictionary with all window-local |
3753 variables is returned. | |
3754 Note that {varname} must be the name without "w:". | |
831 | 3755 Tabs are numbered starting with one. For the current tabpage |
3756 use |getwinvar()|. | |
3757 When {winnr} is zero the current window is used. | |
3758 This also works for a global option, buffer-local option and | |
3759 window-local option, but it doesn't work for a global variable | |
3760 or buffer-local variable. | |
4157 | 3761 When the tab, window or variable doesn't exist {def} or an |
3762 empty string is returned, there is no error message. | |
831 | 3763 Examples: > |
3764 :let list_is_on = gettabwinvar(1, 2, '&list') | |
3765 :echo "myvar = " . gettabwinvar(3, 1, 'myvar') | |
1266 | 3766 < |
7 | 3767 *getwinposx()* |
3768 getwinposx() The result is a Number, which is the X coordinate in pixels of | |
3769 the left hand side of the GUI Vim window. The result will be | |
3770 -1 if the information is not available. | |
3771 | |
3772 *getwinposy()* | |
3773 getwinposy() The result is a Number, which is the Y coordinate in pixels of | |
1621 | 3774 the top of the GUI Vim window. The result will be -1 if the |
7 | 3775 information is not available. |
3776 | |
4157 | 3777 getwinvar({winnr}, {varname} [, {def}]) *getwinvar()* |
831 | 3778 Like |gettabwinvar()| for the current tabpage. |
7 | 3779 Examples: > |
3780 :let list_is_on = getwinvar(2, '&list') | |
3781 :echo "myvar = " . getwinvar(1, 'myvar') | |
3782 < | |
6663 | 3783 glob({expr} [, {nosuf} [, {list} [, {alllinks}]]]) *glob()* |
1754 | 3784 Expand the file wildcards in {expr}. See |wildcards| for the |
1156 | 3785 use of special characters. |
3410
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
3786 |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
3787 Unless the optional {nosuf} argument is given and is non-zero, |
1754 | 3788 the 'suffixes' and 'wildignore' options apply: Names matching |
3789 one of the patterns in 'wildignore' will be skipped and | |
3790 'suffixes' affect the ordering of matches. | |
2662 | 3791 'wildignorecase' always applies. |
3410
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
3792 |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
3793 When {list} is present and it is non-zero the result is a List |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
3794 with all matching files. The advantage of using a List is, |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
3795 you also get filenames containing newlines correctly. |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
3796 Otherwise the result is a String and when there are several |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
3797 matches, they are separated by <NL> characters. |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
3798 |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
3799 If the expansion fails, the result is an empty String or List. |
6663 | 3800 |
3445 | 3801 A name for a non-existing file is not included. A symbolic |
3802 link is only included if it points to an existing file. | |
6663 | 3803 However, when the {alllinks} argument is present and it is |
3804 non-zero then all symbolic links are included. | |
7 | 3805 |
3806 For most systems backticks can be used to get files names from | |
3807 any external command. Example: > | |
3808 :let tagfiles = glob("`find . -name tags -print`") | |
3809 :let &tags = substitute(tagfiles, "\n", ",", "g") | |
3810 < The result of the program inside the backticks should be one | |
1621 | 3811 item per line. Spaces inside an item are allowed. |
7 | 3812 |
3813 See |expand()| for expanding special Vim variables. See | |
3814 |system()| for getting the raw output of an external command. | |
3815 | |
6697 | 3816 glob2regpat({expr}) *glob2regpat()* |
3817 Convert a file pattern, as used by glob(), into a search | |
3818 pattern. The result can be used to match with a string that | |
3819 is a file name. E.g. > | |
3820 if filename =~ glob2regpat('Make*.mak') | |
3821 < This is equivalent to: > | |
3822 if filename =~ '^Make.*\.mak$' | |
3823 < | |
6663 | 3824 *globpath()* |
3825 globpath({path}, {expr} [, {nosuf} [, {list} [, {allinks}]]]) | |
7 | 3826 Perform glob() on all directories in {path} and concatenate |
3827 the results. Example: > | |
3828 :echo globpath(&rtp, "syntax/c.vim") | |
5873 | 3829 < |
3830 {path} is a comma-separated list of directory names. Each | |
7 | 3831 directory name is prepended to {expr} and expanded like with |
1754 | 3832 |glob()|. A path separator is inserted when needed. |
7 | 3833 To add a comma inside a directory name escape it with a |
3834 backslash. Note that on MS-Windows a directory may have a | |
3835 trailing backslash, remove it if you put a comma after it. | |
3836 If the expansion fails for one of the directories, there is no | |
3837 error message. | |
5873 | 3838 |
3839 Unless the optional {nosuf} argument is given and is non-zero, | |
1754 | 3840 the 'suffixes' and 'wildignore' options apply: Names matching |
3841 one of the patterns in 'wildignore' will be skipped and | |
3842 'suffixes' affect the ordering of matches. | |
7 | 3843 |
5873 | 3844 When {list} is present and it is non-zero the result is a List |
3845 with all matching files. The advantage of using a List is, you | |
3846 also get filenames containing newlines correctly. Otherwise | |
3847 the result is a String and when there are several matches, | |
3848 they are separated by <NL> characters. Example: > | |
3849 :echo globpath(&rtp, "syntax/c.vim", 0, 1) | |
3850 < | |
6663 | 3851 {allinks} is used as with |glob()|. |
3852 | |
444 | 3853 The "**" item can be used to search in a directory tree. |
3854 For example, to find all "README.txt" files in the directories | |
3855 in 'runtimepath' and below: > | |
3856 :echo globpath(&rtp, "**/README.txt") | |
1668 | 3857 < Upwards search and limiting the depth of "**" is not |
3858 supported, thus using 'path' will not always work properly. | |
3859 | |
7 | 3860 *has()* |
3861 has({feature}) The result is a Number, which is 1 if the feature {feature} is | |
3862 supported, zero otherwise. The {feature} argument is a | |
3863 string. See |feature-list| below. | |
3864 Also see |exists()|. | |
3865 | |
102 | 3866 |
3867 has_key({dict}, {key}) *has_key()* | |
685 | 3868 The result is a Number, which is 1 if |Dictionary| {dict} has |
3869 an entry with key {key}. Zero otherwise. | |
102 | 3870 |
7653
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
3871 haslocaldir([{winnr} [, {tabnr}]]) *haslocaldir()* |
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
3872 The result is a Number, which is 1 when the window has set a |
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
3873 local path via |:lcd|, and 0 otherwise. |
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
3874 |
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
3875 Without arguments use the current window. |
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
3876 With {winnr} use this window in the current tab page. |
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
3877 With {winnr} and {tabnr} use the window in the specified tab |
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
3878 page. |
d4370fef0175
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c970330676eaae7ba7cd05cfa46df5a413853ef9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7651
diff
changeset
|
3879 Return 0 if the arguments are invalid. |
102 | 3880 |
782 | 3881 hasmapto({what} [, {mode} [, {abbr}]]) *hasmapto()* |
7 | 3882 The result is a Number, which is 1 if there is a mapping that |
3883 contains {what} in somewhere in the rhs (what it is mapped to) | |
3884 and this mapping exists in one of the modes indicated by | |
3885 {mode}. | |
782 | 3886 When {abbr} is there and it is non-zero use abbreviations |
786 | 3887 instead of mappings. Don't forget to specify Insert and/or |
3888 Command-line mode. | |
7 | 3889 Both the global mappings and the mappings local to the current |
3890 buffer are checked for a match. | |
3891 If no matching mapping is found 0 is returned. | |
3892 The following characters are recognized in {mode}: | |
3893 n Normal mode | |
3894 v Visual mode | |
3895 o Operator-pending mode | |
3896 i Insert mode | |
3897 l Language-Argument ("r", "f", "t", etc.) | |
3898 c Command-line mode | |
3899 When {mode} is omitted, "nvo" is used. | |
3900 | |
3901 This function is useful to check if a mapping already exists | |
1621 | 3902 to a function in a Vim script. Example: > |
7 | 3903 :if !hasmapto('\ABCdoit') |
3904 : map <Leader>d \ABCdoit | |
3905 :endif | |
3906 < This installs the mapping to "\ABCdoit" only if there isn't | |
3907 already a mapping to "\ABCdoit". | |
3908 | |
3909 histadd({history}, {item}) *histadd()* | |
3910 Add the String {item} to the history {history} which can be | |
3911 one of: *hist-names* | |
3912 "cmd" or ":" command line history | |
3913 "search" or "/" search pattern history | |
1621 | 3914 "expr" or "=" typed expression history |
7 | 3915 "input" or "@" input line history |
3682 | 3916 "debug" or ">" debug command history |
3917 The {history} string does not need to be the whole name, one | |
3918 character is sufficient. | |
7 | 3919 If {item} does already exist in the history, it will be |
3920 shifted to become the newest entry. | |
3921 The result is a Number: 1 if the operation was successful, | |
3922 otherwise 0 is returned. | |
3923 | |
3924 Example: > | |
3925 :call histadd("input", strftime("%Y %b %d")) | |
3926 :let date=input("Enter date: ") | |
3927 < This function is not available in the |sandbox|. | |
3928 | |
3929 histdel({history} [, {item}]) *histdel()* | |
236 | 3930 Clear {history}, i.e. delete all its entries. See |hist-names| |
7 | 3931 for the possible values of {history}. |
3932 | |
1668 | 3933 If the parameter {item} evaluates to a String, it is used as a |
3934 regular expression. All entries matching that expression will | |
3935 be removed from the history (if there are any). | |
7 | 3936 Upper/lowercase must match, unless "\c" is used |/\c|. |
1668 | 3937 If {item} evaluates to a Number, it will be interpreted as |
3938 an index, see |:history-indexing|. The respective entry will | |
3939 be removed if it exists. | |
7 | 3940 |
3941 The result is a Number: 1 for a successful operation, | |
3942 otherwise 0 is returned. | |
3943 | |
3944 Examples: | |
3945 Clear expression register history: > | |
3946 :call histdel("expr") | |
3947 < | |
3948 Remove all entries starting with "*" from the search history: > | |
3949 :call histdel("/", '^\*') | |
3950 < | |
3951 The following three are equivalent: > | |
3952 :call histdel("search", histnr("search")) | |
3953 :call histdel("search", -1) | |
3954 :call histdel("search", '^'.histget("search", -1).'$') | |
3955 < | |
3956 To delete the last search pattern and use the last-but-one for | |
3957 the "n" command and 'hlsearch': > | |
3958 :call histdel("search", -1) | |
3959 :let @/ = histget("search", -1) | |
3960 | |
3961 histget({history} [, {index}]) *histget()* | |
3962 The result is a String, the entry with Number {index} from | |
3963 {history}. See |hist-names| for the possible values of | |
3964 {history}, and |:history-indexing| for {index}. If there is | |
3965 no such entry, an empty String is returned. When {index} is | |
3966 omitted, the most recent item from the history is used. | |
3967 | |
3968 Examples: | |
3969 Redo the second last search from history. > | |
3970 :execute '/' . histget("search", -2) | |
3971 | |
3972 < Define an Ex command ":H {num}" that supports re-execution of | |
3973 the {num}th entry from the output of |:history|. > | |
3974 :command -nargs=1 H execute histget("cmd", 0+<args>) | |
3975 < | |
3976 histnr({history}) *histnr()* | |
3977 The result is the Number of the current entry in {history}. | |
3978 See |hist-names| for the possible values of {history}. | |
3979 If an error occurred, -1 is returned. | |
3980 | |
3981 Example: > | |
3982 :let inp_index = histnr("expr") | |
3983 < | |
3984 hlexists({name}) *hlexists()* | |
3985 The result is a Number, which is non-zero if a highlight group | |
3986 called {name} exists. This is when the group has been | |
3987 defined in some way. Not necessarily when highlighting has | |
3988 been defined for it, it may also have been used for a syntax | |
3989 item. | |
3990 *highlight_exists()* | |
3991 Obsolete name: highlight_exists(). | |
3992 | |
3993 *hlID()* | |
3994 hlID({name}) The result is a Number, which is the ID of the highlight group | |
3995 with name {name}. When the highlight group doesn't exist, | |
3996 zero is returned. | |
3997 This can be used to retrieve information about the highlight | |
1621 | 3998 group. For example, to get the background color of the |
7 | 3999 "Comment" group: > |
4000 :echo synIDattr(synIDtrans(hlID("Comment")), "bg") | |
4001 < *highlightID()* | |
4002 Obsolete name: highlightID(). | |
4003 | |
4004 hostname() *hostname()* | |
4005 The result is a String, which is the name of the machine on | |
236 | 4006 which Vim is currently running. Machine names greater than |
7 | 4007 256 characters long are truncated. |
4008 | |
4009 iconv({expr}, {from}, {to}) *iconv()* | |
4010 The result is a String, which is the text {expr} converted | |
4011 from encoding {from} to encoding {to}. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4012 When the conversion completely fails an empty string is |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4013 returned. When some characters could not be converted they |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4014 are replaced with "?". |
7 | 4015 The encoding names are whatever the iconv() library function |
4016 can accept, see ":!man 3 iconv". | |
4017 Most conversions require Vim to be compiled with the |+iconv| | |
4018 feature. Otherwise only UTF-8 to latin1 conversion and back | |
4019 can be done. | |
4020 This can be used to display messages with special characters, | |
4021 no matter what 'encoding' is set to. Write the message in | |
4022 UTF-8 and use: > | |
4023 echo iconv(utf8_str, "utf-8", &enc) | |
4024 < Note that Vim uses UTF-8 for all Unicode encodings, conversion | |
4025 from/to UCS-2 is automatically changed to use UTF-8. You | |
4026 cannot use UCS-2 in a string anyway, because of the NUL bytes. | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2569
diff
changeset
|
4027 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte| feature} |
7 | 4028 |
4029 *indent()* | |
4030 indent({lnum}) The result is a Number, which is indent of line {lnum} in the | |
4031 current buffer. The indent is counted in spaces, the value | |
4032 of 'tabstop' is relevant. {lnum} is used just like in | |
4033 |getline()|. | |
4034 When {lnum} is invalid -1 is returned. | |
4035 | |
79 | 4036 |
95 | 4037 index({list}, {expr} [, {start} [, {ic}]]) *index()* |
685 | 4038 Return the lowest index in |List| {list} where the item has a |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4039 value equal to {expr}. There is no automatic conversion, so |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4040 the String "4" is different from the Number 4. And the number |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4041 4 is different from the Float 4.0. The value of 'ignorecase' |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4042 is not used here, case always matters. |
153 | 4043 If {start} is given then start looking at the item with index |
4044 {start} (may be negative for an item relative to the end). | |
79 | 4045 When {ic} is given and it is non-zero, ignore case. Otherwise |
4046 case must match. | |
4047 -1 is returned when {expr} is not found in {list}. | |
4048 Example: > | |
4049 :let idx = index(words, "the") | |
87 | 4050 :if index(numbers, 123) >= 0 |
79 | 4051 |
4052 | |
531 | 4053 input({prompt} [, {text} [, {completion}]]) *input()* |
7 | 4054 The result is a String, which is whatever the user typed on |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4055 the command-line. The {prompt} argument is either a prompt |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4056 string, or a blank string (for no prompt). A '\n' can be used |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4057 in the prompt to start a new line. |
531 | 4058 The highlighting set with |:echohl| is used for the prompt. |
4059 The input is entered just like a command-line, with the same | |
1621 | 4060 editing commands and mappings. There is a separate history |
531 | 4061 for lines typed for input(). |
4062 Example: > | |
4063 :if input("Coffee or beer? ") == "beer" | |
4064 : echo "Cheers!" | |
4065 :endif | |
4066 < | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4067 If the optional {text} argument is present and not empty, this |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4068 is used for the default reply, as if the user typed this. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4069 Example: > |
531 | 4070 :let color = input("Color? ", "white") |
4071 | |
4072 < The optional {completion} argument specifies the type of | |
4073 completion supported for the input. Without it completion is | |
1621 | 4074 not performed. The supported completion types are the same as |
531 | 4075 that can be supplied to a user-defined command using the |
1621 | 4076 "-complete=" argument. Refer to |:command-completion| for |
531 | 4077 more information. Example: > |
4078 let fname = input("File: ", "", "file") | |
4079 < | |
4080 NOTE: This function must not be used in a startup file, for | |
4081 the versions that only run in GUI mode (e.g., the Win32 GUI). | |
7 | 4082 Note: When input() is called from within a mapping it will |
4083 consume remaining characters from that mapping, because a | |
4084 mapping is handled like the characters were typed. | |
4085 Use |inputsave()| before input() and |inputrestore()| | |
4086 after input() to avoid that. Another solution is to avoid | |
4087 that further characters follow in the mapping, e.g., by using | |
4088 |:execute| or |:normal|. | |
4089 | |
531 | 4090 Example with a mapping: > |
7 | 4091 :nmap \x :call GetFoo()<CR>:exe "/" . Foo<CR> |
4092 :function GetFoo() | |
4093 : call inputsave() | |
4094 : let g:Foo = input("enter search pattern: ") | |
4095 : call inputrestore() | |
4096 :endfunction | |
4097 | |
4098 inputdialog({prompt} [, {text} [, {cancelreturn}]]) *inputdialog()* | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4099 Like |input()|, but when the GUI is running and text dialogs |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4100 are supported, a dialog window pops up to input the text. |
7 | 4101 Example: > |
3875 | 4102 :let n = inputdialog("value for shiftwidth", shiftwidth()) |
4103 :if n != "" | |
4104 : let &sw = n | |
4105 :endif | |
7 | 4106 < When the dialog is cancelled {cancelreturn} is returned. When |
4107 omitted an empty string is returned. | |
4108 Hitting <Enter> works like pressing the OK button. Hitting | |
4109 <Esc> works like pressing the Cancel button. | |
531 | 4110 NOTE: Command-line completion is not supported. |
7 | 4111 |
519 | 4112 inputlist({textlist}) *inputlist()* |
819 | 4113 {textlist} must be a |List| of strings. This |List| is |
4114 displayed, one string per line. The user will be prompted to | |
4115 enter a number, which is returned. | |
519 | 4116 The user can also select an item by clicking on it with the |
1621 | 4117 mouse. For the first string 0 is returned. When clicking |
519 | 4118 above the first item a negative number is returned. When |
4119 clicking on the prompt one more than the length of {textlist} | |
4120 is returned. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4121 Make sure {textlist} has less than 'lines' entries, otherwise |
1621 | 4122 it won't work. It's a good idea to put the entry number at |
1156 | 4123 the start of the string. And put a prompt in the first item. |
4124 Example: > | |
519 | 4125 let color = inputlist(['Select color:', '1. red', |
4126 \ '2. green', '3. blue']) | |
4127 | |
7 | 4128 inputrestore() *inputrestore()* |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4129 Restore typeahead that was saved with a previous |inputsave()|. |
7 | 4130 Should be called the same number of times inputsave() is |
4131 called. Calling it more often is harmless though. | |
4132 Returns 1 when there is nothing to restore, 0 otherwise. | |
4133 | |
4134 inputsave() *inputsave()* | |
4135 Preserve typeahead (also from mappings) and clear it, so that | |
4136 a following prompt gets input from the user. Should be | |
4137 followed by a matching inputrestore() after the prompt. Can | |
4138 be used several times, in which case there must be just as | |
4139 many inputrestore() calls. | |
4140 Returns 1 when out of memory, 0 otherwise. | |
4141 | |
4142 inputsecret({prompt} [, {text}]) *inputsecret()* | |
4143 This function acts much like the |input()| function with but | |
4144 two exceptions: | |
4145 a) the user's response will be displayed as a sequence of | |
4146 asterisks ("*") thereby keeping the entry secret, and | |
4147 b) the user's response will not be recorded on the input | |
4148 |history| stack. | |
4149 The result is a String, which is whatever the user actually | |
4150 typed on the command-line in response to the issued prompt. | |
531 | 4151 NOTE: Command-line completion is not supported. |
7 | 4152 |
55 | 4153 insert({list}, {item} [, {idx}]) *insert()* |
685 | 4154 Insert {item} at the start of |List| {list}. |
55 | 4155 If {idx} is specified insert {item} before the item with index |
1621 | 4156 {idx}. If {idx} is zero it goes before the first item, just |
55 | 4157 like omitting {idx}. A negative {idx} is also possible, see |
4158 |list-index|. -1 inserts just before the last item. | |
685 | 4159 Returns the resulting |List|. Examples: > |
55 | 4160 :let mylist = insert([2, 3, 5], 1) |
4161 :call insert(mylist, 4, -1) | |
4162 :call insert(mylist, 6, len(mylist)) | |
82 | 4163 < The last example can be done simpler with |add()|. |
685 | 4164 Note that when {item} is a |List| it is inserted as a single |
692 | 4165 item. Use |extend()| to concatenate |Lists|. |
55 | 4166 |
3214 | 4167 invert({expr}) *invert()* |
4168 Bitwise invert. The argument is converted to a number. A | |
4169 List, Dict or Float argument causes an error. Example: > | |
4170 :let bits = invert(bits) | |
4171 | |
7 | 4172 isdirectory({directory}) *isdirectory()* |
4173 The result is a Number, which is non-zero when a directory | |
4174 with the name {directory} exists. If {directory} doesn't | |
4175 exist, or isn't a directory, the result is FALSE. {directory} | |
4176 is any expression, which is used as a String. | |
4177 | |
819 | 4178 islocked({expr}) *islocked()* *E786* |
148 | 4179 The result is a Number, which is non-zero when {expr} is the |
4180 name of a locked variable. | |
685 | 4181 {expr} must be the name of a variable, |List| item or |
4182 |Dictionary| entry, not the variable itself! Example: > | |
148 | 4183 :let alist = [0, ['a', 'b'], 2, 3] |
4184 :lockvar 1 alist | |
4185 :echo islocked('alist') " 1 | |
4186 :echo islocked('alist[1]') " 0 | |
4187 | |
4188 < When {expr} is a variable that does not exist you get an error | |
843 | 4189 message. Use |exists()| to check for existence. |
148 | 4190 |
140 | 4191 items({dict}) *items()* |
685 | 4192 Return a |List| with all the key-value pairs of {dict}. Each |
4193 |List| item is a list with two items: the key of a {dict} | |
4194 entry and the value of this entry. The |List| is in arbitrary | |
4195 order. | |
140 | 4196 |
95 | 4197 |
4198 join({list} [, {sep}]) *join()* | |
4199 Join the items in {list} together into one String. | |
4200 When {sep} is specified it is put in between the items. If | |
4201 {sep} is omitted a single space is used. | |
4202 Note that {sep} is not added at the end. You might want to | |
4203 add it there too: > | |
4204 let lines = join(mylist, "\n") . "\n" | |
692 | 4205 < String items are used as-is. |Lists| and |Dictionaries| are |
95 | 4206 converted into a string like with |string()|. |
4207 The opposite function is |split()|. | |
4208 | |
99 | 4209 keys({dict}) *keys()* |
685 | 4210 Return a |List| with all the keys of {dict}. The |List| is in |
99 | 4211 arbitrary order. |
4212 | |
85 | 4213 *len()* *E701* |
55 | 4214 len({expr}) The result is a Number, which is the length of the argument. |
4215 When {expr} is a String or a Number the length in bytes is | |
4216 used, as with |strlen()|. | |
685 | 4217 When {expr} is a |List| the number of items in the |List| is |
55 | 4218 returned. |
685 | 4219 When {expr} is a |Dictionary| the number of entries in the |
4220 |Dictionary| is returned. | |
55 | 4221 Otherwise an error is given. |
4222 | |
7 | 4223 *libcall()* *E364* *E368* |
4224 libcall({libname}, {funcname}, {argument}) | |
4225 Call function {funcname} in the run-time library {libname} | |
4226 with single argument {argument}. | |
4227 This is useful to call functions in a library that you | |
4228 especially made to be used with Vim. Since only one argument | |
4229 is possible, calling standard library functions is rather | |
4230 limited. | |
4231 The result is the String returned by the function. If the | |
4232 function returns NULL, this will appear as an empty string "" | |
4233 to Vim. | |
4234 If the function returns a number, use libcallnr()! | |
4235 If {argument} is a number, it is passed to the function as an | |
4236 int; if {argument} is a string, it is passed as a | |
4237 null-terminated string. | |
4238 This function will fail in |restricted-mode|. | |
4239 | |
4240 libcall() allows you to write your own 'plug-in' extensions to | |
4241 Vim without having to recompile the program. It is NOT a | |
4242 means to call system functions! If you try to do so Vim will | |
4243 very probably crash. | |
4244 | |
4245 For Win32, the functions you write must be placed in a DLL | |
4246 and use the normal C calling convention (NOT Pascal which is | |
4247 used in Windows System DLLs). The function must take exactly | |
4248 one parameter, either a character pointer or a long integer, | |
4249 and must return a character pointer or NULL. The character | |
4250 pointer returned must point to memory that will remain valid | |
4251 after the function has returned (e.g. in static data in the | |
4252 DLL). If it points to allocated memory, that memory will | |
4253 leak away. Using a static buffer in the function should work, | |
4254 it's then freed when the DLL is unloaded. | |
4255 | |
4256 WARNING: If the function returns a non-valid pointer, Vim may | |
1621 | 4257 crash! This also happens if the function returns a number, |
7 | 4258 because Vim thinks it's a pointer. |
4259 For Win32 systems, {libname} should be the filename of the DLL | |
4260 without the ".DLL" suffix. A full path is only required if | |
4261 the DLL is not in the usual places. | |
4262 For Unix: When compiling your own plugins, remember that the | |
4263 object code must be compiled as position-independent ('PIC'). | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4264 {only in Win32 and some Unix versions, when the |+libcall| |
7 | 4265 feature is present} |
4266 Examples: > | |
4267 :echo libcall("libc.so", "getenv", "HOME") | |
4268 < | |
4269 *libcallnr()* | |
4270 libcallnr({libname}, {funcname}, {argument}) | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4271 Just like |libcall()|, but used for a function that returns an |
7 | 4272 int instead of a string. |
4273 {only in Win32 on some Unix versions, when the |+libcall| | |
4274 feature is present} | |
1621 | 4275 Examples: > |
4276 :echo libcallnr("/usr/lib/libc.so", "getpid", "") | |
7 | 4277 :call libcallnr("libc.so", "printf", "Hello World!\n") |
4278 :call libcallnr("libc.so", "sleep", 10) | |
4279 < | |
4280 *line()* | |
4281 line({expr}) The result is a Number, which is the line number of the file | |
4282 position given with {expr}. The accepted positions are: | |
4283 . the cursor position | |
4284 $ the last line in the current buffer | |
4285 'x position of mark x (if the mark is not set, 0 is | |
4286 returned) | |
665 | 4287 w0 first line visible in current window |
4288 w$ last line visible in current window | |
1609 | 4289 v In Visual mode: the start of the Visual area (the |
4290 cursor is the end). When not in Visual mode | |
4291 returns the cursor position. Differs from |'<| in | |
4292 that it's updated right away. | |
1156 | 4293 Note that a mark in another file can be used. The line number |
4294 then applies to another buffer. | |
703 | 4295 To get the column number use |col()|. To get both use |
4296 |getpos()|. | |
7 | 4297 Examples: > |
4298 line(".") line number of the cursor | |
4299 line("'t") line number of mark t | |
4300 line("'" . marker) line number of mark marker | |
4301 < *last-position-jump* | |
4302 This autocommand jumps to the last known position in a file | |
4303 just after opening it, if the '" mark is set: > | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4304 :au BufReadPost * if line("'\"") > 1 && line("'\"") <= line("$") | exe "normal! g`\"" | endif |
9 | 4305 |
7 | 4306 line2byte({lnum}) *line2byte()* |
4307 Return the byte count from the start of the buffer for line | |
4308 {lnum}. This includes the end-of-line character, depending on | |
4309 the 'fileformat' option for the current buffer. The first | |
3237 | 4310 line returns 1. 'encoding' matters, 'fileencoding' is ignored. |
7 | 4311 This can also be used to get the byte count for the line just |
4312 below the last line: > | |
4313 line2byte(line("$") + 1) | |
3237 | 4314 < This is the buffer size plus one. If 'fileencoding' is empty |
4315 it is the file size plus one. | |
7 | 4316 When {lnum} is invalid, or the |+byte_offset| feature has been |
4317 disabled at compile time, -1 is returned. | |
4318 Also see |byte2line()|, |go| and |:goto|. | |
4319 | |
4320 lispindent({lnum}) *lispindent()* | |
4321 Get the amount of indent for line {lnum} according the lisp | |
4322 indenting rules, as with 'lisp'. | |
4323 The indent is counted in spaces, the value of 'tabstop' is | |
4324 relevant. {lnum} is used just like in |getline()|. | |
4325 When {lnum} is invalid or Vim was not compiled the | |
4326 |+lispindent| feature, -1 is returned. | |
4327 | |
4328 localtime() *localtime()* | |
4329 Return the current time, measured as seconds since 1st Jan | |
4330 1970. See also |strftime()| and |getftime()|. | |
4331 | |
95 | 4332 |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
4333 log({expr}) *log()* |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
4334 Return the natural logarithm (base e) of {expr} as a |Float|. |
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
4335 {expr} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number| in the range |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
4336 (0, inf]. |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
4337 Examples: > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
4338 :echo log(10) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
4339 < 2.302585 > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
4340 :echo log(exp(5)) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
4341 < 5.0 |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2569
diff
changeset
|
4342 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
4343 |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
4344 |
1621 | 4345 log10({expr}) *log10()* |
4346 Return the logarithm of Float {expr} to base 10 as a |Float|. | |
4347 {expr} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number|. | |
4348 Examples: > | |
4349 :echo log10(1000) | |
4350 < 3.0 > | |
4351 :echo log10(0.01) | |
4352 < -2.0 | |
4353 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} | |
4354 | |
3492 | 4355 luaeval({expr}[, {expr}]) *luaeval()* |
4356 Evaluate Lua expression {expr} and return its result converted | |
4357 to Vim data structures. Second {expr} may hold additional | |
4358 argument accessible as _A inside first {expr}. | |
4359 Strings are returned as they are. | |
4360 Boolean objects are converted to numbers. | |
4361 Numbers are converted to |Float| values if vim was compiled | |
4362 with |+float| and to numbers otherwise. | |
4363 Dictionaries and lists obtained by vim.eval() are returned | |
4364 as-is. | |
4365 Other objects are returned as zero without any errors. | |
4366 See |lua-luaeval| for more details. | |
4367 {only available when compiled with the |+lua| feature} | |
4368 | |
102 | 4369 map({expr}, {string}) *map()* |
685 | 4370 {expr} must be a |List| or a |Dictionary|. |
102 | 4371 Replace each item in {expr} with the result of evaluating |
4372 {string}. | |
4373 Inside {string} |v:val| has the value of the current item. | |
1998 | 4374 For a |Dictionary| |v:key| has the key of the current item |
4375 and for a |List| |v:key| has the index of the current item. | |
102 | 4376 Example: > |
4377 :call map(mylist, '"> " . v:val . " <"') | |
95 | 4378 < This puts "> " before and " <" after each item in "mylist". |
102 | 4379 |
158 | 4380 Note that {string} is the result of an expression and is then |
102 | 4381 used as an expression again. Often it is good to use a |
158 | 4382 |literal-string| to avoid having to double backslashes. You |
4383 still have to double ' quotes | |
102 | 4384 |
685 | 4385 The operation is done in-place. If you want a |List| or |
4386 |Dictionary| to remain unmodified make a copy first: > | |
3682 | 4387 :let tlist = map(copy(mylist), ' v:val . "\t"') |
102 | 4388 |
685 | 4389 < Returns {expr}, the |List| or |Dictionary| that was filtered. |
648 | 4390 When an error is encountered while evaluating {string} no |
4391 further items in {expr} are processed. | |
95 | 4392 |
4393 | |
2610 | 4394 maparg({name}[, {mode} [, {abbr} [, {dict}]]]) *maparg()* |
4395 When {dict} is omitted or zero: Return the rhs of mapping | |
4396 {name} in mode {mode}. The returned String has special | |
4397 characters translated like in the output of the ":map" command | |
4398 listing. | |
4399 | |
4400 When there is no mapping for {name}, an empty String is | |
4401 returned. | |
4402 | |
4403 The {name} can have special key names, like in the ":map" | |
4404 command. | |
4405 | |
644 | 4406 {mode} can be one of these strings: |
7 | 4407 "n" Normal |
2610 | 4408 "v" Visual (including Select) |
7 | 4409 "o" Operator-pending |
4410 "i" Insert | |
4411 "c" Cmd-line | |
2610 | 4412 "s" Select |
4413 "x" Visual | |
7 | 4414 "l" langmap |language-mapping| |
4415 "" Normal, Visual and Operator-pending | |
644 | 4416 When {mode} is omitted, the modes for "" are used. |
2610 | 4417 |
782 | 4418 When {abbr} is there and it is non-zero use abbreviations |
4419 instead of mappings. | |
2610 | 4420 |
4421 When {dict} is there and it is non-zero return a dictionary | |
4422 containing all the information of the mapping with the | |
4423 following items: | |
4424 "lhs" The {lhs} of the mapping. | |
4425 "rhs" The {rhs} of the mapping as typed. | |
4426 "silent" 1 for a |:map-silent| mapping, else 0. | |
2625 | 4427 "noremap" 1 if the {rhs} of the mapping is not remappable. |
2610 | 4428 "expr" 1 for an expression mapping (|:map-<expr>|). |
4429 "buffer" 1 for a buffer local mapping (|:map-local|). | |
4430 "mode" Modes for which the mapping is defined. In | |
4431 addition to the modes mentioned above, these | |
4432 characters will be used: | |
4433 " " Normal, Visual and Operator-pending | |
4434 "!" Insert and Commandline mode | |
2642 | 4435 (|mapmode-ic|) |
2625 | 4436 "sid" The script local ID, used for <sid> mappings |
4437 (|<SID>|). | |
5555 | 4438 "nowait" Do not wait for other, longer mappings. |
4439 (|:map-<nowait>|). | |
2610 | 4440 |
7 | 4441 The mappings local to the current buffer are checked first, |
4442 then the global mappings. | |
626 | 4443 This function can be used to map a key even when it's already |
4444 mapped, and have it do the original mapping too. Sketch: > | |
4445 exe 'nnoremap <Tab> ==' . maparg('<Tab>', 'n') | |
4446 | |
7 | 4447 |
782 | 4448 mapcheck({name}[, {mode} [, {abbr}]]) *mapcheck()* |
7 | 4449 Check if there is a mapping that matches with {name} in mode |
4450 {mode}. See |maparg()| for {mode} and special names in | |
4451 {name}. | |
782 | 4452 When {abbr} is there and it is non-zero use abbreviations |
4453 instead of mappings. | |
7 | 4454 A match happens with a mapping that starts with {name} and |
4455 with a mapping which is equal to the start of {name}. | |
4456 | |
1621 | 4457 matches mapping "a" "ab" "abc" ~ |
7 | 4458 mapcheck("a") yes yes yes |
4459 mapcheck("abc") yes yes yes | |
4460 mapcheck("ax") yes no no | |
4461 mapcheck("b") no no no | |
4462 | |
4463 The difference with maparg() is that mapcheck() finds a | |
4464 mapping that matches with {name}, while maparg() only finds a | |
4465 mapping for {name} exactly. | |
4466 When there is no mapping that starts with {name}, an empty | |
4467 String is returned. If there is one, the rhs of that mapping | |
4468 is returned. If there are several mappings that start with | |
4469 {name}, the rhs of one of them is returned. | |
4470 The mappings local to the current buffer are checked first, | |
4471 then the global mappings. | |
4472 This function can be used to check if a mapping can be added | |
4473 without being ambiguous. Example: > | |
4474 :if mapcheck("_vv") == "" | |
4475 : map _vv :set guifont=7x13<CR> | |
4476 :endif | |
4477 < This avoids adding the "_vv" mapping when there already is a | |
4478 mapping for "_v" or for "_vvv". | |
4479 | |
19 | 4480 match({expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) *match()* |
685 | 4481 When {expr} is a |List| then this returns the index of the |
4482 first item where {pat} matches. Each item is used as a | |
692 | 4483 String, |Lists| and |Dictionaries| are used as echoed. |
1621 | 4484 Otherwise, {expr} is used as a String. The result is a |
95 | 4485 Number, which gives the index (byte offset) in {expr} where |
4486 {pat} matches. | |
685 | 4487 A match at the first character or |List| item returns zero. |
19 | 4488 If there is no match -1 is returned. |
2833 | 4489 For getting submatches see |matchlist()|. |
19 | 4490 Example: > |
95 | 4491 :echo match("testing", "ing") " results in 4 |
714 | 4492 :echo match([1, 'x'], '\a') " results in 1 |
95 | 4493 < See |string-match| for how {pat} is used. |
170 | 4494 *strpbrk()* |
1621 | 4495 Vim doesn't have a strpbrk() function. But you can do: > |
170 | 4496 :let sepidx = match(line, '[.,;: \t]') |
4497 < *strcasestr()* | |
4498 Vim doesn't have a strcasestr() function. But you can add | |
4499 "\c" to the pattern to ignore case: > | |
4500 :let idx = match(haystack, '\cneedle') | |
4501 < | |
95 | 4502 If {start} is given, the search starts from byte index |
685 | 4503 {start} in a String or item {start} in a |List|. |
7 | 4504 The result, however, is still the index counted from the |
236 | 4505 first character/item. Example: > |
7 | 4506 :echo match("testing", "ing", 2) |
4507 < result is again "4". > | |
4508 :echo match("testing", "ing", 4) | |
4509 < result is again "4". > | |
4510 :echo match("testing", "t", 2) | |
4511 < result is "3". | |
694 | 4512 For a String, if {start} > 0 then it is like the string starts |
703 | 4513 {start} bytes later, thus "^" will match at {start}. Except |
4514 when {count} is given, then it's like matches before the | |
4515 {start} byte are ignored (this is a bit complicated to keep it | |
4516 backwards compatible). | |
95 | 4517 For a String, if {start} < 0, it will be set to 0. For a list |
4518 the index is counted from the end. | |
697 | 4519 If {start} is out of range ({start} > strlen({expr}) for a |
4520 String or {start} > len({expr}) for a |List|) -1 is returned. | |
95 | 4521 |
694 | 4522 When {count} is given use the {count}'th match. When a match |
697 | 4523 is found in a String the search for the next one starts one |
694 | 4524 character further. Thus this example results in 1: > |
4525 echo match("testing", "..", 0, 2) | |
4526 < In a |List| the search continues in the next item. | |
703 | 4527 Note that when {count} is added the way {start} works changes, |
4528 see above. | |
694 | 4529 |
7 | 4530 See |pattern| for the patterns that are accepted. |
4531 The 'ignorecase' option is used to set the ignore-caseness of | |
1621 | 4532 the pattern. 'smartcase' is NOT used. The matching is always |
7 | 4533 done like 'magic' is set and 'cpoptions' is empty. |
4534 | |
1326 | 4535 *matchadd()* *E798* *E799* *E801* |
6951
b2673982c625
Updated and new runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
6947
diff
changeset
|
4536 matchadd({group}, {pattern}[, {priority}[, {id} [, {dict}]]]) |
1326 | 4537 Defines a pattern to be highlighted in the current window (a |
4538 "match"). It will be highlighted with {group}. Returns an | |
4539 identification number (ID), which can be used to delete the | |
4540 match using |matchdelete()|. | |
5466 | 4541 Matching is case sensitive and magic, unless case sensitivity |
4542 or magicness are explicitly overridden in {pattern}. The | |
4543 'magic', 'smartcase' and 'ignorecase' options are not used. | |
6951
b2673982c625
Updated and new runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
6947
diff
changeset
|
4544 The "Conceal" value is special, it causes the match to be |
b2673982c625
Updated and new runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
6947
diff
changeset
|
4545 concealed. |
1326 | 4546 |
4547 The optional {priority} argument assigns a priority to the | |
1621 | 4548 match. A match with a high priority will have its |
1326 | 4549 highlighting overrule that of a match with a lower priority. |
4550 A priority is specified as an integer (negative numbers are no | |
4551 exception). If the {priority} argument is not specified, the | |
4552 default priority is 10. The priority of 'hlsearch' is zero, | |
4553 hence all matches with a priority greater than zero will | |
4554 overrule it. Syntax highlighting (see 'syntax') is a separate | |
4555 mechanism, and regardless of the chosen priority a match will | |
4556 always overrule syntax highlighting. | |
4557 | |
4558 The optional {id} argument allows the request for a specific | |
4559 match ID. If a specified ID is already taken, an error | |
4560 message will appear and the match will not be added. An ID | |
4561 is specified as a positive integer (zero excluded). IDs 1, 2 | |
4562 and 3 are reserved for |:match|, |:2match| and |:3match|, | |
6947 | 4563 respectively. If the {id} argument is not specified or -1, |
1326 | 4564 |matchadd()| automatically chooses a free ID. |
4565 | |
7659
07f11de5efca
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/85084ef1e999dcf50e8d466106a33bac24a0febb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7653
diff
changeset
|
4566 The optional {dict} argument allows for further custom |
07f11de5efca
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/85084ef1e999dcf50e8d466106a33bac24a0febb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7653
diff
changeset
|
4567 values. Currently this is used to specify a match specific |
6947 | 4568 conceal character that will be shown for |hl-Conceal| |
4569 highlighted matches. The dict can have the following members: | |
4570 | |
4571 conceal Special character to show instead of the | |
4572 match (only for |hl-Conceal| highlighed | |
4573 matches, see |:syn-cchar|) | |
4574 | |
1326 | 4575 The number of matches is not limited, as it is the case with |
4576 the |:match| commands. | |
4577 | |
4578 Example: > | |
4579 :highlight MyGroup ctermbg=green guibg=green | |
4580 :let m = matchadd("MyGroup", "TODO") | |
4581 < Deletion of the pattern: > | |
4582 :call matchdelete(m) | |
4583 | |
4584 < A list of matches defined by |matchadd()| and |:match| are | |
1621 | 4585 available from |getmatches()|. All matches can be deleted in |
1326 | 4586 one operation by |clearmatches()|. |
819 | 4587 |
6947 | 4588 matchaddpos({group}, {pos}[, {priority}[, {id}[, {dict}]]]) *matchaddpos()* |
5979 | 4589 Same as |matchadd()|, but requires a list of positions {pos} |
4590 instead of a pattern. This command is faster than |matchadd()| | |
4591 because it does not require to handle regular expressions and | |
4592 sets buffer line boundaries to redraw screen. It is supposed | |
4593 to be used when fast match additions and deletions are | |
4594 required, for example to highlight matching parentheses. | |
4595 | |
4596 The list {pos} can contain one of these items: | |
6007 | 4597 - A number. This whole line will be highlighted. The first |
5979 | 4598 line has number 1. |
4599 - A list with one number, e.g., [23]. The whole line with this | |
4600 number will be highlighted. | |
4601 - A list with two numbers, e.g., [23, 11]. The first number is | |
6007 | 4602 the line number, the second one is the column number (first |
4603 column is 1, the value must correspond to the byte index as | |
4604 |col()| would return). The character at this position will | |
4605 be highlighted. | |
5979 | 4606 - A list with three numbers, e.g., [23, 11, 3]. As above, but |
6007 | 4607 the third number gives the length of the highlight in bytes. |
5979 | 4608 |
4609 The maximum number of positions is 8. | |
4610 | |
4611 Example: > | |
4612 :highlight MyGroup ctermbg=green guibg=green | |
4613 :let m = matchaddpos("MyGroup", [[23, 24], 34]) | |
4614 < Deletion of the pattern: > | |
4615 :call matchdelete(m) | |
4616 | |
4617 < Matches added by |matchaddpos()| are returned by | |
4618 |getmatches()| with an entry "pos1", "pos2", etc., with the | |
4619 value a list like the {pos} item. | |
4620 These matches cannot be set via |setmatches()|, however they | |
4621 can still be deleted by |clearmatches()|. | |
4622 | |
819 | 4623 matcharg({nr}) *matcharg()* |
856 | 4624 Selects the {nr} match item, as set with a |:match|, |
819 | 4625 |:2match| or |:3match| command. |
4626 Return a |List| with two elements: | |
4627 The name of the highlight group used | |
4628 The pattern used. | |
4629 When {nr} is not 1, 2 or 3 returns an empty |List|. | |
4630 When there is no match item set returns ['', '']. | |
1326 | 4631 This is useful to save and restore a |:match|. |
4632 Highlighting matches using the |:match| commands are limited | |
4633 to three matches. |matchadd()| does not have this limitation. | |
4634 | |
4635 matchdelete({id}) *matchdelete()* *E802* *E803* | |
4636 Deletes a match with ID {id} previously defined by |matchadd()| | |
1621 | 4637 or one of the |:match| commands. Returns 0 if successful, |
1326 | 4638 otherwise -1. See example for |matchadd()|. All matches can |
4639 be deleted in one operation by |clearmatches()|. | |
819 | 4640 |
19 | 4641 matchend({expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) *matchend()* |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4642 Same as |match()|, but return the index of first character |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4643 after the match. Example: > |
7 | 4644 :echo matchend("testing", "ing") |
4645 < results in "7". | |
170 | 4646 *strspn()* *strcspn()* |
4647 Vim doesn't have a strspn() or strcspn() function, but you can | |
4648 do it with matchend(): > | |
4649 :let span = matchend(line, '[a-zA-Z]') | |
4650 :let span = matchend(line, '[^a-zA-Z]') | |
4651 < Except that -1 is returned when there are no matches. | |
4652 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4653 The {start}, if given, has the same meaning as for |match()|. > |
7 | 4654 :echo matchend("testing", "ing", 2) |
4655 < results in "7". > | |
4656 :echo matchend("testing", "ing", 5) | |
4657 < result is "-1". | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4658 When {expr} is a |List| the result is equal to |match()|. |
7 | 4659 |
158 | 4660 matchlist({expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) *matchlist()* |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4661 Same as |match()|, but return a |List|. The first item in the |
158 | 4662 list is the matched string, same as what matchstr() would |
4663 return. Following items are submatches, like "\1", "\2", etc. | |
842 | 4664 in |:substitute|. When an optional submatch didn't match an |
4665 empty string is used. Example: > | |
4666 echo matchlist('acd', '\(a\)\?\(b\)\?\(c\)\?\(.*\)') | |
4667 < Results in: ['acd', 'a', '', 'c', 'd', '', '', '', '', ''] | |
158 | 4668 When there is no match an empty list is returned. |
4669 | |
19 | 4670 matchstr({expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) *matchstr()* |
1621 | 4671 Same as |match()|, but return the matched string. Example: > |
7 | 4672 :echo matchstr("testing", "ing") |
4673 < results in "ing". | |
4674 When there is no match "" is returned. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
4675 The {start}, if given, has the same meaning as for |match()|. > |
7 | 4676 :echo matchstr("testing", "ing", 2) |
4677 < results in "ing". > | |
4678 :echo matchstr("testing", "ing", 5) | |
4679 < result is "". | |
685 | 4680 When {expr} is a |List| then the matching item is returned. |
95 | 4681 The type isn't changed, it's not necessarily a String. |
7 | 4682 |
87 | 4683 *max()* |
4684 max({list}) Return the maximum value of all items in {list}. | |
4685 If {list} is not a list or one of the items in {list} cannot | |
4686 be used as a Number this results in an error. | |
685 | 4687 An empty |List| results in zero. |
87 | 4688 |
4689 *min()* | |
1215 | 4690 min({list}) Return the minimum value of all items in {list}. |
87 | 4691 If {list} is not a list or one of the items in {list} cannot |
4692 be used as a Number this results in an error. | |
685 | 4693 An empty |List| results in zero. |
87 | 4694 |
843 | 4695 *mkdir()* *E739* |
168 | 4696 mkdir({name} [, {path} [, {prot}]]) |
4697 Create directory {name}. | |
4698 If {path} is "p" then intermediate directories are created as | |
4699 necessary. Otherwise it must be "". | |
4700 If {prot} is given it is used to set the protection bits of | |
4701 the new directory. The default is 0755 (rwxr-xr-x: r/w for | |
1621 | 4702 the user readable for others). Use 0700 to make it unreadable |
1702 | 4703 for others. This is only used for the last part of {name}. |
4704 Thus if you create /tmp/foo/bar then /tmp/foo will be created | |
4705 with 0755. | |
4706 Example: > | |
4707 :call mkdir($HOME . "/tmp/foo/bar", "p", 0700) | |
4708 < This function is not available in the |sandbox|. | |
168 | 4709 Not available on all systems. To check use: > |
4710 :if exists("*mkdir") | |
4711 < | |
7 | 4712 *mode()* |
1621 | 4713 mode([expr]) Return a string that indicates the current mode. |
1661 | 4714 If [expr] is supplied and it evaluates to a non-zero Number or |
4715 a non-empty String (|non-zero-arg|), then the full mode is | |
4716 returned, otherwise only the first letter is returned. Note | |
4717 that " " and "0" are also non-empty strings. | |
1621 | 4718 |
7 | 4719 n Normal |
1621 | 4720 no Operator-pending |
7 | 4721 v Visual by character |
4722 V Visual by line | |
4723 CTRL-V Visual blockwise | |
4724 s Select by character | |
4725 S Select by line | |
4726 CTRL-S Select blockwise | |
4727 i Insert | |
1621 | 4728 R Replace |R| |
4729 Rv Virtual Replace |gR| | |
7 | 4730 c Command-line |
1621 | 4731 cv Vim Ex mode |gQ| |
4732 ce Normal Ex mode |Q| | |
7 | 4733 r Hit-enter prompt |
1621 | 4734 rm The -- more -- prompt |
4735 r? A |:confirm| query of some sort | |
4736 ! Shell or external command is executing | |
4737 This is useful in the 'statusline' option or when used | |
4738 with |remote_expr()| In most other places it always returns | |
4739 "c" or "n". | |
4740 Also see |visualmode()|. | |
7 | 4741 |
2050
afcf9db31561
updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2033
diff
changeset
|
4742 mzeval({expr}) *mzeval()* |
afcf9db31561
updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2033
diff
changeset
|
4743 Evaluate MzScheme expression {expr} and return its result |
3492 | 4744 converted to Vim data structures. |
2050
afcf9db31561
updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2033
diff
changeset
|
4745 Numbers and strings are returned as they are. |
afcf9db31561
updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2033
diff
changeset
|
4746 Pairs (including lists and improper lists) and vectors are |
afcf9db31561
updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2033
diff
changeset
|
4747 returned as Vim |Lists|. |
afcf9db31561
updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2033
diff
changeset
|
4748 Hash tables are represented as Vim |Dictionary| type with keys |
afcf9db31561
updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2033
diff
changeset
|
4749 converted to strings. |
afcf9db31561
updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2033
diff
changeset
|
4750 All other types are converted to string with display function. |
afcf9db31561
updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2033
diff
changeset
|
4751 Examples: > |
afcf9db31561
updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2033
diff
changeset
|
4752 :mz (define l (list 1 2 3)) |
afcf9db31561
updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2033
diff
changeset
|
4753 :mz (define h (make-hash)) (hash-set! h "list" l) |
afcf9db31561
updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2033
diff
changeset
|
4754 :echo mzeval("l") |
afcf9db31561
updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2033
diff
changeset
|
4755 :echo mzeval("h") |
afcf9db31561
updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2033
diff
changeset
|
4756 < |
afcf9db31561
updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2033
diff
changeset
|
4757 {only available when compiled with the |+mzscheme| feature} |
afcf9db31561
updated for version 7.2.336
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2033
diff
changeset
|
4758 |
7 | 4759 nextnonblank({lnum}) *nextnonblank()* |
4760 Return the line number of the first line at or below {lnum} | |
4761 that is not blank. Example: > | |
4762 if getline(nextnonblank(1)) =~ "Java" | |
4763 < When {lnum} is invalid or there is no non-blank line at or | |
4764 below it, zero is returned. | |
4765 See also |prevnonblank()|. | |
4766 | |
4051 | 4767 nr2char({expr}[, {utf8}]) *nr2char()* |
7 | 4768 Return a string with a single character, which has the number |
4769 value {expr}. Examples: > | |
4770 nr2char(64) returns "@" | |
4771 nr2char(32) returns " " | |
4051 | 4772 < When {utf8} is omitted or zero, the current 'encoding' is used. |
4773 Example for "utf-8": > | |
7 | 4774 nr2char(300) returns I with bow character |
4051 | 4775 < With {utf8} set to 1, always return utf-8 characters. |
4776 Note that a NUL character in the file is specified with | |
7 | 4777 nr2char(10), because NULs are represented with newline |
4778 characters. nr2char(0) is a real NUL and terminates the | |
119 | 4779 string, thus results in an empty string. |
7 | 4780 |
3214 | 4781 or({expr}, {expr}) *or()* |
4782 Bitwise OR on the two arguments. The arguments are converted | |
4783 to a number. A List, Dict or Float argument causes an error. | |
4784 Example: > | |
4785 :let bits = or(bits, 0x80) | |
4786 | |
4787 | |
819 | 4788 pathshorten({expr}) *pathshorten()* |
4789 Shorten directory names in the path {expr} and return the | |
4790 result. The tail, the file name, is kept as-is. The other | |
4791 components in the path are reduced to single letters. Leading | |
4792 '~' and '.' characters are kept. Example: > | |
4793 :echo pathshorten('~/.vim/autoload/myfile.vim') | |
4794 < ~/.v/a/myfile.vim ~ | |
4795 It doesn't matter if the path exists or not. | |
4796 | |
7651
c7575b07de98
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e9b892ebcd8596bf813793a1eed5a460a9495a28
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7629
diff
changeset
|
4797 perleval({expr}) *perleval()* |
c7575b07de98
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e9b892ebcd8596bf813793a1eed5a460a9495a28
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7629
diff
changeset
|
4798 Evaluate Perl expression {expr} in scalar context and return |
c7575b07de98
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e9b892ebcd8596bf813793a1eed5a460a9495a28
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7629
diff
changeset
|
4799 its result converted to Vim data structures. If value can't be |
7659
07f11de5efca
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/85084ef1e999dcf50e8d466106a33bac24a0febb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7653
diff
changeset
|
4800 converted, it is returned as a string Perl representation. |
07f11de5efca
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/85084ef1e999dcf50e8d466106a33bac24a0febb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7653
diff
changeset
|
4801 Note: If you want an array or hash, {expr} must return a |
07f11de5efca
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/85084ef1e999dcf50e8d466106a33bac24a0febb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7653
diff
changeset
|
4802 reference to it. |
7651
c7575b07de98
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e9b892ebcd8596bf813793a1eed5a460a9495a28
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7629
diff
changeset
|
4803 Example: > |
c7575b07de98
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e9b892ebcd8596bf813793a1eed5a460a9495a28
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7629
diff
changeset
|
4804 :echo perleval('[1 .. 4]') |
c7575b07de98
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e9b892ebcd8596bf813793a1eed5a460a9495a28
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7629
diff
changeset
|
4805 < [1, 2, 3, 4] |
c7575b07de98
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e9b892ebcd8596bf813793a1eed5a460a9495a28
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7629
diff
changeset
|
4806 {only available when compiled with the |+perl| feature} |
c7575b07de98
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e9b892ebcd8596bf813793a1eed5a460a9495a28
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7629
diff
changeset
|
4807 |
1621 | 4808 pow({x}, {y}) *pow()* |
4809 Return the power of {x} to the exponent {y} as a |Float|. | |
4810 {x} and {y} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number|. | |
4811 Examples: > | |
4812 :echo pow(3, 3) | |
4813 < 27.0 > | |
4814 :echo pow(2, 16) | |
4815 < 65536.0 > | |
4816 :echo pow(32, 0.20) | |
4817 < 2.0 | |
4818 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} | |
4819 | |
667 | 4820 prevnonblank({lnum}) *prevnonblank()* |
4821 Return the line number of the first line at or above {lnum} | |
4822 that is not blank. Example: > | |
4823 let ind = indent(prevnonblank(v:lnum - 1)) | |
4824 < When {lnum} is invalid or there is no non-blank line at or | |
4825 above it, zero is returned. | |
4826 Also see |nextnonblank()|. | |
4827 | |
4828 | |
449 | 4829 printf({fmt}, {expr1} ...) *printf()* |
4830 Return a String with {fmt}, where "%" items are replaced by | |
4831 the formatted form of their respective arguments. Example: > | |
452 | 4832 printf("%4d: E%d %.30s", lnum, errno, msg) |
449 | 4833 < May result in: |
452 | 4834 " 99: E42 asdfasdfasdfasdfasdfasdfasdfas" ~ |
449 | 4835 |
4836 Often used items are: | |
856 | 4837 %s string |
3914 | 4838 %6S string right-aligned in 6 display cells |
653 | 4839 %6s string right-aligned in 6 bytes |
1621 | 4840 %.9s string truncated to 9 bytes |
4841 %c single byte | |
4842 %d decimal number | |
4843 %5d decimal number padded with spaces to 5 characters | |
4844 %x hex number | |
4845 %04x hex number padded with zeros to at least 4 characters | |
4846 %X hex number using upper case letters | |
4847 %o octal number | |
4848 %f floating point number in the form 123.456 | |
4849 %e floating point number in the form 1.234e3 | |
4850 %E floating point number in the form 1.234E3 | |
4851 %g floating point number, as %f or %e depending on value | |
4852 %G floating point number, as %f or %E depending on value | |
4853 %% the % character itself | |
449 | 4854 |
4855 Conversion specifications start with '%' and end with the | |
4856 conversion type. All other characters are copied unchanged to | |
4857 the result. | |
4858 | |
4859 The "%" starts a conversion specification. The following | |
452 | 4860 arguments appear in sequence: |
4861 | |
4862 % [flags] [field-width] [.precision] type | |
4863 | |
856 | 4864 flags |
452 | 4865 Zero or more of the following flags: |
4866 | |
449 | 4867 # The value should be converted to an "alternate |
4868 form". For c, d, and s conversions, this option | |
4869 has no effect. For o conversions, the precision | |
4870 of the number is increased to force the first | |
4871 character of the output string to a zero (except | |
4872 if a zero value is printed with an explicit | |
4873 precision of zero). | |
4874 For x and X conversions, a non-zero result has | |
4875 the string "0x" (or "0X" for X conversions) | |
4876 prepended to it. | |
452 | 4877 |
449 | 4878 0 (zero) Zero padding. For all conversions the converted |
4879 value is padded on the left with zeros rather | |
4880 than blanks. If a precision is given with a | |
4881 numeric conversion (d, o, x, and X), the 0 flag | |
4882 is ignored. | |
452 | 4883 |
449 | 4884 - A negative field width flag; the converted value |
4885 is to be left adjusted on the field boundary. | |
4886 The converted value is padded on the right with | |
4887 blanks, rather than on the left with blanks or | |
4888 zeros. A - overrides a 0 if both are given. | |
452 | 4889 |
449 | 4890 ' ' (space) A blank should be left before a positive |
4891 number produced by a signed conversion (d). | |
452 | 4892 |
449 | 4893 + A sign must always be placed before a number |
1621 | 4894 produced by a signed conversion. A + overrides |
449 | 4895 a space if both are used. |
452 | 4896 |
4897 field-width | |
4898 An optional decimal digit string specifying a minimum | |
653 | 4899 field width. If the converted value has fewer bytes |
4900 than the field width, it will be padded with spaces on | |
4901 the left (or right, if the left-adjustment flag has | |
4902 been given) to fill out the field width. | |
452 | 4903 |
4904 .precision | |
4905 An optional precision, in the form of a period '.' | |
4906 followed by an optional digit string. If the digit | |
4907 string is omitted, the precision is taken as zero. | |
4908 This gives the minimum number of digits to appear for | |
4909 d, o, x, and X conversions, or the maximum number of | |
653 | 4910 bytes to be printed from a string for s conversions. |
1621 | 4911 For floating point it is the number of digits after |
4912 the decimal point. | |
452 | 4913 |
4914 type | |
4915 A character that specifies the type of conversion to | |
4916 be applied, see below. | |
4917 | |
449 | 4918 A field width or precision, or both, may be indicated by an |
4919 asterisk '*' instead of a digit string. In this case, a | |
1621 | 4920 Number argument supplies the field width or precision. A |
449 | 4921 negative field width is treated as a left adjustment flag |
4922 followed by a positive field width; a negative precision is | |
4923 treated as though it were missing. Example: > | |
452 | 4924 :echo printf("%d: %.*s", nr, width, line) |
449 | 4925 < This limits the length of the text used from "line" to |
452 | 4926 "width" bytes. |
449 | 4927 |
856 | 4928 The conversion specifiers and their meanings are: |
452 | 4929 |
1621 | 4930 *printf-d* *printf-o* *printf-x* *printf-X* |
4931 doxX The Number argument is converted to signed decimal | |
449 | 4932 (d), unsigned octal (o), or unsigned hexadecimal (x |
4933 and X) notation. The letters "abcdef" are used for | |
4934 x conversions; the letters "ABCDEF" are used for X | |
452 | 4935 conversions. |
4936 The precision, if any, gives the minimum number of | |
4937 digits that must appear; if the converted value | |
4938 requires fewer digits, it is padded on the left with | |
4939 zeros. | |
4940 In no case does a non-existent or small field width | |
4941 cause truncation of a numeric field; if the result of | |
4942 a conversion is wider than the field width, the field | |
4943 is expanded to contain the conversion result. | |
4944 | |
1621 | 4945 *printf-c* |
452 | 4946 c The Number argument is converted to a byte, and the |
4947 resulting character is written. | |
4948 | |
1621 | 4949 *printf-s* |
452 | 4950 s The text of the String argument is used. If a |
4951 precision is specified, no more bytes than the number | |
4952 specified are used. | |
6583 | 4953 *printf-S* |
3914 | 4954 S The text of the String argument is used. If a |
4955 precision is specified, no more display cells than the | |
4956 number specified are used. Without the |+multi_byte| | |
4957 feature works just like 's'. | |
452 | 4958 |
1621 | 4959 *printf-f* *E807* |
4960 f The Float argument is converted into a string of the | |
4961 form 123.456. The precision specifies the number of | |
4962 digits after the decimal point. When the precision is | |
4963 zero the decimal point is omitted. When the precision | |
4964 is not specified 6 is used. A really big number | |
4965 (out of range or dividing by zero) results in "inf". | |
4966 "0.0 / 0.0" results in "nan". | |
4967 Example: > | |
4968 echo printf("%.2f", 12.115) | |
4969 < 12.12 | |
4970 Note that roundoff depends on the system libraries. | |
4971 Use |round()| when in doubt. | |
4972 | |
4973 *printf-e* *printf-E* | |
4974 e E The Float argument is converted into a string of the | |
4975 form 1.234e+03 or 1.234E+03 when using 'E'. The | |
4976 precision specifies the number of digits after the | |
4977 decimal point, like with 'f'. | |
4978 | |
4979 *printf-g* *printf-G* | |
4980 g G The Float argument is converted like with 'f' if the | |
4981 value is between 0.001 (inclusive) and 10000000.0 | |
4982 (exclusive). Otherwise 'e' is used for 'g' and 'E' | |
4983 for 'G'. When no precision is specified superfluous | |
4984 zeroes and '+' signs are removed, except for the zero | |
4985 immediately after the decimal point. Thus 10000000.0 | |
4986 results in 1.0e7. | |
4987 | |
4988 *printf-%* | |
449 | 4989 % A '%' is written. No argument is converted. The |
4990 complete conversion specification is "%%". | |
452 | 4991 |
1668 | 4992 When a Number argument is expected a String argument is also |
4993 accepted and automatically converted. | |
4994 When a Float or String argument is expected a Number argument | |
4995 is also accepted and automatically converted. | |
4996 Any other argument type results in an error message. | |
449 | 4997 |
459 | 4998 *E766* *E767* |
449 | 4999 The number of {exprN} arguments must exactly match the number |
5000 of "%" items. If there are not sufficient or too many | |
452 | 5001 arguments an error is given. Up to 18 arguments can be used. |
449 | 5002 |
5003 | |
667 | 5004 pumvisible() *pumvisible()* |
5005 Returns non-zero when the popup menu is visible, zero | |
5006 otherwise. See |ins-completion-menu|. | |
712 | 5007 This can be used to avoid some things that would remove the |
5008 popup menu. | |
7 | 5009 |
4502
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4437
diff
changeset
|
5010 *E860* |
3682 | 5011 py3eval({expr}) *py3eval()* |
5012 Evaluate Python expression {expr} and return its result | |
5013 converted to Vim data structures. | |
5014 Numbers and strings are returned as they are (strings are | |
6647 | 5015 copied though, Unicode strings are additionally converted to |
3682 | 5016 'encoding'). |
5017 Lists are represented as Vim |List| type. | |
5018 Dictionaries are represented as Vim |Dictionary| type with | |
5019 keys converted to strings. | |
5020 {only available when compiled with the |+python3| feature} | |
5021 | |
5022 *E858* *E859* | |
5023 pyeval({expr}) *pyeval()* | |
5024 Evaluate Python expression {expr} and return its result | |
5025 converted to Vim data structures. | |
5026 Numbers and strings are returned as they are (strings are | |
5027 copied though). | |
5028 Lists are represented as Vim |List| type. | |
3830 | 5029 Dictionaries are represented as Vim |Dictionary| type, |
5030 non-string keys result in error. | |
3682 | 5031 {only available when compiled with the |+python| feature} |
5032 | |
114 | 5033 *E726* *E727* |
99 | 5034 range({expr} [, {max} [, {stride}]]) *range()* |
685 | 5035 Returns a |List| with Numbers: |
99 | 5036 - If only {expr} is specified: [0, 1, ..., {expr} - 1] |
5037 - If {max} is specified: [{expr}, {expr} + 1, ..., {max}] | |
5038 - If {stride} is specified: [{expr}, {expr} + {stride}, ..., | |
5039 {max}] (increasing {expr} with {stride} each time, not | |
5040 producing a value past {max}). | |
336 | 5041 When the maximum is one before the start the result is an |
5042 empty list. When the maximum is more than one before the | |
5043 start this is an error. | |
99 | 5044 Examples: > |
856 | 5045 range(4) " [0, 1, 2, 3] |
99 | 5046 range(2, 4) " [2, 3, 4] |
5047 range(2, 9, 3) " [2, 5, 8] | |
856 | 5048 range(2, -2, -1) " [2, 1, 0, -1, -2] |
336 | 5049 range(0) " [] |
5050 range(2, 0) " error! | |
99 | 5051 < |
158 | 5052 *readfile()* |
168 | 5053 readfile({fname} [, {binary} [, {max}]]) |
685 | 5054 Read file {fname} and return a |List|, each line of the file |
5055 as an item. Lines broken at NL characters. Macintosh files | |
158 | 5056 separated with CR will result in a single long line (unless a |
5057 NL appears somewhere). | |
2513
a88237afdb20
Change readfile() to ignore byte order marks, unless in binary mode.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2490
diff
changeset
|
5058 All NUL characters are replaced with a NL character. |
6918 | 5059 When {binary} contains "b" binary mode is used: |
158 | 5060 - When the last line ends in a NL an extra empty list item is |
5061 added. | |
5062 - No CR characters are removed. | |
5063 Otherwise: | |
5064 - CR characters that appear before a NL are removed. | |
5065 - Whether the last line ends in a NL or not does not matter. | |
2513
a88237afdb20
Change readfile() to ignore byte order marks, unless in binary mode.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2490
diff
changeset
|
5066 - When 'encoding' is Unicode any UTF-8 byte order mark is |
a88237afdb20
Change readfile() to ignore byte order marks, unless in binary mode.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2490
diff
changeset
|
5067 removed from the text. |
168 | 5068 When {max} is given this specifies the maximum number of lines |
5069 to be read. Useful if you only want to check the first ten | |
5070 lines of a file: > | |
5071 :for line in readfile(fname, '', 10) | |
5072 : if line =~ 'Date' | echo line | endif | |
5073 :endfor | |
233 | 5074 < When {max} is negative -{max} lines from the end of the file |
5075 are returned, or as many as there are. | |
5076 When {max} is zero the result is an empty list. | |
168 | 5077 Note that without {max} the whole file is read into memory. |
5078 Also note that there is no recognition of encoding. Read a | |
5079 file into a buffer if you need to. | |
158 | 5080 When the file can't be opened an error message is given and |
5081 the result is an empty list. | |
5082 Also see |writefile()|. | |
5083 | |
794 | 5084 reltime([{start} [, {end}]]) *reltime()* |
5085 Return an item that represents a time value. The format of | |
5086 the item depends on the system. It can be passed to | |
5087 |reltimestr()| to convert it to a string. | |
5088 Without an argument it returns the current time. | |
5089 With one argument is returns the time passed since the time | |
5090 specified in the argument. | |
843 | 5091 With two arguments it returns the time passed between {start} |
794 | 5092 and {end}. |
5093 The {start} and {end} arguments must be values returned by | |
5094 reltime(). | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2569
diff
changeset
|
5095 {only available when compiled with the |+reltime| feature} |
794 | 5096 |
5097 reltimestr({time}) *reltimestr()* | |
5098 Return a String that represents the time value of {time}. | |
5099 This is the number of seconds, a dot and the number of | |
5100 microseconds. Example: > | |
5101 let start = reltime() | |
5102 call MyFunction() | |
5103 echo reltimestr(reltime(start)) | |
5104 < Note that overhead for the commands will be added to the time. | |
5105 The accuracy depends on the system. | |
1156 | 5106 Leading spaces are used to make the string align nicely. You |
5107 can use split() to remove it. > | |
5108 echo split(reltimestr(reltime(start)))[0] | |
5109 < Also see |profiling|. | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2569
diff
changeset
|
5110 {only available when compiled with the |+reltime| feature} |
794 | 5111 |
7 | 5112 *remote_expr()* *E449* |
5113 remote_expr({server}, {string} [, {idvar}]) | |
1621 | 5114 Send the {string} to {server}. The string is sent as an |
7 | 5115 expression and the result is returned after evaluation. |
714 | 5116 The result must be a String or a |List|. A |List| is turned |
5117 into a String by joining the items with a line break in | |
5118 between (not at the end), like with join(expr, "\n"). | |
7 | 5119 If {idvar} is present, it is taken as the name of a |
5120 variable and a {serverid} for later use with | |
5121 remote_read() is stored there. | |
5122 See also |clientserver| |RemoteReply|. | |
5123 This function is not available in the |sandbox|. | |
5124 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature} | |
5125 Note: Any errors will cause a local error message to be issued | |
5126 and the result will be the empty string. | |
5127 Examples: > | |
5128 :echo remote_expr("gvim", "2+2") | |
5129 :echo remote_expr("gvim1", "b:current_syntax") | |
5130 < | |
5131 | |
5132 remote_foreground({server}) *remote_foreground()* | |
5133 Move the Vim server with the name {server} to the foreground. | |
5134 This works like: > | |
5135 remote_expr({server}, "foreground()") | |
5136 < Except that on Win32 systems the client does the work, to work | |
5137 around the problem that the OS doesn't always allow the server | |
5138 to bring itself to the foreground. | |
574 | 5139 Note: This does not restore the window if it was minimized, |
5140 like foreground() does. | |
7 | 5141 This function is not available in the |sandbox|. |
5142 {only in the Win32, Athena, Motif and GTK GUI versions and the | |
5143 Win32 console version} | |
5144 | |
5145 | |
5146 remote_peek({serverid} [, {retvar}]) *remote_peek()* | |
5147 Returns a positive number if there are available strings | |
5148 from {serverid}. Copies any reply string into the variable | |
1621 | 5149 {retvar} if specified. {retvar} must be a string with the |
7 | 5150 name of a variable. |
5151 Returns zero if none are available. | |
5152 Returns -1 if something is wrong. | |
5153 See also |clientserver|. | |
5154 This function is not available in the |sandbox|. | |
5155 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature} | |
5156 Examples: > | |
5157 :let repl = "" | |
5158 :echo "PEEK: ".remote_peek(id, "repl").": ".repl | |
5159 | |
5160 remote_read({serverid}) *remote_read()* | |
5161 Return the oldest available reply from {serverid} and consume | |
5162 it. It blocks until a reply is available. | |
5163 See also |clientserver|. | |
5164 This function is not available in the |sandbox|. | |
5165 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature} | |
5166 Example: > | |
5167 :echo remote_read(id) | |
5168 < | |
5169 *remote_send()* *E241* | |
5170 remote_send({server}, {string} [, {idvar}]) | |
1621 | 5171 Send the {string} to {server}. The string is sent as input |
22 | 5172 keys and the function returns immediately. At the Vim server |
5173 the keys are not mapped |:map|. | |
667 | 5174 If {idvar} is present, it is taken as the name of a variable |
5175 and a {serverid} for later use with remote_read() is stored | |
5176 there. | |
7 | 5177 See also |clientserver| |RemoteReply|. |
5178 This function is not available in the |sandbox|. | |
5179 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature} | |
5180 Note: Any errors will be reported in the server and may mess | |
5181 up the display. | |
5182 Examples: > | |
5183 :echo remote_send("gvim", ":DropAndReply ".file, "serverid"). | |
5184 \ remote_read(serverid) | |
5185 | |
5186 :autocmd NONE RemoteReply * | |
5187 \ echo remote_read(expand("<amatch>")) | |
5188 :echo remote_send("gvim", ":sleep 10 | echo ". | |
5189 \ 'server2client(expand("<client>"), "HELLO")<CR>') | |
82 | 5190 < |
79 | 5191 remove({list}, {idx} [, {end}]) *remove()* |
685 | 5192 Without {end}: Remove the item at {idx} from |List| {list} and |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
5193 return the item. |
79 | 5194 With {end}: Remove items from {idx} to {end} (inclusive) and |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
5195 return a List with these items. When {idx} points to the same |
79 | 5196 item as {end} a list with one item is returned. When {end} |
5197 points to an item before {idx} this is an error. | |
5198 See |list-index| for possible values of {idx} and {end}. | |
55 | 5199 Example: > |
5200 :echo "last item: " . remove(mylist, -1) | |
79 | 5201 :call remove(mylist, 0, 9) |
99 | 5202 remove({dict}, {key}) |
5203 Remove the entry from {dict} with key {key}. Example: > | |
5204 :echo "removed " . remove(dict, "one") | |
5205 < If there is no {key} in {dict} this is an error. | |
5206 | |
5207 Use |delete()| to remove a file. | |
55 | 5208 |
7 | 5209 rename({from}, {to}) *rename()* |
5210 Rename the file by the name {from} to the name {to}. This | |
5211 should also work to move files across file systems. The | |
5212 result is a Number, which is 0 if the file was renamed | |
5213 successfully, and non-zero when the renaming failed. | |
1851 | 5214 NOTE: If {to} exists it is overwritten without warning. |
7 | 5215 This function is not available in the |sandbox|. |
5216 | |
18 | 5217 repeat({expr}, {count}) *repeat()* |
5218 Repeat {expr} {count} times and return the concatenated | |
5219 result. Example: > | |
843 | 5220 :let separator = repeat('-', 80) |
18 | 5221 < When {count} is zero or negative the result is empty. |
685 | 5222 When {expr} is a |List| the result is {expr} concatenated |
1621 | 5223 {count} times. Example: > |
79 | 5224 :let longlist = repeat(['a', 'b'], 3) |
5225 < Results in ['a', 'b', 'a', 'b', 'a', 'b']. | |
18 | 5226 |
82 | 5227 |
7 | 5228 resolve({filename}) *resolve()* *E655* |
5229 On MS-Windows, when {filename} is a shortcut (a .lnk file), | |
5230 returns the path the shortcut points to in a simplified form. | |
5231 On Unix, repeat resolving symbolic links in all path | |
5232 components of {filename} and return the simplified result. | |
5233 To cope with link cycles, resolving of symbolic links is | |
5234 stopped after 100 iterations. | |
5235 On other systems, return the simplified {filename}. | |
5236 The simplification step is done as by |simplify()|. | |
5237 resolve() keeps a leading path component specifying the | |
5238 current directory (provided the result is still a relative | |
5239 path name) and also keeps a trailing path separator. | |
5240 | |
82 | 5241 *reverse()* |
1621 | 5242 reverse({list}) Reverse the order of items in {list} in-place. Returns |
82 | 5243 {list}. |
5244 If you want a list to remain unmodified make a copy first: > | |
5245 :let revlist = reverse(copy(mylist)) | |
5246 | |
1621 | 5247 round({expr}) *round()* |
1668 | 5248 Round off {expr} to the nearest integral value and return it |
1621 | 5249 as a |Float|. If {expr} lies halfway between two integral |
5250 values, then use the larger one (away from zero). | |
5251 {expr} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number|. | |
5252 Examples: > | |
5253 echo round(0.456) | |
5254 < 0.0 > | |
5255 echo round(4.5) | |
5256 < 5.0 > | |
5257 echo round(-4.5) | |
5258 < -5.0 | |
5259 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} | |
3996 | 5260 |
4835
4db0bf9f1b44
updated for version 7.3.1164
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5261 screenattr(row, col) *screenattr()* |
4db0bf9f1b44
updated for version 7.3.1164
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5262 Like screenchar(), but return the attribute. This is a rather |
4db0bf9f1b44
updated for version 7.3.1164
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5263 arbitrary number that can only be used to compare to the |
4db0bf9f1b44
updated for version 7.3.1164
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5264 attribute at other positions. |
4db0bf9f1b44
updated for version 7.3.1164
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5265 |
4db0bf9f1b44
updated for version 7.3.1164
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5266 screenchar(row, col) *screenchar()* |
4db0bf9f1b44
updated for version 7.3.1164
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5267 The result is a Number, which is the character at position |
4db0bf9f1b44
updated for version 7.3.1164
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5268 [row, col] on the screen. This works for every possible |
4db0bf9f1b44
updated for version 7.3.1164
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5269 screen position, also status lines, window separators and the |
4db0bf9f1b44
updated for version 7.3.1164
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5270 command line. The top left position is row one, column one |
4db0bf9f1b44
updated for version 7.3.1164
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5271 The character excludes composing characters. For double-byte |
4db0bf9f1b44
updated for version 7.3.1164
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5272 encodings it may only be the first byte. |
4db0bf9f1b44
updated for version 7.3.1164
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5273 This is mainly to be used for testing. |
4db0bf9f1b44
updated for version 7.3.1164
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5274 Returns -1 when row or col is out of range. |
4db0bf9f1b44
updated for version 7.3.1164
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5275 |
3996 | 5276 screencol() *screencol()* |
5277 The result is a Number, which is the current screen column of | |
5278 the cursor. The leftmost column has number 1. | |
5279 This function is mainly used for testing. | |
5280 | |
5281 Note: Always returns the current screen column, thus if used | |
5282 in a command (e.g. ":echo screencol()") it will return the | |
5283 column inside the command line, which is 1 when the command is | |
5284 executed. To get the cursor position in the file use one of | |
5285 the following mappings: > | |
5286 nnoremap <expr> GG ":echom ".screencol()."\n" | |
5287 nnoremap <silent> GG :echom screencol()<CR> | |
5288 < | |
5289 screenrow() *screenrow()* | |
5290 The result is a Number, which is the current screen row of the | |
5291 cursor. The top line has number one. | |
5292 This function is mainly used for testing. | |
5293 | |
5294 Note: Same restrictions as with |screencol()|. | |
5295 | |
1496 | 5296 search({pattern} [, {flags} [, {stopline} [, {timeout}]]]) *search()* |
7 | 5297 Search for regexp pattern {pattern}. The search starts at the |
119 | 5298 cursor position (you can use |cursor()| to set it). |
707 | 5299 |
3967 | 5300 When a match has been found its line number is returned. |
3312 | 5301 If there is no match a 0 is returned and the cursor doesn't |
5302 move. No error message is given. | |
5303 | |
7 | 5304 {flags} is a String, which can contain these character flags: |
7358
6fbeef3b65e6
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad4d8a192abf44b89371af87d70b971cd654b799
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7315
diff
changeset
|
5305 'b' search Backward instead of forward |
6fbeef3b65e6
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad4d8a192abf44b89371af87d70b971cd654b799
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7315
diff
changeset
|
5306 'c' accept a match at the Cursor position |
712 | 5307 'e' move to the End of the match |
20 | 5308 'n' do Not move the cursor |
7358
6fbeef3b65e6
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad4d8a192abf44b89371af87d70b971cd654b799
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7315
diff
changeset
|
5309 'p' return number of matching sub-Pattern (see below) |
6fbeef3b65e6
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad4d8a192abf44b89371af87d70b971cd654b799
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7315
diff
changeset
|
5310 's' Set the ' mark at the previous location of the cursor |
6fbeef3b65e6
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad4d8a192abf44b89371af87d70b971cd654b799
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7315
diff
changeset
|
5311 'w' Wrap around the end of the file |
6fbeef3b65e6
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad4d8a192abf44b89371af87d70b971cd654b799
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7315
diff
changeset
|
5312 'W' don't Wrap around the end of the file |
6fbeef3b65e6
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad4d8a192abf44b89371af87d70b971cd654b799
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7315
diff
changeset
|
5313 'z' start searching at the cursor column instead of zero |
7 | 5314 If neither 'w' or 'W' is given, the 'wrapscan' option applies. |
5315 | |
444 | 5316 If the 's' flag is supplied, the ' mark is set, only if the |
5317 cursor is moved. The 's' flag cannot be combined with the 'n' | |
5318 flag. | |
5319 | |
1156 | 5320 'ignorecase', 'smartcase' and 'magic' are used. |
7358
6fbeef3b65e6
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad4d8a192abf44b89371af87d70b971cd654b799
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7315
diff
changeset
|
5321 |
7659
07f11de5efca
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/85084ef1e999dcf50e8d466106a33bac24a0febb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7653
diff
changeset
|
5322 When the 'z' flag is not given, searching always starts in |
7358
6fbeef3b65e6
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad4d8a192abf44b89371af87d70b971cd654b799
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7315
diff
changeset
|
5323 column zero and then matches before the cursor are skipped. |
6fbeef3b65e6
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad4d8a192abf44b89371af87d70b971cd654b799
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7315
diff
changeset
|
5324 When the 'c' flag is present in 'cpo' the next search starts |
6fbeef3b65e6
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad4d8a192abf44b89371af87d70b971cd654b799
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7315
diff
changeset
|
5325 after the match. Without the 'c' flag the next search starts |
6fbeef3b65e6
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad4d8a192abf44b89371af87d70b971cd654b799
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7315
diff
changeset
|
5326 one column further. |
1156 | 5327 |
692 | 5328 When the {stopline} argument is given then the search stops |
5329 after searching this line. This is useful to restrict the | |
5330 search to a range of lines. Examples: > | |
5331 let match = search('(', 'b', line("w0")) | |
5332 let end = search('END', '', line("w$")) | |
5333 < When {stopline} is used and it is not zero this also implies | |
5334 that the search does not wrap around the end of the file. | |
1496 | 5335 A zero value is equal to not giving the argument. |
5336 | |
5337 When the {timeout} argument is given the search stops when | |
3513 | 5338 more than this many milliseconds have passed. Thus when |
1496 | 5339 {timeout} is 500 the search stops after half a second. |
5340 The value must not be negative. A zero value is like not | |
5341 giving the argument. | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2569
diff
changeset
|
5342 {only available when compiled with the |+reltime| feature} |
692 | 5343 |
714 | 5344 *search()-sub-match* |
5345 With the 'p' flag the returned value is one more than the | |
5346 first sub-match in \(\). One if none of them matched but the | |
5347 whole pattern did match. | |
712 | 5348 To get the column number too use |searchpos()|. |
5349 | |
20 | 5350 The cursor will be positioned at the match, unless the 'n' |
707 | 5351 flag is used. |
7 | 5352 |
5353 Example (goes over all files in the argument list): > | |
5354 :let n = 1 | |
5355 :while n <= argc() " loop over all files in arglist | |
5356 : exe "argument " . n | |
5357 : " start at the last char in the file and wrap for the | |
5358 : " first search to find match at start of file | |
5359 : normal G$ | |
5360 : let flags = "w" | |
5361 : while search("foo", flags) > 0 | |
1621 | 5362 : s/foo/bar/g |
7 | 5363 : let flags = "W" |
5364 : endwhile | |
5365 : update " write the file if modified | |
5366 : let n = n + 1 | |
5367 :endwhile | |
5368 < | |
712 | 5369 Example for using some flags: > |
5370 :echo search('\<if\|\(else\)\|\(endif\)', 'ncpe') | |
5371 < This will search for the keywords "if", "else", and "endif" | |
5372 under or after the cursor. Because of the 'p' flag, it | |
5373 returns 1, 2, or 3 depending on which keyword is found, or 0 | |
5374 if the search fails. With the cursor on the first word of the | |
5375 line: | |
5376 if (foo == 0) | let foo = foo + 1 | endif ~ | |
5377 the function returns 1. Without the 'c' flag, the function | |
5378 finds the "endif" and returns 3. The same thing happens | |
5379 without the 'e' flag if the cursor is on the "f" of "if". | |
5380 The 'n' flag tells the function not to move the cursor. | |
5381 | |
504 | 5382 |
523 | 5383 searchdecl({name} [, {global} [, {thisblock}]]) *searchdecl()* |
5384 Search for the declaration of {name}. | |
856 | 5385 |
523 | 5386 With a non-zero {global} argument it works like |gD|, find |
5387 first match in the file. Otherwise it works like |gd|, find | |
5388 first match in the function. | |
5389 | |
5390 With a non-zero {thisblock} argument matches in a {} block | |
5391 that ends before the cursor position are ignored. Avoids | |
5392 finding variable declarations only valid in another scope. | |
5393 | |
504 | 5394 Moves the cursor to the found match. |
5395 Returns zero for success, non-zero for failure. | |
5396 Example: > | |
5397 if searchdecl('myvar') == 0 | |
5398 echo getline('.') | |
5399 endif | |
5400 < | |
7 | 5401 *searchpair()* |
1496 | 5402 searchpair({start}, {middle}, {end} [, {flags} [, {skip} |
5403 [, {stopline} [, {timeout}]]]]) | |
7 | 5404 Search for the match of a nested start-end pair. This can be |
5405 used to find the "endif" that matches an "if", while other | |
5406 if/endif pairs in between are ignored. | |
677 | 5407 The search starts at the cursor. The default is to search |
5408 forward, include 'b' in {flags} to search backward. | |
5409 If a match is found, the cursor is positioned at it and the | |
5410 line number is returned. If no match is found 0 or -1 is | |
5411 returned and the cursor doesn't move. No error message is | |
5412 given. | |
7 | 5413 |
5414 {start}, {middle} and {end} are patterns, see |pattern|. They | |
5415 must not contain \( \) pairs. Use of \%( \) is allowed. When | |
5416 {middle} is not empty, it is found when searching from either | |
5417 direction, but only when not in a nested start-end pair. A | |
5418 typical use is: > | |
5419 searchpair('\<if\>', '\<else\>', '\<endif\>') | |
5420 < By leaving {middle} empty the "else" is skipped. | |
5421 | |
712 | 5422 {flags} 'b', 'c', 'n', 's', 'w' and 'W' are used like with |
5423 |search()|. Additionally: | |
7 | 5424 'r' Repeat until no more matches found; will find the |
1621 | 5425 outer pair. Implies the 'W' flag. |
5426 'm' Return number of matches instead of line number with | |
712 | 5427 the match; will be > 1 when 'r' is used. |
1621 | 5428 Note: it's nearly always a good idea to use the 'W' flag, to |
5429 avoid wrapping around the end of the file. | |
7 | 5430 |
5431 When a match for {start}, {middle} or {end} is found, the | |
5432 {skip} expression is evaluated with the cursor positioned on | |
5433 the start of the match. It should return non-zero if this | |
5434 match is to be skipped. E.g., because it is inside a comment | |
5435 or a string. | |
5436 When {skip} is omitted or empty, every match is accepted. | |
5437 When evaluating {skip} causes an error the search is aborted | |
5438 and -1 returned. | |
5439 | |
1496 | 5440 For {stopline} and {timeout} see |search()|. |
692 | 5441 |
7 | 5442 The value of 'ignorecase' is used. 'magic' is ignored, the |
5443 patterns are used like it's on. | |
5444 | |
5445 The search starts exactly at the cursor. A match with | |
5446 {start}, {middle} or {end} at the next character, in the | |
5447 direction of searching, is the first one found. Example: > | |
5448 if 1 | |
5449 if 2 | |
5450 endif 2 | |
5451 endif 1 | |
5452 < When starting at the "if 2", with the cursor on the "i", and | |
5453 searching forwards, the "endif 2" is found. When starting on | |
5454 the character just before the "if 2", the "endif 1" will be | |
1621 | 5455 found. That's because the "if 2" will be found first, and |
7 | 5456 then this is considered to be a nested if/endif from "if 2" to |
5457 "endif 2". | |
5458 When searching backwards and {end} is more than one character, | |
5459 it may be useful to put "\zs" at the end of the pattern, so | |
5460 that when the cursor is inside a match with the end it finds | |
5461 the matching start. | |
5462 | |
5463 Example, to find the "endif" command in a Vim script: > | |
5464 | |
5465 :echo searchpair('\<if\>', '\<el\%[seif]\>', '\<en\%[dif]\>', 'W', | |
5466 \ 'getline(".") =~ "^\\s*\""') | |
5467 | |
5468 < The cursor must be at or after the "if" for which a match is | |
5469 to be found. Note that single-quote strings are used to avoid | |
5470 having to double the backslashes. The skip expression only | |
5471 catches comments at the start of a line, not after a command. | |
5472 Also, a word "en" or "if" halfway a line is considered a | |
5473 match. | |
5474 Another example, to search for the matching "{" of a "}": > | |
5475 | |
5476 :echo searchpair('{', '', '}', 'bW') | |
5477 | |
5478 < This works when the cursor is at or before the "}" for which a | |
5479 match is to be found. To reject matches that syntax | |
5480 highlighting recognized as strings: > | |
5481 | |
5482 :echo searchpair('{', '', '}', 'bW', | |
5483 \ 'synIDattr(synID(line("."), col("."), 0), "name") =~? "string"') | |
5484 < | |
667 | 5485 *searchpairpos()* |
1496 | 5486 searchpairpos({start}, {middle}, {end} [, {flags} [, {skip} |
5487 [, {stopline} [, {timeout}]]]]) | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
5488 Same as |searchpair()|, but returns a |List| with the line and |
685 | 5489 column position of the match. The first element of the |List| |
5490 is the line number and the second element is the byte index of | |
667 | 5491 the column position of the match. If no match is found, |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
5492 returns [0, 0]. > |
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
5493 |
667 | 5494 :let [lnum,col] = searchpairpos('{', '', '}', 'n') |
5495 < | |
5496 See |match-parens| for a bigger and more useful example. | |
5497 | |
1496 | 5498 searchpos({pattern} [, {flags} [, {stopline} [, {timeout}]]]) *searchpos()* |
692 | 5499 Same as |search()|, but returns a |List| with the line and |
685 | 5500 column position of the match. The first element of the |List| |
5501 is the line number and the second element is the byte index of | |
5502 the column position of the match. If no match is found, | |
5503 returns [0, 0]. | |
714 | 5504 Example: > |
5505 :let [lnum, col] = searchpos('mypattern', 'n') | |
5506 | |
5507 < When the 'p' flag is given then there is an extra item with | |
5508 the sub-pattern match number |search()-sub-match|. Example: > | |
5509 :let [lnum, col, submatch] = searchpos('\(\l\)\|\(\u\)', 'np') | |
5510 < In this example "submatch" is 2 when a lowercase letter is | |
5511 found |/\l|, 3 when an uppercase letter is found |/\u|. | |
5512 | |
7 | 5513 server2client( {clientid}, {string}) *server2client()* |
5514 Send a reply string to {clientid}. The most recent {clientid} | |
5515 that sent a string can be retrieved with expand("<client>"). | |
5516 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature} | |
5517 Note: | |
5518 This id has to be stored before the next command can be | |
236 | 5519 received. I.e. before returning from the received command and |
7 | 5520 before calling any commands that waits for input. |
5521 See also |clientserver|. | |
5522 Example: > | |
5523 :echo server2client(expand("<client>"), "HELLO") | |
5524 < | |
5525 serverlist() *serverlist()* | |
5526 Return a list of available server names, one per line. | |
5527 When there are no servers or the information is not available | |
5528 an empty string is returned. See also |clientserver|. | |
5529 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature} | |
5530 Example: > | |
5531 :echo serverlist() | |
5532 < | |
5533 setbufvar({expr}, {varname}, {val}) *setbufvar()* | |
5534 Set option or local variable {varname} in buffer {expr} to | |
5535 {val}. | |
5536 This also works for a global or local window option, but it | |
5537 doesn't work for a global or local window variable. | |
5538 For a local window option the global value is unchanged. | |
5539 For the use of {expr}, see |bufname()| above. | |
5540 Note that the variable name without "b:" must be used. | |
5541 Examples: > | |
5542 :call setbufvar(1, "&mod", 1) | |
5543 :call setbufvar("todo", "myvar", "foobar") | |
5544 < This function is not available in the |sandbox|. | |
5545 | |
7100
f717d96a39b3
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/12969c04fe7bd27dc0cbf37709eb40a86d4a27f9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7013
diff
changeset
|
5546 setcharsearch({dict}) *setcharsearch()* |
6991 | 5547 Set the current character search information to {dict}, |
5548 which contains one or more of the following entries: | |
5549 | |
5550 char character which will be used for a subsequent | |
5551 |,| or |;| command; an empty string clears the | |
5552 character search | |
5553 forward direction of character search; 1 for forward, | |
5554 0 for backward | |
5555 until type of character search; 1 for a |t| or |T| | |
5556 character search, 0 for an |f| or |F| | |
5557 character search | |
5558 | |
5559 This can be useful to save/restore a user's character search | |
5560 from a script: > | |
5561 :let prevsearch = getcharsearch() | |
5562 :" Perform a command which clobbers user's search | |
5563 :call setcharsearch(prevsearch) | |
5564 < Also see |getcharsearch()|. | |
5565 | |
7 | 5566 setcmdpos({pos}) *setcmdpos()* |
5567 Set the cursor position in the command line to byte position | |
1621 | 5568 {pos}. The first position is 1. |
7 | 5569 Use |getcmdpos()| to obtain the current position. |
5570 Only works while editing the command line, thus you must use | |
99 | 5571 |c_CTRL-\_e|, |c_CTRL-R_=| or |c_CTRL-R_CTRL-R| with '='. For |
5572 |c_CTRL-\_e| and |c_CTRL-R_CTRL-R| with '=' the position is | |
5573 set after the command line is set to the expression. For | |
5574 |c_CTRL-R_=| it is set after evaluating the expression but | |
5575 before inserting the resulting text. | |
7 | 5576 When the number is too big the cursor is put at the end of the |
5577 line. A number smaller than one has undefined results. | |
5578 Returns 0 when successful, 1 when not editing the command | |
5579 line. | |
5580 | |
1621 | 5581 setline({lnum}, {text}) *setline()* |
3312 | 5582 Set line {lnum} of the current buffer to {text}. To insert |
5583 lines use |append()|. | |
236 | 5584 {lnum} is used like with |getline()|. |
1621 | 5585 When {lnum} is just below the last line the {text} will be |
282 | 5586 added as a new line. |
236 | 5587 If this succeeds, 0 is returned. If this fails (most likely |
5588 because {lnum} is invalid) 1 is returned. Example: > | |
7 | 5589 :call setline(5, strftime("%c")) |
1621 | 5590 < When {text} is a |List| then line {lnum} and following lines |
282 | 5591 will be set to the items in the list. Example: > |
5592 :call setline(5, ['aaa', 'bbb', 'ccc']) | |
5593 < This is equivalent to: > | |
3465 | 5594 :for [n, l] in [[5, 'aaa'], [6, 'bbb'], [7, 'ccc']] |
282 | 5595 : call setline(n, l) |
5596 :endfor | |
7 | 5597 < Note: The '[ and '] marks are not set. |
5598 | |
647 | 5599 setloclist({nr}, {list} [, {action}]) *setloclist()* |
5600 Create or replace or add to the location list for window {nr}. | |
5601 When {nr} is zero the current window is used. For a location | |
648 | 5602 list window, the displayed location list is modified. For an |
5603 invalid window number {nr}, -1 is returned. | |
1326 | 5604 Otherwise, same as |setqflist()|. |
5605 Also see |location-list|. | |
5606 | |
5607 setmatches({list}) *setmatches()* | |
5608 Restores a list of matches saved by |getmatches()|. Returns 0 | |
1621 | 5609 if successful, otherwise -1. All current matches are cleared |
1326 | 5610 before the list is restored. See example for |getmatches()|. |
230 | 5611 |
707 | 5612 *setpos()* |
5613 setpos({expr}, {list}) | |
5614 Set the position for {expr}. Possible values: | |
5615 . the cursor | |
5616 'x mark x | |
5617 | |
5938 | 5618 {list} must be a |List| with four or five numbers: |
707 | 5619 [bufnum, lnum, col, off] |
5938 | 5620 [bufnum, lnum, col, off, curswant] |
707 | 5621 |
1621 | 5622 "bufnum" is the buffer number. Zero can be used for the |
856 | 5623 current buffer. Setting the cursor is only possible for |
707 | 5624 the current buffer. To set a mark in another buffer you can |
5625 use the |bufnr()| function to turn a file name into a buffer | |
5626 number. | |
798 | 5627 Does not change the jumplist. |
707 | 5628 |
5629 "lnum" and "col" are the position in the buffer. The first | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
5630 column is 1. Use a zero "lnum" to delete a mark. If "col" is |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
5631 smaller than 1 then 1 is used. |
707 | 5632 |
5633 The "off" number is only used when 'virtualedit' is set. Then | |
5634 it is the offset in screen columns from the start of the | |
1266 | 5635 character. E.g., a position within a <Tab> or after the last |
707 | 5636 character. |
5637 | |
5938 | 5638 The "curswant" number is only used when setting the cursor |
5639 position. It sets the preferred column for when moving the | |
5640 cursor vertically. When the "curswant" number is missing the | |
5641 preferred column is not set. When it is present and setting a | |
5642 mark position it is not used. | |
5643 | |
5555 | 5644 Note that for '< and '> changing the line number may result in |
5645 the marks to be effectively be swapped, so that '< is always | |
5646 before '>. | |
5647 | |
1533 | 5648 Returns 0 when the position could be set, -1 otherwise. |
5649 An error message is given if {expr} is invalid. | |
5650 | |
5944 | 5651 Also see |getpos()| and |getcurpos()|. |
707 | 5652 |
1156 | 5653 This does not restore the preferred column for moving |
5938 | 5654 vertically; if you set the cursor position with this, |j| and |
5655 |k| motions will jump to previous columns! Use |cursor()| to | |
5656 also set the preferred column. Also see the "curswant" key in | |
5657 |winrestview()|. | |
1156 | 5658 |
707 | 5659 |
277 | 5660 setqflist({list} [, {action}]) *setqflist()* |
647 | 5661 Create or replace or add to the quickfix list using the items |
5662 in {list}. Each item in {list} is a dictionary. | |
5663 Non-dictionary items in {list} are ignored. Each dictionary | |
5664 item can contain the following entries: | |
230 | 5665 |
1065 | 5666 bufnr buffer number; must be the number of a valid |
1621 | 5667 buffer |
1065 | 5668 filename name of a file; only used when "bufnr" is not |
1621 | 5669 present or it is invalid. |
230 | 5670 lnum line number in the file |
233 | 5671 pattern search pattern used to locate the error |
230 | 5672 col column number |
233 | 5673 vcol when non-zero: "col" is visual column |
856 | 5674 when zero: "col" is byte index |
233 | 5675 nr error number |
230 | 5676 text description of the error |
233 | 5677 type single-character error type, 'E', 'W', etc. |
5678 | |
5679 The "col", "vcol", "nr", "type" and "text" entries are | |
5680 optional. Either "lnum" or "pattern" entry can be used to | |
5681 locate a matching error line. | |
1065 | 5682 If the "filename" and "bufnr" entries are not present or |
5683 neither the "lnum" or "pattern" entries are present, then the | |
5684 item will not be handled as an error line. | |
230 | 5685 If both "pattern" and "lnum" are present then "pattern" will |
5686 be used. | |
2152 | 5687 If you supply an empty {list}, the quickfix list will be |
5688 cleared. | |
1065 | 5689 Note that the list is not exactly the same as what |
5690 |getqflist()| returns. | |
230 | 5691 |
277 | 5692 If {action} is set to 'a', then the items from {list} are |
5693 added to the existing quickfix list. If there is no existing | |
5694 list, then a new list is created. If {action} is set to 'r', | |
5695 then the items from the current quickfix list are replaced | |
5696 with the items from {list}. If {action} is not present or is | |
5697 set to ' ', then a new list is created. | |
5698 | |
230 | 5699 Returns zero for success, -1 for failure. |
5700 | |
5701 This function can be used to create a quickfix list | |
5702 independent of the 'errorformat' setting. Use a command like | |
5703 ":cc 1" to jump to the first position. | |
5704 | |
5705 | |
7 | 5706 *setreg()* |
5707 setreg({regname}, {value} [,{options}]) | |
5708 Set the register {regname} to {value}. | |
5798 | 5709 {value} may be any value returned by |getreg()|, including |
5710 a |List|. | |
7 | 5711 If {options} contains "a" or {regname} is upper case, |
5712 then the value is appended. | |
2423 | 5713 {options} can also contain a register type specification: |
7 | 5714 "c" or "v" |characterwise| mode |
5715 "l" or "V" |linewise| mode | |
5716 "b" or "<CTRL-V>" |blockwise-visual| mode | |
5717 If a number immediately follows "b" or "<CTRL-V>" then this is | |
5718 used as the width of the selection - if it is not specified | |
5719 then the width of the block is set to the number of characters | |
1266 | 5720 in the longest line (counting a <Tab> as 1 character). |
7 | 5721 |
5722 If {options} contains no register settings, then the default | |
5798 | 5723 is to use character mode unless {value} ends in a <NL> for |
5724 string {value} and linewise mode for list {value}. Blockwise | |
5725 mode is never selected automatically. | |
5726 Returns zero for success, non-zero for failure. | |
5727 | |
5728 *E883* | |
6180 | 5729 Note: you may not use |List| containing more than one item to |
5798 | 5730 set search and expression registers. Lists containing no |
5731 items act like empty strings. | |
7 | 5732 |
5733 Examples: > | |
5734 :call setreg(v:register, @*) | |
5735 :call setreg('*', @%, 'ac') | |
5736 :call setreg('a', "1\n2\n3", 'b5') | |
5737 | |
5738 < This example shows using the functions to save and restore a | |
5798 | 5739 register (note: you may not reliably restore register value |
5740 without using the third argument to |getreg()| as without it | |
5741 newlines are represented as newlines AND Nul bytes are | |
5742 represented as newlines as well, see |NL-used-for-Nul|). > | |
5743 :let var_a = getreg('a', 1, 1) | |
7 | 5744 :let var_amode = getregtype('a') |
5745 .... | |
5746 :call setreg('a', var_a, var_amode) | |
5747 | |
5748 < You can also change the type of a register by appending | |
5749 nothing: > | |
5750 :call setreg('a', '', 'al') | |
5751 | |
2207
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2206
diff
changeset
|
5752 settabvar({tabnr}, {varname}, {val}) *settabvar()* |
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2206
diff
changeset
|
5753 Set tab-local variable {varname} to {val} in tab page {tabnr}. |
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2206
diff
changeset
|
5754 |t:var| |
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2206
diff
changeset
|
5755 Note that the variable name without "t:" must be used. |
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2206
diff
changeset
|
5756 Tabs are numbered starting with one. |
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2206
diff
changeset
|
5757 This function is not available in the |sandbox|. |
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2206
diff
changeset
|
5758 |
831 | 5759 settabwinvar({tabnr}, {winnr}, {varname}, {val}) *settabwinvar()* |
5760 Set option or local variable {varname} in window {winnr} to | |
5761 {val}. | |
5762 Tabs are numbered starting with one. For the current tabpage | |
5763 use |setwinvar()|. | |
5764 When {winnr} is zero the current window is used. | |
7 | 5765 This also works for a global or local buffer option, but it |
5766 doesn't work for a global or local buffer variable. | |
5767 For a local buffer option the global value is unchanged. | |
5768 Note that the variable name without "w:" must be used. | |
831 | 5769 Examples: > |
5770 :call settabwinvar(1, 1, "&list", 0) | |
5771 :call settabwinvar(3, 2, "myvar", "foobar") | |
5772 < This function is not available in the |sandbox|. | |
5773 | |
5774 setwinvar({nr}, {varname}, {val}) *setwinvar()* | |
5775 Like |settabwinvar()| for the current tab page. | |
7 | 5776 Examples: > |
5777 :call setwinvar(1, "&list", 0) | |
5778 :call setwinvar(2, "myvar", "foobar") | |
5779 | |
4126 | 5780 sha256({string}) *sha256()* |
6647 | 5781 Returns a String with 64 hex characters, which is the SHA256 |
4126 | 5782 checksum of {string}. |
5783 {only available when compiled with the |+cryptv| feature} | |
5784 | |
1661 | 5785 shellescape({string} [, {special}]) *shellescape()* |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
5786 Escape {string} for use as a shell command argument. |
985 | 5787 On MS-Windows and MS-DOS, when 'shellslash' is not set, it |
1661 | 5788 will enclose {string} in double quotes and double all double |
985 | 5789 quotes within {string}. |
5790 For other systems, it will enclose {string} in single quotes | |
5791 and replace all "'" with "'\''". | |
1661 | 5792 When the {special} argument is present and it's a non-zero |
5793 Number or a non-empty String (|non-zero-arg|), then special | |
1698 | 5794 items such as "!", "%", "#" and "<cword>" will be preceded by |
5795 a backslash. This backslash will be removed again by the |:!| | |
1661 | 5796 command. |
1698 | 5797 The "!" character will be escaped (again with a |non-zero-arg| |
5798 {special}) when 'shell' contains "csh" in the tail. That is | |
5799 because for csh and tcsh "!" is used for history replacement | |
5800 even when inside single quotes. | |
5801 The <NL> character is also escaped. With a |non-zero-arg| | |
5802 {special} and 'shell' containing "csh" in the tail it's | |
5803 escaped a second time. | |
1661 | 5804 Example of use with a |:!| command: > |
5805 :exe '!dir ' . shellescape(expand('<cfile>'), 1) | |
5806 < This results in a directory listing for the file under the | |
5807 cursor. Example of use with |system()|: > | |
5808 :call system("chmod +w -- " . shellescape(expand("%"))) | |
5690 | 5809 < See also |::S|. |
985 | 5810 |
5811 | |
3875 | 5812 shiftwidth() *shiftwidth()* |
5813 Returns the effective value of 'shiftwidth'. This is the | |
5814 'shiftwidth' value unless it is zero, in which case it is the | |
5815 'tabstop' value. To be backwards compatible in indent | |
5816 plugins, use this: > | |
5817 if exists('*shiftwidth') | |
5818 func s:sw() | |
5819 return shiftwidth() | |
5820 endfunc | |
5821 else | |
5822 func s:sw() | |
5823 return &sw | |
5824 endfunc | |
5825 endif | |
5826 < And then use s:sw() instead of &sw. | |
5827 | |
5828 | |
7 | 5829 simplify({filename}) *simplify()* |
5830 Simplify the file name as much as possible without changing | |
5831 the meaning. Shortcuts (on MS-Windows) or symbolic links (on | |
5832 Unix) are not resolved. If the first path component in | |
5833 {filename} designates the current directory, this will be | |
5834 valid for the result as well. A trailing path separator is | |
5835 not removed either. | |
5836 Example: > | |
5837 simplify("./dir/.././/file/") == "./file/" | |
5838 < Note: The combination "dir/.." is only removed if "dir" is | |
5839 a searchable directory or does not exist. On Unix, it is also | |
5840 removed when "dir" is a symbolic link within the same | |
5841 directory. In order to resolve all the involved symbolic | |
5842 links before simplifying the path name, use |resolve()|. | |
5843 | |
82 | 5844 |
1621 | 5845 sin({expr}) *sin()* |
5846 Return the sine of {expr}, measured in radians, as a |Float|. | |
5847 {expr} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number|. | |
5848 Examples: > | |
5849 :echo sin(100) | |
5850 < -0.506366 > | |
5851 :echo sin(-4.01) | |
5852 < 0.763301 | |
5853 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} | |
5854 | |
5855 | |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5856 sinh({expr}) *sinh()* |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
5857 Return the hyperbolic sine of {expr} as a |Float| in the range |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5858 [-inf, inf]. |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
5859 {expr} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number|. |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5860 Examples: > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5861 :echo sinh(0.5) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5862 < 0.521095 > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5863 :echo sinh(-0.9) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5864 < -1.026517 |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2569
diff
changeset
|
5865 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5866 |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5867 |
2902 | 5868 sort({list} [, {func} [, {dict}]]) *sort()* *E702* |
5747 | 5869 Sort the items in {list} in-place. Returns {list}. |
5870 | |
5871 If you want a list to remain unmodified make a copy first: > | |
82 | 5872 :let sortedlist = sort(copy(mylist)) |
5968 | 5873 |
6009 | 5874 < When {func} is omitted, is empty or zero, then sort() uses the |
5875 string representation of each item to sort on. Numbers sort | |
5876 after Strings, |Lists| after Numbers. For sorting text in the | |
5877 current buffer use |:sort|. | |
5878 | |
6180 | 5879 When {func} is given and it is '1' or 'i' then case is |
6009 | 5880 ignored. |
5881 | |
5882 When {func} is given and it is 'n' then all items will be | |
5883 sorted numerical (Implementation detail: This uses the | |
5884 strtod() function to parse numbers, Strings, Lists, Dicts and | |
5885 Funcrefs will be considered as being 0). | |
5886 | |
7291
6ffc75d807bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b00da1d6d1655cb6e415f84ecc3be5ff3b790811
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7279
diff
changeset
|
5887 When {func} is given and it is 'N' then all items will be |
6ffc75d807bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b00da1d6d1655cb6e415f84ecc3be5ff3b790811
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7279
diff
changeset
|
5888 sorted numerical. This is like 'n' but a string containing |
6ffc75d807bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b00da1d6d1655cb6e415f84ecc3be5ff3b790811
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7279
diff
changeset
|
5889 digits will be used as the number they represent. |
6ffc75d807bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b00da1d6d1655cb6e415f84ecc3be5ff3b790811
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7279
diff
changeset
|
5890 |
685 | 5891 When {func} is a |Funcref| or a function name, this function |
5892 is called to compare items. The function is invoked with two | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
5893 items as argument and must return zero if they are equal, 1 or |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
5894 bigger if the first one sorts after the second one, -1 or |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
5895 smaller if the first one sorts before the second one. |
5747 | 5896 |
5897 {dict} is for functions with the "dict" attribute. It will be | |
5898 used to set the local variable "self". |Dictionary-function| | |
5899 | |
6032
b8f703a4e55f
Updated runtime files. Overhauled HTML indent script.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
6009
diff
changeset
|
5900 The sort is stable, items which compare equal (as number or as |
b8f703a4e55f
Updated runtime files. Overhauled HTML indent script.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
6009
diff
changeset
|
5901 string) will keep their relative position. E.g., when sorting |
6051 | 5902 on numbers, text strings will sort next to each other, in the |
6032
b8f703a4e55f
Updated runtime files. Overhauled HTML indent script.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
6009
diff
changeset
|
5903 same order as they were originally. |
b8f703a4e55f
Updated runtime files. Overhauled HTML indent script.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
6009
diff
changeset
|
5904 |
5747 | 5905 Also see |uniq()|. |
5906 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
5907 Example: > |
82 | 5908 func MyCompare(i1, i2) |
5909 return a:i1 == a:i2 ? 0 : a:i1 > a:i2 ? 1 : -1 | |
5910 endfunc | |
5911 let sortedlist = sort(mylist, "MyCompare") | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
5912 < A shorter compare version for this specific simple case, which |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
5913 ignores overflow: > |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
5914 func MyCompare(i1, i2) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
5915 return a:i1 - a:i2 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
5916 endfunc |
344 | 5917 < |
374 | 5918 *soundfold()* |
5919 soundfold({word}) | |
5920 Return the sound-folded equivalent of {word}. Uses the first | |
1621 | 5921 language in 'spelllang' for the current window that supports |
375 | 5922 soundfolding. 'spell' must be set. When no sound folding is |
5923 possible the {word} is returned unmodified. | |
374 | 5924 This can be used for making spelling suggestions. Note that |
5925 the method can be quite slow. | |
5926 | |
344 | 5927 *spellbadword()* |
532 | 5928 spellbadword([{sentence}]) |
5929 Without argument: The result is the badly spelled word under | |
5930 or after the cursor. The cursor is moved to the start of the | |
5931 bad word. When no bad word is found in the cursor line the | |
5932 result is an empty string and the cursor doesn't move. | |
5933 | |
5934 With argument: The result is the first word in {sentence} that | |
5935 is badly spelled. If there are no spelling mistakes the | |
5936 result is an empty string. | |
5937 | |
5938 The return value is a list with two items: | |
5939 - The badly spelled word or an empty string. | |
5940 - The type of the spelling error: | |
856 | 5941 "bad" spelling mistake |
532 | 5942 "rare" rare word |
5943 "local" word only valid in another region | |
5944 "caps" word should start with Capital | |
5945 Example: > | |
5946 echo spellbadword("the quik brown fox") | |
5947 < ['quik', 'bad'] ~ | |
5948 | |
5949 The spelling information for the current window is used. The | |
5950 'spell' option must be set and the value of 'spelllang' is | |
5951 used. | |
344 | 5952 |
5953 *spellsuggest()* | |
537 | 5954 spellsuggest({word} [, {max} [, {capital}]]) |
685 | 5955 Return a |List| with spelling suggestions to replace {word}. |
344 | 5956 When {max} is given up to this number of suggestions are |
5957 returned. Otherwise up to 25 suggestions are returned. | |
5958 | |
537 | 5959 When the {capital} argument is given and it's non-zero only |
5960 suggestions with a leading capital will be given. Use this | |
5961 after a match with 'spellcapcheck'. | |
5962 | |
344 | 5963 {word} can be a badly spelled word followed by other text. |
5964 This allows for joining two words that were split. The | |
359 | 5965 suggestions also include the following text, thus you can |
5966 replace a line. | |
5967 | |
5968 {word} may also be a good word. Similar words will then be | |
537 | 5969 returned. {word} itself is not included in the suggestions, |
5970 although it may appear capitalized. | |
344 | 5971 |
5972 The spelling information for the current window is used. The | |
375 | 5973 'spell' option must be set and the values of 'spelllang' and |
5974 'spellsuggest' are used. | |
344 | 5975 |
82 | 5976 |
282 | 5977 split({expr} [, {pattern} [, {keepempty}]]) *split()* |
685 | 5978 Make a |List| out of {expr}. When {pattern} is omitted or |
5979 empty each white-separated sequence of characters becomes an | |
5980 item. | |
82 | 5981 Otherwise the string is split where {pattern} matches, |
3920 | 5982 removing the matched characters. 'ignorecase' is not used |
5983 here, add \c to ignore case. |/\c| | |
282 | 5984 When the first or last item is empty it is omitted, unless the |
5985 {keepempty} argument is given and it's non-zero. | |
293 | 5986 Other empty items are kept when {pattern} matches at least one |
5987 character or when {keepempty} is non-zero. | |
82 | 5988 Example: > |
95 | 5989 :let words = split(getline('.'), '\W\+') |
282 | 5990 < To split a string in individual characters: > |
236 | 5991 :for c in split(mystring, '\zs') |
7100
f717d96a39b3
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/12969c04fe7bd27dc0cbf37709eb40a86d4a27f9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7013
diff
changeset
|
5992 < If you want to keep the separator you can also use '\zs' at |
f717d96a39b3
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/12969c04fe7bd27dc0cbf37709eb40a86d4a27f9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7013
diff
changeset
|
5993 the end of the pattern: > |
258 | 5994 :echo split('abc:def:ghi', ':\zs') |
5995 < ['abc:', 'def:', 'ghi'] ~ | |
282 | 5996 Splitting a table where the first element can be empty: > |
5997 :let items = split(line, ':', 1) | |
5998 < The opposite function is |join()|. | |
82 | 5999 |
6000 | |
1621 | 6001 sqrt({expr}) *sqrt()* |
6002 Return the non-negative square root of Float {expr} as a | |
6003 |Float|. | |
6004 {expr} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number|. When {expr} | |
6005 is negative the result is NaN (Not a Number). | |
6006 Examples: > | |
6007 :echo sqrt(100) | |
6008 < 10.0 > | |
6009 :echo sqrt(-4.01) | |
6010 < nan | |
1668 | 6011 "nan" may be different, it depends on system libraries. |
1621 | 6012 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} |
6013 | |
6014 | |
6015 str2float( {expr}) *str2float()* | |
6016 Convert String {expr} to a Float. This mostly works the same | |
6017 as when using a floating point number in an expression, see | |
6018 |floating-point-format|. But it's a bit more permissive. | |
6019 E.g., "1e40" is accepted, while in an expression you need to | |
6020 write "1.0e40". | |
6021 Text after the number is silently ignored. | |
6022 The decimal point is always '.', no matter what the locale is | |
6023 set to. A comma ends the number: "12,345.67" is converted to | |
6024 12.0. You can strip out thousands separators with | |
6025 |substitute()|: > | |
6026 let f = str2float(substitute(text, ',', '', 'g')) | |
6027 < {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} | |
6028 | |
6029 | |
782 | 6030 str2nr( {expr} [, {base}]) *str2nr()* |
6031 Convert string {expr} to a number. | |
7477
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7384
diff
changeset
|
6032 {base} is the conversion base, it can be 2, 8, 10 or 16. |
782 | 6033 When {base} is omitted base 10 is used. This also means that |
6034 a leading zero doesn't cause octal conversion to be used, as | |
6035 with the default String to Number conversion. | |
6036 When {base} is 16 a leading "0x" or "0X" is ignored. With a | |
7477
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7384
diff
changeset
|
6037 different base the result will be zero. Similarly, when |
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7384
diff
changeset
|
6038 {base} is 8 a leading "0" is ignored, and when {base} is 2 a |
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7384
diff
changeset
|
6039 leading "0b" or "0B" is ignored. |
782 | 6040 Text after the number is silently ignored. |
856 | 6041 |
782 | 6042 |
6884 | 6043 strchars({expr} [, {skipcc}]) *strchars()* |
2338
da6ec32d8d8f
Added strwidth() and strchars() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
6044 The result is a Number, which is the number of characters |
6884 | 6045 in String {expr}. |
6046 When {skipcc} is omitted or zero, composing characters are | |
6047 counted separately. | |
6048 When {skipcc} set to 1, Composing characters are ignored. | |
2339
01e4b4d37842
Added strdisplaywidth() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2338
diff
changeset
|
6049 Also see |strlen()|, |strdisplaywidth()| and |strwidth()|. |
01e4b4d37842
Added strdisplaywidth() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2338
diff
changeset
|
6050 |
6918 | 6051 |
6052 {skipcc} is only available after 7.4.755. For backward | |
6053 compatibility, you can define a wrapper function: > | |
6054 if has("patch-7.4.755") | |
6055 function s:strchars(str, skipcc) | |
6056 return strchars(a:str, a:skipcc) | |
6057 endfunction | |
6058 else | |
6059 function s:strchars(str, skipcc) | |
6060 if a:skipcc | |
6061 return strlen(substitute(a:str, ".", "x", "g")) | |
6062 else | |
6063 return strchars(a:str) | |
6064 endif | |
6065 endfunction | |
6066 endif | |
6067 < | |
6068 | |
2339
01e4b4d37842
Added strdisplaywidth() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2338
diff
changeset
|
6069 strdisplaywidth({expr}[, {col}]) *strdisplaywidth()* |
01e4b4d37842
Added strdisplaywidth() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2338
diff
changeset
|
6070 The result is a Number, which is the number of display cells |
6884 | 6071 String {expr} occupies on the screen when it starts at {col}. |
2339
01e4b4d37842
Added strdisplaywidth() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2338
diff
changeset
|
6072 When {col} is omitted zero is used. Otherwise it is the |
01e4b4d37842
Added strdisplaywidth() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2338
diff
changeset
|
6073 screen column where to start. This matters for Tab |
01e4b4d37842
Added strdisplaywidth() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2338
diff
changeset
|
6074 characters. |
2343
0703d2fd5749
Last few changes for the 7.3a BETA release.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2339
diff
changeset
|
6075 The option settings of the current window are used. This |
0703d2fd5749
Last few changes for the 7.3a BETA release.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2339
diff
changeset
|
6076 matters for anything that's displayed differently, such as |
0703d2fd5749
Last few changes for the 7.3a BETA release.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2339
diff
changeset
|
6077 'tabstop' and 'display'. |
2339
01e4b4d37842
Added strdisplaywidth() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2338
diff
changeset
|
6078 When {expr} contains characters with East Asian Width Class |
01e4b4d37842
Added strdisplaywidth() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2338
diff
changeset
|
6079 Ambiguous, this function's return value depends on 'ambiwidth'. |
01e4b4d37842
Added strdisplaywidth() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2338
diff
changeset
|
6080 Also see |strlen()|, |strwidth()| and |strchars()|. |
2338
da6ec32d8d8f
Added strwidth() and strchars() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
6081 |
7 | 6082 strftime({format} [, {time}]) *strftime()* |
6083 The result is a String, which is a formatted date and time, as | |
6084 specified by the {format} string. The given {time} is used, | |
6085 or the current time if no time is given. The accepted | |
6086 {format} depends on your system, thus this is not portable! | |
6087 See the manual page of the C function strftime() for the | |
6088 format. The maximum length of the result is 80 characters. | |
6089 See also |localtime()| and |getftime()|. | |
6090 The language can be changed with the |:language| command. | |
6091 Examples: > | |
6092 :echo strftime("%c") Sun Apr 27 11:49:23 1997 | |
6093 :echo strftime("%Y %b %d %X") 1997 Apr 27 11:53:25 | |
6094 :echo strftime("%y%m%d %T") 970427 11:53:55 | |
6095 :echo strftime("%H:%M") 11:55 | |
6096 :echo strftime("%c", getftime("file.c")) | |
6097 Show mod time of file.c. | |
82 | 6098 < Not available on all systems. To check use: > |
6099 :if exists("*strftime") | |
6100 | |
133 | 6101 stridx({haystack}, {needle} [, {start}]) *stridx()* |
6102 The result is a Number, which gives the byte index in | |
6103 {haystack} of the first occurrence of the String {needle}. | |
140 | 6104 If {start} is specified, the search starts at index {start}. |
6105 This can be used to find a second match: > | |
2662 | 6106 :let colon1 = stridx(line, ":") |
6107 :let colon2 = stridx(line, ":", colon1 + 1) | |
140 | 6108 < The search is done case-sensitive. |
205 | 6109 For pattern searches use |match()|. |
133 | 6110 -1 is returned if the {needle} does not occur in {haystack}. |
140 | 6111 See also |strridx()|. |
6112 Examples: > | |
7 | 6113 :echo stridx("An Example", "Example") 3 |
6114 :echo stridx("Starting point", "Start") 0 | |
6115 :echo stridx("Starting point", "start") -1 | |
856 | 6116 < *strstr()* *strchr()* |
170 | 6117 stridx() works similar to the C function strstr(). When used |
6118 with a single character it works similar to strchr(). | |
6119 | |
55 | 6120 *string()* |
95 | 6121 string({expr}) Return {expr} converted to a String. If {expr} is a Number, |
1621 | 6122 Float, String or a composition of them, then the result can be |
6123 parsed back with |eval()|. | |
55 | 6124 {expr} type result ~ |
99 | 6125 String 'string' |
95 | 6126 Number 123 |
1621 | 6127 Float 123.123456 or 1.123456e8 |
99 | 6128 Funcref function('name') |
95 | 6129 List [item, item] |
323 | 6130 Dictionary {key: value, key: value} |
99 | 6131 Note that in String values the ' character is doubled. |
1156 | 6132 Also see |strtrans()|. |
55 | 6133 |
7 | 6134 *strlen()* |
6135 strlen({expr}) The result is a Number, which is the length of the String | |
502 | 6136 {expr} in bytes. |
55 | 6137 If the argument is a Number it is first converted to a String. |
6138 For other types an error is given. | |
6870 | 6139 If you want to count the number of multi-byte characters use |
6140 |strchars()|. | |
6141 Also see |len()|, |strdisplaywidth()| and |strwidth()|. | |
7 | 6142 |
6143 strpart({src}, {start}[, {len}]) *strpart()* | |
6144 The result is a String, which is part of {src}, starting from | |
574 | 6145 byte {start}, with the byte length {len}. |
7 | 6146 When non-existing bytes are included, this doesn't result in |
6147 an error, the bytes are simply omitted. | |
6148 If {len} is missing, the copy continues from {start} till the | |
6149 end of the {src}. > | |
6150 strpart("abcdefg", 3, 2) == "de" | |
6151 strpart("abcdefg", -2, 4) == "ab" | |
6152 strpart("abcdefg", 5, 4) == "fg" | |
1621 | 6153 strpart("abcdefg", 3) == "defg" |
7 | 6154 < Note: To get the first character, {start} must be 0. For |
6155 example, to get three bytes under and after the cursor: > | |
823 | 6156 strpart(getline("."), col(".") - 1, 3) |
7 | 6157 < |
140 | 6158 strridx({haystack}, {needle} [, {start}]) *strridx()* |
6159 The result is a Number, which gives the byte index in | |
6160 {haystack} of the last occurrence of the String {needle}. | |
6161 When {start} is specified, matches beyond this index are | |
6162 ignored. This can be used to find a match before a previous | |
6163 match: > | |
6164 :let lastcomma = strridx(line, ",") | |
6165 :let comma2 = strridx(line, ",", lastcomma - 1) | |
6166 < The search is done case-sensitive. | |
133 | 6167 For pattern searches use |match()|. |
6168 -1 is returned if the {needle} does not occur in {haystack}. | |
22 | 6169 If the {needle} is empty the length of {haystack} is returned. |
236 | 6170 See also |stridx()|. Examples: > |
7 | 6171 :echo strridx("an angry armadillo", "an") 3 |
856 | 6172 < *strrchr()* |
170 | 6173 When used with a single character it works similar to the C |
6174 function strrchr(). | |
6175 | |
7 | 6176 strtrans({expr}) *strtrans()* |
6177 The result is a String, which is {expr} with all unprintable | |
6178 characters translated into printable characters |'isprint'|. | |
6179 Like they are shown in a window. Example: > | |
6180 echo strtrans(@a) | |
6181 < This displays a newline in register a as "^@" instead of | |
6182 starting a new line. | |
6183 | |
2338
da6ec32d8d8f
Added strwidth() and strchars() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
6184 strwidth({expr}) *strwidth()* |
da6ec32d8d8f
Added strwidth() and strchars() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
6185 The result is a Number, which is the number of display cells |
da6ec32d8d8f
Added strwidth() and strchars() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
6186 String {expr} occupies. A Tab character is counted as one |
2339
01e4b4d37842
Added strdisplaywidth() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2338
diff
changeset
|
6187 cell, alternatively use |strdisplaywidth()|. |
2338
da6ec32d8d8f
Added strwidth() and strchars() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
6188 When {expr} contains characters with East Asian Width Class |
da6ec32d8d8f
Added strwidth() and strchars() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
6189 Ambiguous, this function's return value depends on 'ambiwidth'. |
2339
01e4b4d37842
Added strdisplaywidth() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2338
diff
changeset
|
6190 Also see |strlen()|, |strdisplaywidth()| and |strchars()|. |
2338
da6ec32d8d8f
Added strwidth() and strchars() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
6191 |
5794 | 6192 submatch({nr}[, {list}]) *submatch()* |
2908 | 6193 Only for an expression in a |:substitute| command or |
6194 substitute() function. | |
6195 Returns the {nr}'th submatch of the matched text. When {nr} | |
6196 is 0 the whole matched text is returned. | |
5794 | 6197 Note that a NL in the string can stand for a line break of a |
6198 multi-line match or a NUL character in the text. | |
2908 | 6199 Also see |sub-replace-expression|. |
5794 | 6200 |
6201 If {list} is present and non-zero then submatch() returns | |
6202 a list of strings, similar to |getline()| with two arguments. | |
6203 NL characters in the text represent NUL characters in the | |
6204 text. | |
6205 Only returns more than one item for |:substitute|, inside | |
6206 |substitute()| this list will always contain one or zero | |
6207 items, since there are no real line breaks. | |
6208 | |
7 | 6209 Example: > |
6210 :s/\d\+/\=submatch(0) + 1/ | |
6211 < This finds the first number in the line and adds one to it. | |
6212 A line break is included as a newline character. | |
6213 | |
6214 substitute({expr}, {pat}, {sub}, {flags}) *substitute()* | |
6215 The result is a String, which is a copy of {expr}, in which | |
2908 | 6216 the first match of {pat} is replaced with {sub}. |
6217 When {flags} is "g", all matches of {pat} in {expr} are | |
6218 replaced. Otherwise {flags} should be "". | |
6219 | |
6220 This works like the ":substitute" command (without any flags). | |
6221 But the matching with {pat} is always done like the 'magic' | |
6222 option is set and 'cpoptions' is empty (to make scripts | |
3967 | 6223 portable). 'ignorecase' is still relevant, use |/\c| or |/\C| |
6224 if you want to ignore or match case and ignore 'ignorecase'. | |
6225 'smartcase' is not used. See |string-match| for how {pat} is | |
6226 used. | |
2908 | 6227 |
6228 A "~" in {sub} is not replaced with the previous {sub}. | |
7 | 6229 Note that some codes in {sub} have a special meaning |
1621 | 6230 |sub-replace-special|. For example, to replace something with |
7 | 6231 "\n" (two characters), use "\\\\n" or '\\n'. |
2908 | 6232 |
7 | 6233 When {pat} does not match in {expr}, {expr} is returned |
6234 unmodified. | |
2908 | 6235 |
7 | 6236 Example: > |
6237 :let &path = substitute(&path, ",\\=[^,]*$", "", "") | |
6238 < This removes the last component of the 'path' option. > | |
6239 :echo substitute("testing", ".*", "\\U\\0", "") | |
6240 < results in "TESTING". | |
2908 | 6241 |
6242 When {sub} starts with "\=", the remainder is interpreted as | |
6243 an expression. See |sub-replace-expression|. Example: > | |
2833 | 6244 :echo substitute(s, '%\(\x\x\)', |
6245 \ '\=nr2char("0x" . submatch(1))', 'g') | |
7 | 6246 |
32 | 6247 synID({lnum}, {col}, {trans}) *synID()* |
7 | 6248 The result is a Number, which is the syntax ID at the position |
32 | 6249 {lnum} and {col} in the current window. |
7 | 6250 The syntax ID can be used with |synIDattr()| and |
6251 |synIDtrans()| to obtain syntax information about text. | |
419 | 6252 |
32 | 6253 {col} is 1 for the leftmost column, {lnum} is 1 for the first |
419 | 6254 line. 'synmaxcol' applies, in a longer line zero is returned. |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7100
diff
changeset
|
6255 Note that when the position is after the last character, |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7100
diff
changeset
|
6256 that's where the cursor can be in Insert mode, synID() returns |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7100
diff
changeset
|
6257 zero. |
419 | 6258 |
7 | 6259 When {trans} is non-zero, transparent items are reduced to the |
1621 | 6260 item that they reveal. This is useful when wanting to know |
7 | 6261 the effective color. When {trans} is zero, the transparent |
6262 item is returned. This is useful when wanting to know which | |
6263 syntax item is effective (e.g. inside parens). | |
6264 Warning: This function can be very slow. Best speed is | |
6265 obtained by going through the file in forward direction. | |
6266 | |
6267 Example (echoes the name of the syntax item under the cursor): > | |
6268 :echo synIDattr(synID(line("."), col("."), 1), "name") | |
6269 < | |
2401
e7751177126b
Add the synconcealed() function and use it for :TOhtml. (Benjamin Fritz)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
6270 |
7 | 6271 synIDattr({synID}, {what} [, {mode}]) *synIDattr()* |
6272 The result is a String, which is the {what} attribute of | |
6273 syntax ID {synID}. This can be used to obtain information | |
6274 about a syntax item. | |
6275 {mode} can be "gui", "cterm" or "term", to get the attributes | |
1621 | 6276 for that mode. When {mode} is omitted, or an invalid value is |
7 | 6277 used, the attributes for the currently active highlighting are |
6278 used (GUI, cterm or term). | |
6279 Use synIDtrans() to follow linked highlight groups. | |
6280 {what} result | |
6281 "name" the name of the syntax item | |
6282 "fg" foreground color (GUI: color name used to set | |
6283 the color, cterm: color number as a string, | |
6284 term: empty string) | |
1755 | 6285 "bg" background color (as with "fg") |
2106
15674e198164
updated for version 7.2.389
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2072
diff
changeset
|
6286 "font" font name (only available in the GUI) |
15674e198164
updated for version 7.2.389
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2072
diff
changeset
|
6287 |highlight-font| |
1755 | 6288 "sp" special color (as with "fg") |highlight-guisp| |
7 | 6289 "fg#" like "fg", but for the GUI and the GUI is |
6290 running the name in "#RRGGBB" form | |
6291 "bg#" like "fg#" for "bg" | |
1755 | 6292 "sp#" like "fg#" for "sp" |
7 | 6293 "bold" "1" if bold |
6294 "italic" "1" if italic | |
6295 "reverse" "1" if reverse | |
6296 "inverse" "1" if inverse (= reverse) | |
2106
15674e198164
updated for version 7.2.389
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2072
diff
changeset
|
6297 "standout" "1" if standout |
7 | 6298 "underline" "1" if underlined |
205 | 6299 "undercurl" "1" if undercurled |
7 | 6300 |
6301 Example (echoes the color of the syntax item under the | |
6302 cursor): > | |
6303 :echo synIDattr(synIDtrans(synID(line("."), col("."), 1)), "fg") | |
6304 < | |
6305 synIDtrans({synID}) *synIDtrans()* | |
6306 The result is a Number, which is the translated syntax ID of | |
6307 {synID}. This is the syntax group ID of what is being used to | |
6308 highlight the character. Highlight links given with | |
6309 ":highlight link" are followed. | |
6310 | |
2608
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
6311 synconcealed({lnum}, {col}) *synconcealed()* |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
6312 The result is a List. The first item in the list is 0 if the |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
6313 character at the position {lnum} and {col} is not part of a |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
6314 concealable region, 1 if it is. The second item in the list is |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
6315 a string. If the first item is 1, the second item contains the |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
6316 text which will be displayed in place of the concealed text, |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
6317 depending on the current setting of 'conceallevel'. The third |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
6318 and final item in the list is a unique number representing the |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
6319 specific syntax region matched. This allows detection of the |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
6320 beginning of a new concealable region if there are two |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
6321 consecutive regions with the same replacement character. |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
6322 For an example use see $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/2html.vim . |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
6323 |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
6324 |
1500 | 6325 synstack({lnum}, {col}) *synstack()* |
6326 Return a |List|, which is the stack of syntax items at the | |
6327 position {lnum} and {col} in the current window. Each item in | |
6328 the List is an ID like what |synID()| returns. | |
6329 The first item in the List is the outer region, following are | |
6330 items contained in that one. The last one is what |synID()| | |
6331 returns, unless not the whole item is highlighted or it is a | |
6332 transparent item. | |
6333 This function is useful for debugging a syntax file. | |
6334 Example that shows the syntax stack under the cursor: > | |
6335 for id in synstack(line("."), col(".")) | |
6336 echo synIDattr(id, "name") | |
6337 endfor | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2281
diff
changeset
|
6338 < When the position specified with {lnum} and {col} is invalid |
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2281
diff
changeset
|
6339 nothing is returned. The position just after the last |
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2281
diff
changeset
|
6340 character in a line and the first column in an empty line are |
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2281
diff
changeset
|
6341 valid positions. |
1500 | 6342 |
24 | 6343 system({expr} [, {input}]) *system()* *E677* |
5808 | 6344 Get the output of the shell command {expr} as a string. See |
6345 |systemlist()| to get the output as a List. | |
5806 | 6346 |
6347 When {input} is given and is a string this string is written | |
6348 to a file and passed as stdin to the command. The string is | |
6349 written as-is, you need to take care of using the correct line | |
6350 separators yourself. | |
6351 If {input} is given and is a |List| it is written to the file | |
6352 in a way |writefile()| does with {binary} set to "b" (i.e. | |
6353 with a newline between each list item with newlines inside | |
6354 list items converted to NULs). | |
6355 Pipes are not used. | |
6356 | |
6183 | 6357 When prepended by |:silent| the shell will not be set to |
6358 cooked mode. This is meant to be used for commands that do | |
6359 not need the user to type. It avoids stray characters showing | |
6360 up on the screen which require |CTRL-L| to remove. > | |
6361 :silent let f = system('ls *.vim') | |
6362 < | |
5690 | 6363 Note: Use |shellescape()| or |::S| with |expand()| or |
6364 |fnamemodify()| to escape special characters in a command | |
6365 argument. Newlines in {expr} may cause the command to fail. | |
6366 The characters in 'shellquote' and 'shellxquote' may also | |
6367 cause trouble. | |
7 | 6368 This is not to be used for interactive commands. |
1661 | 6369 |
7 | 6370 The result is a String. Example: > |
1661 | 6371 :let files = system("ls " . shellescape(expand('%:h'))) |
5690 | 6372 :let files = system('ls ' . expand('%:h:S')) |
7 | 6373 |
6374 < To make the result more system-independent, the shell output | |
6375 is filtered to replace <CR> with <NL> for Macintosh, and | |
6376 <CR><NL> with <NL> for DOS-like systems. | |
5277 | 6377 To avoid the string being truncated at a NUL, all NUL |
6378 characters are replaced with SOH (0x01). | |
6379 | |
7 | 6380 The command executed is constructed using several options: |
6381 'shell' 'shellcmdflag' 'shellxquote' {expr} 'shellredir' {tmp} 'shellxquote' | |
6382 ({tmp} is an automatically generated file name). | |
6383 For Unix and OS/2 braces are put around {expr} to allow for | |
6384 concatenated commands. | |
6385 | |
794 | 6386 The command will be executed in "cooked" mode, so that a |
6387 CTRL-C will interrupt the command (on Unix at least). | |
6388 | |
7 | 6389 The resulting error code can be found in |v:shell_error|. |
6390 This function will fail in |restricted-mode|. | |
625 | 6391 |
6392 Note that any wrong value in the options mentioned above may | |
6393 make the function fail. It has also been reported to fail | |
6394 when using a security agent application. | |
7 | 6395 Unlike ":!cmd" there is no automatic check for changed files. |
6396 Use |:checktime| to force a check. | |
6397 | |
205 | 6398 |
5808 | 6399 systemlist({expr} [, {input}]) *systemlist()* |
6400 Same as |system()|, but returns a |List| with lines (parts of | |
6401 output separated by NL) with NULs transformed into NLs. Output | |
6402 is the same as |readfile()| will output with {binary} argument | |
6403 set to "b". | |
6404 | |
6405 Returns an empty string on error, so be careful not to run | |
6406 into |E706|. | |
6407 | |
6408 | |
677 | 6409 tabpagebuflist([{arg}]) *tabpagebuflist()* |
685 | 6410 The result is a |List|, where each item is the number of the |
677 | 6411 buffer associated with each window in the current tab page. |
6412 {arg} specifies the number of tab page to be used. When | |
6413 omitted the current tab page is used. | |
6414 When {arg} is invalid the number zero is returned. | |
6415 To get a list of all buffers in all tabs use this: > | |
3445 | 6416 let buflist = [] |
677 | 6417 for i in range(tabpagenr('$')) |
3445 | 6418 call extend(buflist, tabpagebuflist(i + 1)) |
677 | 6419 endfor |
6420 < Note that a buffer may appear in more than one window. | |
6421 | |
6422 | |
6423 tabpagenr([{arg}]) *tabpagenr()* | |
674 | 6424 The result is a Number, which is the number of the current |
6425 tab page. The first tab page has number 1. | |
6426 When the optional argument is "$", the number of the last tab | |
6427 page is returned (the tab page count). | |
6428 The number can be used with the |:tab| command. | |
6429 | |
6430 | |
5763 | 6431 tabpagewinnr({tabarg} [, {arg}]) *tabpagewinnr()* |
2569
f612f6b0b883
Docs fix for tabpagewinnr(). (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
6432 Like |winnr()| but for tab page {tabarg}. |
677 | 6433 {tabarg} specifies the number of tab page to be used. |
6434 {arg} is used like with |winnr()|: | |
6435 - When omitted the current window number is returned. This is | |
6436 the window which will be used when going to this tab page. | |
6437 - When "$" the number of windows is returned. | |
6438 - When "#" the previous window nr is returned. | |
6439 Useful examples: > | |
6440 tabpagewinnr(1) " current window of tab page 1 | |
6441 tabpagewinnr(4, '$') " number of windows in tab page 4 | |
6442 < When {tabarg} is invalid zero is returned. | |
6443 | |
805 | 6444 *tagfiles()* |
6445 tagfiles() Returns a |List| with the file names used to search for tags | |
6446 for the current buffer. This is the 'tags' option expanded. | |
6447 | |
6448 | |
205 | 6449 taglist({expr}) *taglist()* |
6450 Returns a list of tags matching the regular expression {expr}. | |
438 | 6451 Each list item is a dictionary with at least the following |
6452 entries: | |
648 | 6453 name Name of the tag. |
6454 filename Name of the file where the tag is | |
1156 | 6455 defined. It is either relative to the |
6456 current directory or a full path. | |
205 | 6457 cmd Ex command used to locate the tag in |
6458 the file. | |
648 | 6459 kind Type of the tag. The value for this |
205 | 6460 entry depends on the language specific |
1156 | 6461 kind values. Only available when |
6462 using a tags file generated by | |
6463 Exuberant ctags or hdrtag. | |
648 | 6464 static A file specific tag. Refer to |
205 | 6465 |static-tag| for more information. |
1156 | 6466 More entries may be present, depending on the content of the |
6467 tags file: access, implementation, inherits and signature. | |
6468 Refer to the ctags documentation for information about these | |
6469 fields. For C code the fields "struct", "class" and "enum" | |
6470 may appear, they give the name of the entity the tag is | |
6471 contained in. | |
452 | 6472 |
216 | 6473 The ex-command 'cmd' can be either an ex search pattern, a |
6474 line number or a line number followed by a byte number. | |
205 | 6475 |
6476 If there are no matching tags, then an empty list is returned. | |
6477 | |
6478 To get an exact tag match, the anchors '^' and '$' should be | |
4073 | 6479 used in {expr}. This also make the function work faster. |
6480 Refer to |tag-regexp| for more information about the tag | |
6481 search regular expression pattern. | |
205 | 6482 |
6483 Refer to |'tags'| for information about how the tags file is | |
6484 located by Vim. Refer to |tags-file-format| for the format of | |
6485 the tags file generated by the different ctags tools. | |
6486 | |
7 | 6487 tempname() *tempname()* *temp-file-name* |
6488 The result is a String, which is the name of a file that | |
1621 | 6489 doesn't exist. It can be used for a temporary file. The name |
7 | 6490 is different for at least 26 consecutive calls. Example: > |
6491 :let tmpfile = tempname() | |
6492 :exe "redir > " . tmpfile | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
6493 < For Unix, the file will be in a private directory |tempfile|. |
7 | 6494 For MS-Windows forward slashes are used when the 'shellslash' |
6495 option is set or when 'shellcmdflag' starts with '-'. | |
6496 | |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6497 |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6498 tan({expr}) *tan()* |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
6499 Return the tangent of {expr}, measured in radians, as a |Float| |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6500 in the range [-inf, inf]. |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
6501 {expr} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number|. |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6502 Examples: > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6503 :echo tan(10) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6504 < 0.648361 > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6505 :echo tan(-4.01) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6506 < -1.181502 |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2569
diff
changeset
|
6507 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6508 |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6509 |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6510 tanh({expr}) *tanh()* |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
6511 Return the hyperbolic tangent of {expr} as a |Float| in the |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6512 range [-1, 1]. |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
6513 {expr} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number|. |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6514 Examples: > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6515 :echo tanh(0.5) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6516 < 0.462117 > |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6517 :echo tanh(-1) |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6518 < -0.761594 |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2569
diff
changeset
|
6519 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} |
2206
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6520 |
a8afba7027ae
Add extra floating point functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
6521 |
7 | 6522 tolower({expr}) *tolower()* |
6523 The result is a copy of the String given, with all uppercase | |
6524 characters turned into lowercase (just like applying |gu| to | |
6525 the string). | |
6526 | |
6527 toupper({expr}) *toupper()* | |
6528 The result is a copy of the String given, with all lowercase | |
6529 characters turned into uppercase (just like applying |gU| to | |
6530 the string). | |
6531 | |
15 | 6532 tr({src}, {fromstr}, {tostr}) *tr()* |
6533 The result is a copy of the {src} string with all characters | |
6534 which appear in {fromstr} replaced by the character in that | |
6535 position in the {tostr} string. Thus the first character in | |
6536 {fromstr} is translated into the first character in {tostr} | |
6537 and so on. Exactly like the unix "tr" command. | |
6538 This code also deals with multibyte characters properly. | |
6539 | |
6540 Examples: > | |
6541 echo tr("hello there", "ht", "HT") | |
6542 < returns "Hello THere" > | |
6543 echo tr("<blob>", "<>", "{}") | |
6544 < returns "{blob}" | |
6545 | |
1621 | 6546 trunc({expr}) *trunc()* |
1668 | 6547 Return the largest integral value with magnitude less than or |
1621 | 6548 equal to {expr} as a |Float| (truncate towards zero). |
6549 {expr} must evaluate to a |Float| or a |Number|. | |
6550 Examples: > | |
6551 echo trunc(1.456) | |
6552 < 1.0 > | |
6553 echo trunc(-5.456) | |
6554 < -5.0 > | |
6555 echo trunc(4.0) | |
6556 < 4.0 | |
6557 {only available when compiled with the |+float| feature} | |
6558 | |
87 | 6559 *type()* |
6560 type({expr}) The result is a Number, depending on the type of {expr}: | |
153 | 6561 Number: 0 |
6562 String: 1 | |
6563 Funcref: 2 | |
6564 List: 3 | |
6565 Dictionary: 4 | |
1621 | 6566 Float: 5 |
153 | 6567 To avoid the magic numbers it should be used this way: > |
87 | 6568 :if type(myvar) == type(0) |
6569 :if type(myvar) == type("") | |
6570 :if type(myvar) == type(function("tr")) | |
6571 :if type(myvar) == type([]) | |
153 | 6572 :if type(myvar) == type({}) |
1621 | 6573 :if type(myvar) == type(0.0) |
7 | 6574 |
2236
dc2e5ec0500d
Added the undofile() function. Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2226
diff
changeset
|
6575 undofile({name}) *undofile()* |
dc2e5ec0500d
Added the undofile() function. Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2226
diff
changeset
|
6576 Return the name of the undo file that would be used for a file |
dc2e5ec0500d
Added the undofile() function. Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2226
diff
changeset
|
6577 with name {name} when writing. This uses the 'undodir' |
dc2e5ec0500d
Added the undofile() function. Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2226
diff
changeset
|
6578 option, finding directories that exist. It does not check if |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
6579 the undo file exists. |
2249
6d3d35ff2c2b
Use full path in undofile(). Updated docs.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2236
diff
changeset
|
6580 {name} is always expanded to the full path, since that is what |
6d3d35ff2c2b
Use full path in undofile(). Updated docs.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2236
diff
changeset
|
6581 is used internally. |
3507
8201108e9cf0
More runtime file fixes for 'compatible' mode.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3492
diff
changeset
|
6582 If {name} is empty undofile() returns an empty string, since a |
8201108e9cf0
More runtime file fixes for 'compatible' mode.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3492
diff
changeset
|
6583 buffer without a file name will not write an undo file. |
2236
dc2e5ec0500d
Added the undofile() function. Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2226
diff
changeset
|
6584 Useful in combination with |:wundo| and |:rundo|. |
dc2e5ec0500d
Added the undofile() function. Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2226
diff
changeset
|
6585 When compiled without the +persistent_undo option this always |
dc2e5ec0500d
Added the undofile() function. Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2226
diff
changeset
|
6586 returns an empty string. |
dc2e5ec0500d
Added the undofile() function. Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2226
diff
changeset
|
6587 |
2280
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6588 undotree() *undotree()* |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6589 Return the current state of the undo tree in a dictionary with |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6590 the following items: |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6591 "seq_last" The highest undo sequence number used. |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6592 "seq_cur" The sequence number of the current position in |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6593 the undo tree. This differs from "seq_last" |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6594 when some changes were undone. |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6595 "time_cur" Time last used for |:earlier| and related |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6596 commands. Use |strftime()| to convert to |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6597 something readable. |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6598 "save_last" Number of the last file write. Zero when no |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6599 write yet. |
2281
e41433ea71df
Added ":earlier 1f" and ":later 1f".
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2280
diff
changeset
|
6600 "save_cur" Number of the current position in the undo |
e41433ea71df
Added ":earlier 1f" and ":later 1f".
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2280
diff
changeset
|
6601 tree. |
2280
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6602 "synced" Non-zero when the last undo block was synced. |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6603 This happens when waiting from input from the |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6604 user. See |undo-blocks|. |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6605 "entries" A list of dictionaries with information about |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6606 undo blocks. |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6607 |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6608 The first item in the "entries" list is the oldest undo item. |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6609 Each List item is a Dictionary with these items: |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6610 "seq" Undo sequence number. Same as what appears in |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6611 |:undolist|. |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6612 "time" Timestamp when the change happened. Use |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6613 |strftime()| to convert to something readable. |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6614 "newhead" Only appears in the item that is the last one |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6615 that was added. This marks the last change |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6616 and where further changes will be added. |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6617 "curhead" Only appears in the item that is the last one |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6618 that was undone. This marks the current |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6619 position in the undo tree, the block that will |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6620 be used by a redo command. When nothing was |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6621 undone after the last change this item will |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6622 not appear anywhere. |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6623 "save" Only appears on the last block before a file |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6624 write. The number is the write count. The |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6625 first write has number 1, the last one the |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6626 "save_last" mentioned above. |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6627 "alt" Alternate entry. This is again a List of undo |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6628 blocks. Each item may again have an "alt" |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6629 item. |
941ff1cd317a
Add file save counter to undo information. Add undotree() function.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2252
diff
changeset
|
6630 |
5747 | 6631 uniq({list} [, {func} [, {dict}]]) *uniq()* *E882* |
6632 Remove second and succeeding copies of repeated adjacent | |
6633 {list} items in-place. Returns {list}. If you want a list | |
6634 to remain unmodified make a copy first: > | |
6635 :let newlist = uniq(copy(mylist)) | |
6636 < The default compare function uses the string representation of | |
6637 each item. For the use of {func} and {dict} see |sort()|. | |
6638 | |
140 | 6639 values({dict}) *values()* |
1621 | 6640 Return a |List| with all the values of {dict}. The |List| is |
685 | 6641 in arbitrary order. |
140 | 6642 |
6643 | |
7 | 6644 virtcol({expr}) *virtcol()* |
6645 The result is a Number, which is the screen column of the file | |
6646 position given with {expr}. That is, the last screen position | |
6647 occupied by the character at that position, when the screen | |
6648 would be of unlimited width. When there is a <Tab> at the | |
6649 position, the returned Number will be the column at the end of | |
6650 the <Tab>. For example, for a <Tab> in column 1, with 'ts' | |
3445 | 6651 set to 8, it returns 8. |conceal| is ignored. |
1317 | 6652 For the byte position use |col()|. |
6653 For the use of {expr} see |col()|. | |
6654 When 'virtualedit' is used {expr} can be [lnum, col, off], where | |
703 | 6655 "off" is the offset in screen columns from the start of the |
1266 | 6656 character. E.g., a position within a <Tab> or after the last |
2965 | 6657 character. When "off" is omitted zero is used. |
7 | 6658 When Virtual editing is active in the current mode, a position |
6659 beyond the end of the line can be returned. |'virtualedit'| | |
6660 The accepted positions are: | |
6661 . the cursor position | |
6662 $ the end of the cursor line (the result is the | |
6663 number of displayed characters in the cursor line | |
6664 plus one) | |
6665 'x position of mark x (if the mark is not set, 0 is | |
6666 returned) | |
6447 | 6667 v In Visual mode: the start of the Visual area (the |
6668 cursor is the end). When not in Visual mode | |
6669 returns the cursor position. Differs from |'<| in | |
6670 that it's updated right away. | |
7 | 6671 Note that only marks in the current file can be used. |
6672 Examples: > | |
6673 virtcol(".") with text "foo^Lbar", with cursor on the "^L", returns 5 | |
6674 virtcol("$") with text "foo^Lbar", returns 9 | |
1621 | 6675 virtcol("'t") with text " there", with 't at 'h', returns 6 |
6676 < The first column is 1. 0 is returned for an error. | |
1156 | 6677 A more advanced example that echoes the maximum length of |
6678 all lines: > | |
6679 echo max(map(range(1, line('$')), "virtcol([v:val, '$'])")) | |
6680 | |
7 | 6681 |
6682 visualmode([expr]) *visualmode()* | |
6683 The result is a String, which describes the last Visual mode | |
856 | 6684 used in the current buffer. Initially it returns an empty |
6685 string, but once Visual mode has been used, it returns "v", | |
6686 "V", or "<CTRL-V>" (a single CTRL-V character) for | |
6687 character-wise, line-wise, or block-wise Visual mode | |
6688 respectively. | |
7 | 6689 Example: > |
6690 :exe "normal " . visualmode() | |
6691 < This enters the same Visual mode as before. It is also useful | |
6692 in scripts if you wish to act differently depending on the | |
6693 Visual mode that was used. | |
1621 | 6694 If Visual mode is active, use |mode()| to get the Visual mode |
6695 (e.g., in a |:vmap|). | |
1661 | 6696 *non-zero-arg* |
6697 If [expr] is supplied and it evaluates to a non-zero Number or | |
6698 a non-empty String, then the Visual mode will be cleared and | |
1621 | 6699 the old value is returned. Note that " " and "0" are also |
1661 | 6700 non-empty strings, thus cause the mode to be cleared. A List, |
6701 Dictionary or Float is not a Number or String, thus does not | |
6702 cause the mode to be cleared. | |
7 | 6703 |
4151 | 6704 wildmenumode() *wildmenumode()* |
6705 Returns non-zero when the wildmenu is active and zero | |
6706 otherwise. See 'wildmenu' and 'wildmode'. | |
6707 This can be used in mappings to handle the 'wildcharm' option | |
6708 gracefully. (Makes only sense with |mapmode-c| mappings). | |
6709 | |
6710 For example to make <c-j> work like <down> in wildmode, use: > | |
6711 :cnoremap <expr> <C-j> wildmenumode() ? "\<Down>\<Tab>" : "\<c-j>" | |
6712 < | |
6713 (Note, this needs the 'wildcharm' option set appropriately). | |
6714 | |
6715 | |
7 | 6716 *winbufnr()* |
6717 winbufnr({nr}) The result is a Number, which is the number of the buffer | |
236 | 6718 associated with window {nr}. When {nr} is zero, the number of |
7 | 6719 the buffer in the current window is returned. When window |
6720 {nr} doesn't exist, -1 is returned. | |
6721 Example: > | |
6722 :echo "The file in the current window is " . bufname(winbufnr(0)) | |
6723 < | |
6724 *wincol()* | |
6725 wincol() The result is a Number, which is the virtual column of the | |
6726 cursor in the window. This is counting screen cells from the | |
6727 left side of the window. The leftmost column is one. | |
6728 | |
6729 winheight({nr}) *winheight()* | |
6730 The result is a Number, which is the height of window {nr}. | |
6731 When {nr} is zero, the height of the current window is | |
6732 returned. When window {nr} doesn't exist, -1 is returned. | |
6733 An existing window always has a height of zero or more. | |
6734 Examples: > | |
6735 :echo "The current window has " . winheight(0) . " lines." | |
6736 < | |
6737 *winline()* | |
6738 winline() The result is a Number, which is the screen line of the cursor | |
1621 | 6739 in the window. This is counting screen lines from the top of |
7 | 6740 the window. The first line is one. |
531 | 6741 If the cursor was moved the view on the file will be updated |
6742 first, this may cause a scroll. | |
7 | 6743 |
6744 *winnr()* | |
20 | 6745 winnr([{arg}]) The result is a Number, which is the number of the current |
6746 window. The top window has number 1. | |
6747 When the optional argument is "$", the number of the | |
3967 | 6748 last window is returned (the window count). > |
6749 let window_count = winnr('$') | |
6750 < When the optional argument is "#", the number of the last | |
20 | 6751 accessed window is returned (where |CTRL-W_p| goes to). |
1156 | 6752 If there is no previous window or it is in another tab page 0 |
6753 is returned. | |
20 | 6754 The number can be used with |CTRL-W_w| and ":wincmd w" |
6755 |:wincmd|. | |
1156 | 6756 Also see |tabpagewinnr()|. |
7 | 6757 |
6758 *winrestcmd()* | |
6759 winrestcmd() Returns a sequence of |:resize| commands that should restore | |
6760 the current window sizes. Only works properly when no windows | |
712 | 6761 are opened or closed and the current window and tab page is |
6762 unchanged. | |
7 | 6763 Example: > |
6764 :let cmd = winrestcmd() | |
6765 :call MessWithWindowSizes() | |
6766 :exe cmd | |
712 | 6767 < |
6768 *winrestview()* | |
6769 winrestview({dict}) | |
6770 Uses the |Dictionary| returned by |winsaveview()| to restore | |
6771 the view of the current window. | |
5940 | 6772 Note: The {dict} does not have to contain all values, that are |
6773 returned by |winsaveview()|. If values are missing, those | |
6774 settings won't be restored. So you can use: > | |
6775 :call winrestview({'curswant': 4}) | |
6776 < | |
6777 This will only set the curswant value (the column the cursor | |
6778 wants to move on vertical movements) of the cursor to column 5 | |
6779 (yes, that is 5), while all other settings will remain the | |
6780 same. This is useful, if you set the cursor position manually. | |
6781 | |
712 | 6782 If you have changed the values the result is unpredictable. |
6783 If the window size changed the result won't be the same. | |
6784 | |
6785 *winsaveview()* | |
6786 winsaveview() Returns a |Dictionary| that contains information to restore | |
6787 the view of the current window. Use |winrestview()| to | |
6788 restore the view. | |
6789 This is useful if you have a mapping that jumps around in the | |
6790 buffer and you want to go back to the original view. | |
6791 This does not save fold information. Use the 'foldenable' | |
798 | 6792 option to temporarily switch off folding, so that folds are |
6070
32a77cc160d9
Update runtime files. Make matchparen plugin backwards compatible.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
6051
diff
changeset
|
6793 not opened when moving around. This may have side effects. |
712 | 6794 The return value includes: |
6795 lnum cursor line number | |
5940 | 6796 col cursor column (Note: the first column |
6797 zero, as opposed to what getpos() | |
6798 returns) | |
712 | 6799 coladd cursor column offset for 'virtualedit' |
6800 curswant column for vertical movement | |
6801 topline first line in the window | |
6802 topfill filler lines, only in diff mode | |
6803 leftcol first column displayed | |
6804 skipcol columns skipped | |
6805 Note that no option values are saved. | |
6806 | |
7 | 6807 |
6808 winwidth({nr}) *winwidth()* | |
6809 The result is a Number, which is the width of window {nr}. | |
6810 When {nr} is zero, the width of the current window is | |
6811 returned. When window {nr} doesn't exist, -1 is returned. | |
6812 An existing window always has a width of zero or more. | |
6813 Examples: > | |
6814 :echo "The current window has " . winwidth(0) . " columns." | |
6815 :if winwidth(0) <= 50 | |
6816 : exe "normal 50\<C-W>|" | |
6817 :endif | |
6818 < | |
7480
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6819 wordcount() *wordcount()* |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6820 The result is a dictionary of byte/chars/word statistics for |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6821 the current buffer. This is the same info as provided by |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6822 |g_CTRL-G| |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6823 The return value includes: |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6824 bytes Number of bytes in the buffer |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6825 chars Number of chars in the buffer |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6826 words Number of words in the buffer |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6827 cursor_bytes Number of bytes before cursor position |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6828 (not in Visual mode) |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6829 cursor_chars Number of chars before cursor position |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6830 (not in Visual mode) |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6831 cursor_words Number of words before cursor position |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6832 (not in Visual mode) |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6833 visual_bytes Number of bytes visually selected |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6834 (only in Visual mode) |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6835 visual_chars Number of chars visually selected |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6836 (only in Visual mode) |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6837 visual_words Number of chars visually selected |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6838 (only in Visual mode) |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6839 |
a49163681559
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ed767a2073ef150971b0439a58e7ee582af6984e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6840 |
158 | 6841 *writefile()* |
6341 | 6842 writefile({list}, {fname} [, {flags}]) |
685 | 6843 Write |List| {list} to file {fname}. Each list item is |
158 | 6844 separated with a NL. Each list item must be a String or |
6845 Number. | |
6341 | 6846 When {flags} contains "b" then binary mode is used: There will |
158 | 6847 not be a NL after the last list item. An empty item at the |
6848 end does cause the last line in the file to end in a NL. | |
6341 | 6849 |
6850 When {flags} contains "a" then append mode is used, lines are | |
6851 append to the file: > | |
6852 :call writefile(["foo"], "event.log", "a") | |
6853 :call writefile(["bar"], "event.log", "a") | |
6854 > | |
6855 < All NL characters are replaced with a NUL character. | |
158 | 6856 Inserting CR characters needs to be done before passing {list} |
6857 to writefile(). | |
6858 An existing file is overwritten, if possible. | |
6859 When the write fails -1 is returned, otherwise 0. There is an | |
6860 error message if the file can't be created or when writing | |
6861 fails. | |
6862 Also see |readfile()|. | |
6863 To copy a file byte for byte: > | |
6864 :let fl = readfile("foo", "b") | |
6865 :call writefile(fl, "foocopy", "b") | |
3214 | 6866 |
6867 | |
6868 xor({expr}, {expr}) *xor()* | |
6869 Bitwise XOR on the two arguments. The arguments are converted | |
6870 to a number. A List, Dict or Float argument causes an error. | |
6871 Example: > | |
6872 :let bits = xor(bits, 0x80) | |
3256 | 6873 < |
3214 | 6874 |
7 | 6875 |
6876 *feature-list* | |
6009 | 6877 There are four types of features: |
7 | 6878 1. Features that are only supported when they have been enabled when Vim |
6879 was compiled |+feature-list|. Example: > | |
6880 :if has("cindent") | |
6881 2. Features that are only supported when certain conditions have been met. | |
6882 Example: > | |
6883 :if has("gui_running") | |
6884 < *has-patch* | |
5814 | 6885 3. Included patches. The "patch123" feature means that patch 123 has been |
6886 included. Note that this form does not check the version of Vim, you need | |
6887 to inspect |v:version| for that. | |
6888 Example (checking version 6.2.148 or later): > | |
7 | 6889 :if v:version > 602 || v:version == 602 && has("patch148") |
5814 | 6890 < Note that it's possible for patch 147 to be omitted even though 148 is |
6891 included. | |
6892 | |
6893 4. Beyond a certain version or at a certain version and including a specific | |
5862 | 6894 patch. The "patch-7.4.237" feature means that the Vim version is 7.5 or |
6895 later, or it is version 7.4 and patch 237 was included. | |
6896 Note that this only works for patch 7.4.237 and later, before that you | |
6897 need to use the example above that checks v:version. Example: > | |
6898 :if has("patch-7.4.248") | |
5814 | 6899 < Note that it's possible for patch 147 to be omitted even though 148 is |
1156 | 6900 included. |
7 | 6901 |
5340 | 6902 acl Compiled with |ACL| support. |
7 | 6903 all_builtin_terms Compiled with all builtin terminals enabled. |
6904 amiga Amiga version of Vim. | |
6905 arabic Compiled with Arabic support |Arabic|. | |
6906 arp Compiled with ARP support (Amiga). | |
613 | 6907 autocmd Compiled with autocommand support. |autocommand| |
7 | 6908 balloon_eval Compiled with |balloon-eval| support. |
435 | 6909 balloon_multiline GUI supports multiline balloons. |
7 | 6910 beos BeOS version of Vim. |
6911 browse Compiled with |:browse| support, and browse() will | |
6912 work. | |
3682 | 6913 browsefilter Compiled with support for |browsefilter|. |
7 | 6914 builtin_terms Compiled with some builtin terminals. |
6915 byte_offset Compiled with support for 'o' in 'statusline' | |
6916 cindent Compiled with 'cindent' support. | |
6917 clientserver Compiled with remote invocation support |clientserver|. | |
6918 clipboard Compiled with 'clipboard' support. | |
6919 cmdline_compl Compiled with |cmdline-completion| support. | |
6920 cmdline_hist Compiled with |cmdline-history| support. | |
6921 cmdline_info Compiled with 'showcmd' and 'ruler' support. | |
6922 comments Compiled with |'comments'| support. | |
2681 | 6923 compatible Compiled to be very Vi compatible. |
7 | 6924 cryptv Compiled with encryption support |encryption|. |
6925 cscope Compiled with |cscope| support. | |
6926 debug Compiled with "DEBUG" defined. | |
6927 dialog_con Compiled with console dialog support. | |
6928 dialog_gui Compiled with GUI dialog support. | |
6929 diff Compiled with |vimdiff| and 'diff' support. | |
6930 digraphs Compiled with support for digraphs. | |
6110 | 6931 directx Compiled with support for Direct-X and 'renderoptions'. |
7 | 6932 dnd Compiled with support for the "~ register |quote_~|. |
2681 | 6933 dos16 16 bits DOS version of Vim. |
7 | 6934 dos32 32 bits DOS (DJGPP) version of Vim. |
6935 ebcdic Compiled on a machine with ebcdic character set. | |
6936 emacs_tags Compiled with support for Emacs tags. | |
6937 eval Compiled with expression evaluation support. Always | |
6938 true, of course! | |
6939 ex_extra Compiled with extra Ex commands |+ex_extra|. | |
6940 extra_search Compiled with support for |'incsearch'| and | |
6941 |'hlsearch'| | |
6942 farsi Compiled with Farsi support |farsi|. | |
6943 file_in_path Compiled with support for |gf| and |<cfile>| | |
168 | 6944 filterpipe When 'shelltemp' is off pipes are used for shell |
6945 read/write/filter commands | |
7 | 6946 find_in_path Compiled with support for include file searches |
6947 |+find_in_path|. | |
1621 | 6948 float Compiled with support for |Float|. |
7 | 6949 fname_case Case in file names matters (for Amiga, MS-DOS, and |
6950 Windows this is not present). | |
6951 folding Compiled with |folding| support. | |
6952 footer Compiled with GUI footer support. |gui-footer| | |
6953 fork Compiled to use fork()/exec() instead of system(). | |
6954 gettext Compiled with message translation |multi-lang| | |
6955 gui Compiled with GUI enabled. | |
6956 gui_athena Compiled with Athena GUI. | |
2681 | 6957 gui_gnome Compiled with Gnome support (gui_gtk is also defined). |
7 | 6958 gui_gtk Compiled with GTK+ GUI (any version). |
6959 gui_gtk2 Compiled with GTK+ 2 GUI (gui_gtk is also defined). | |
6960 gui_mac Compiled with Macintosh GUI. | |
6961 gui_motif Compiled with Motif GUI. | |
6962 gui_photon Compiled with Photon GUI. | |
2681 | 6963 gui_running Vim is running in the GUI, or it will start soon. |
7 | 6964 gui_win32 Compiled with MS Windows Win32 GUI. |
6965 gui_win32s idem, and Win32s system being used (Windows 3.1) | |
6966 hangul_input Compiled with Hangul input support. |hangul| | |
6967 iconv Can use iconv() for conversion. | |
6968 insert_expand Compiled with support for CTRL-X expansion commands in | |
6969 Insert mode. | |
6970 jumplist Compiled with |jumplist| support. | |
6971 keymap Compiled with 'keymap' support. | |
6972 langmap Compiled with 'langmap' support. | |
6973 libcall Compiled with |libcall()| support. | |
5995 | 6974 linebreak Compiled with 'linebreak', 'breakat', 'showbreak' and |
6975 'breakindent' support. | |
7 | 6976 lispindent Compiled with support for lisp indenting. |
6977 listcmds Compiled with commands for the buffer list |:files| | |
6978 and the argument list |arglist|. | |
6979 localmap Compiled with local mappings and abbr. |:map-local| | |
2320
966a5609669e
Added Lua interfae. (Luis Carvalho)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2290
diff
changeset
|
6980 lua Compiled with Lua interface |Lua|. |
7 | 6981 mac Macintosh version of Vim. |
6982 macunix Macintosh version of Vim, using Unix files (OS-X). | |
6983 menu Compiled with support for |:menu|. | |
6984 mksession Compiled with support for |:mksession|. | |
6985 modify_fname Compiled with file name modifiers. |filename-modifiers| | |
6986 mouse Compiled with support mouse. | |
6987 mouse_dec Compiled with support for Dec terminal mouse. | |
6988 mouse_gpm Compiled with support for gpm (Linux console mouse) | |
6989 mouse_netterm Compiled with support for netterm mouse. | |
6990 mouse_pterm Compiled with support for qnx pterm mouse. | |
1621 | 6991 mouse_sysmouse Compiled with support for sysmouse (*BSD console mouse) |
3750 | 6992 mouse_sgr Compiled with support for sgr mouse. |
3224 | 6993 mouse_urxvt Compiled with support for urxvt mouse. |
7 | 6994 mouse_xterm Compiled with support for xterm mouse. |
2681 | 6995 mouseshape Compiled with support for 'mouseshape'. |
1768 | 6996 multi_byte Compiled with support for 'encoding' |
6997 multi_byte_encoding 'encoding' is set to a multi-byte encoding. | |
7 | 6998 multi_byte_ime Compiled with support for IME input method. |
6999 multi_lang Compiled with support for multiple languages. | |
14 | 7000 mzscheme Compiled with MzScheme interface |mzscheme|. |
2681 | 7001 netbeans_enabled Compiled with support for |netbeans| and connected. |
7 | 7002 netbeans_intg Compiled with support for |netbeans|. |
7003 ole Compiled with OLE automation support for Win32. | |
7004 os2 OS/2 version of Vim. | |
7005 path_extra Compiled with up/downwards search in 'path' and 'tags' | |
7006 perl Compiled with Perl interface. | |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2210
diff
changeset
|
7007 persistent_undo Compiled with support for persistent undo history. |
7 | 7008 postscript Compiled with PostScript file printing. |
7009 printer Compiled with |:hardcopy| support. | |
170 | 7010 profile Compiled with |:profile| support. |
2826 | 7011 python Compiled with Python 2.x interface. |has-python| |
7012 python3 Compiled with Python 3.x interface. |has-python| | |
7 | 7013 qnx QNX version of Vim. |
7014 quickfix Compiled with |quickfix| support. | |
857 | 7015 reltime Compiled with |reltime()| support. |
7 | 7016 rightleft Compiled with 'rightleft' support. |
7017 ruby Compiled with Ruby interface |ruby|. | |
7018 scrollbind Compiled with 'scrollbind' support. | |
7019 showcmd Compiled with 'showcmd' support. | |
7020 signs Compiled with |:sign| support. | |
7021 smartindent Compiled with 'smartindent' support. | |
9 | 7022 sniff Compiled with SNiFF interface support. |
2681 | 7023 spell Compiled with spell checking support |spell|. |
1989 | 7024 startuptime Compiled with |--startuptime| support. |
7 | 7025 statusline Compiled with support for 'statusline', 'rulerformat' |
7026 and special formats of 'titlestring' and 'iconstring'. | |
7027 sun_workshop Compiled with support for Sun |workshop|. | |
314 | 7028 syntax Compiled with syntax highlighting support |syntax|. |
7 | 7029 syntax_items There are active syntax highlighting items for the |
7030 current buffer. | |
7031 system Compiled to use system() instead of fork()/exec(). | |
7032 tag_binary Compiled with binary searching in tags files | |
7033 |tag-binary-search|. | |
7034 tag_old_static Compiled with support for old static tags | |
7035 |tag-old-static|. | |
7036 tag_any_white Compiled with support for any white characters in tags | |
7037 files |tag-any-white|. | |
7038 tcl Compiled with Tcl interface. | |
7039 terminfo Compiled with terminfo instead of termcap. | |
7040 termresponse Compiled with support for |t_RV| and |v:termresponse|. | |
7041 textobjects Compiled with support for |text-objects|. | |
7042 tgetent Compiled with tgetent support, able to use a termcap | |
7043 or terminfo file. | |
7044 title Compiled with window title support |'title'|. | |
7045 toolbar Compiled with support for |gui-toolbar|. | |
7046 unix Unix version of Vim. | |
7047 user_commands User-defined commands. | |
2681 | 7048 vertsplit Compiled with vertically split windows |:vsplit|. |
2581 | 7049 vim_starting True while initial source'ing takes place. |startup| |
2681 | 7050 viminfo Compiled with viminfo support. |
7 | 7051 virtualedit Compiled with 'virtualedit' option. |
7052 visual Compiled with Visual mode. | |
7053 visualextra Compiled with extra Visual mode commands. | |
7054 |blockwise-operators|. | |
7055 vms VMS version of Vim. | |
7056 vreplace Compiled with |gR| and |gr| commands. | |
7057 wildignore Compiled with 'wildignore' option. | |
7058 wildmenu Compiled with 'wildmenu' option. | |
7059 win16 Win16 version of Vim (MS-Windows 3.1). | |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
7060 win32 Win32 version of Vim (MS-Windows 95 and later, 32 or |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
7061 64 bits) |
2681 | 7062 win32unix Win32 version of Vim, using Unix files (Cygwin) |
7 | 7063 win64 Win64 version of Vim (MS-Windows 64 bit). |
7064 win95 Win32 version for MS-Windows 95/98/ME. | |
2681 | 7065 winaltkeys Compiled with 'winaltkeys' option. |
7066 windows Compiled with support for more than one window. | |
7 | 7067 writebackup Compiled with 'writebackup' default on. |
7068 xfontset Compiled with X fontset support |xfontset|. | |
7069 xim Compiled with X input method support |xim|. | |
5340 | 7070 xpm Compiled with pixmap support. |
7071 xpm_w32 Compiled with pixmap support for Win32. (Only for | |
7072 backward compatibility. Use "xpm" instead.) | |
7 | 7073 xsmp Compiled with X session management support. |
7074 xsmp_interact Compiled with interactive X session management support. | |
7075 xterm_clipboard Compiled with support for xterm clipboard. | |
7076 xterm_save Compiled with support for saving and restoring the | |
7077 xterm screen. | |
7078 x11 Compiled with X11 support. | |
7079 | |
7080 *string-match* | |
7081 Matching a pattern in a String | |
7082 | |
7083 A regexp pattern as explained at |pattern| is normally used to find a match in | |
7084 the buffer lines. When a pattern is used to find a match in a String, almost | |
7085 everything works in the same way. The difference is that a String is handled | |
7086 like it is one line. When it contains a "\n" character, this is not seen as a | |
7087 line break for the pattern. It can be matched with a "\n" in the pattern, or | |
7088 with ".". Example: > | |
7089 :let a = "aaaa\nxxxx" | |
7090 :echo matchstr(a, "..\n..") | |
7091 aa | |
7092 xx | |
7093 :echo matchstr(a, "a.x") | |
7094 a | |
7095 x | |
7096 | |
7097 Don't forget that "^" will only match at the first character of the String and | |
7098 "$" at the last character of the string. They don't match after or before a | |
7099 "\n". | |
7100 | |
7101 ============================================================================== | |
7102 5. Defining functions *user-functions* | |
7103 | |
7104 New functions can be defined. These can be called just like builtin | |
7105 functions. The function executes a sequence of Ex commands. Normal mode | |
7106 commands can be executed with the |:normal| command. | |
7107 | |
7108 The function name must start with an uppercase letter, to avoid confusion with | |
7109 builtin functions. To prevent from using the same name in different scripts | |
7110 avoid obvious, short names. A good habit is to start the function name with | |
7111 the name of the script, e.g., "HTMLcolor()". | |
7112 | |
504 | 7113 It's also possible to use curly braces, see |curly-braces-names|. And the |
7114 |autoload| facility is useful to define a function only when it's called. | |
7 | 7115 |
7116 *local-function* | |
7117 A function local to a script must start with "s:". A local script function | |
7118 can only be called from within the script and from functions, user commands | |
7119 and autocommands defined in the script. It is also possible to call the | |
1698 | 7120 function from a mapping defined in the script, but then |<SID>| must be used |
7 | 7121 instead of "s:" when the mapping is expanded outside of the script. |
5862 | 7122 There are only script-local functions, no buffer-local or window-local |
7123 functions. | |
7 | 7124 |
7125 *:fu* *:function* *E128* *E129* *E123* | |
7126 :fu[nction] List all functions and their arguments. | |
7127 | |
7128 :fu[nction] {name} List function {name}. | |
685 | 7129 {name} can also be a |Dictionary| entry that is a |
7130 |Funcref|: > | |
114 | 7131 :function dict.init |
504 | 7132 |
7133 :fu[nction] /{pattern} List functions with a name matching {pattern}. | |
7134 Example that lists all functions ending with "File": > | |
7135 :function /File$ | |
482 | 7136 < |
7137 *:function-verbose* | |
7138 When 'verbose' is non-zero, listing a function will also display where it was | |
7139 last defined. Example: > | |
7140 | |
7141 :verbose function SetFileTypeSH | |
7142 function SetFileTypeSH(name) | |
7143 Last set from /usr/share/vim/vim-7.0/filetype.vim | |
7144 < | |
484 | 7145 See |:verbose-cmd| for more information. |
482 | 7146 |
5862 | 7147 *E124* *E125* *E853* *E884* |
102 | 7148 :fu[nction][!] {name}([arguments]) [range] [abort] [dict] |
7 | 7149 Define a new function by the name {name}. The name |
7150 must be made of alphanumeric characters and '_', and | |
5862 | 7151 must start with a capital or "s:" (see above). Note |
7152 that using "b:" or "g:" is not allowed. (since patch | |
7153 7.4.260 E884 is given if the function name has a colon | |
7154 in the name, e.g. for "foo:bar()". Before that patch | |
7155 no error was given). | |
114 | 7156 |
685 | 7157 {name} can also be a |Dictionary| entry that is a |
7158 |Funcref|: > | |
114 | 7159 :function dict.init(arg) |
1621 | 7160 < "dict" must be an existing dictionary. The entry |
114 | 7161 "init" is added if it didn't exist yet. Otherwise [!] |
1621 | 7162 is required to overwrite an existing function. The |
114 | 7163 result is a |Funcref| to a numbered function. The |
7164 function can only be used with a |Funcref| and will be | |
7165 deleted if there are no more references to it. | |
7 | 7166 *E127* *E122* |
7167 When a function by this name already exists and [!] is | |
7168 not used an error message is given. When [!] is used, | |
7169 an existing function is silently replaced. Unless it | |
7170 is currently being executed, that is an error. | |
133 | 7171 |
7172 For the {arguments} see |function-argument|. | |
7173 | |
5618 | 7174 *:func-range* *a:firstline* *a:lastline* |
7 | 7175 When the [range] argument is added, the function is |
7176 expected to take care of a range itself. The range is | |
7177 passed as "a:firstline" and "a:lastline". If [range] | |
7178 is excluded, ":{range}call" will call the function for | |
7179 each line in the range, with the cursor on the start | |
7180 of each line. See |function-range-example|. | |
3967 | 7181 The cursor is still moved to the first line of the |
7182 range, as is the case with all Ex commands. | |
5618 | 7183 *:func-abort* |
7 | 7184 When the [abort] argument is added, the function will |
7185 abort as soon as an error is detected. | |
5618 | 7186 *:func-dict* |
102 | 7187 When the [dict] argument is added, the function must |
1621 | 7188 be invoked through an entry in a |Dictionary|. The |
102 | 7189 local variable "self" will then be set to the |
7190 dictionary. See |Dictionary-function|. | |
7 | 7191 |
1621 | 7192 *function-search-undo* |
653 | 7193 The last used search pattern and the redo command "." |
1621 | 7194 will not be changed by the function. This also |
7195 implies that the effect of |:nohlsearch| is undone | |
7196 when the function returns. | |
653 | 7197 |
7 | 7198 *:endf* *:endfunction* *E126* *E193* |
7199 :endf[unction] The end of a function definition. Must be on a line | |
7200 by its own, without other commands. | |
7201 | |
7202 *:delf* *:delfunction* *E130* *E131* | |
7203 :delf[unction] {name} Delete function {name}. | |
685 | 7204 {name} can also be a |Dictionary| entry that is a |
7205 |Funcref|: > | |
114 | 7206 :delfunc dict.init |
1621 | 7207 < This will remove the "init" entry from "dict". The |
114 | 7208 function is deleted if there are no more references to |
7209 it. | |
7 | 7210 *:retu* *:return* *E133* |
7211 :retu[rn] [expr] Return from a function. When "[expr]" is given, it is | |
7212 evaluated and returned as the result of the function. | |
7213 If "[expr]" is not given, the number 0 is returned. | |
7214 When a function ends without an explicit ":return", | |
7215 the number 0 is returned. | |
7216 Note that there is no check for unreachable lines, | |
7217 thus there is no warning if commands follow ":return". | |
7218 | |
7219 If the ":return" is used after a |:try| but before the | |
7220 matching |:finally| (if present), the commands | |
7221 following the ":finally" up to the matching |:endtry| | |
7222 are executed first. This process applies to all | |
7223 nested ":try"s inside the function. The function | |
7224 returns at the outermost ":endtry". | |
7225 | |
133 | 7226 *function-argument* *a:var* |
1621 | 7227 An argument can be defined by giving its name. In the function this can then |
133 | 7228 be used as "a:name" ("a:" for argument). |
1156 | 7229 *a:0* *a:1* *a:000* *E740* *...* |
133 | 7230 Up to 20 arguments can be given, separated by commas. After the named |
7231 arguments an argument "..." can be specified, which means that more arguments | |
7232 may optionally be following. In the function the extra arguments can be used | |
7233 as "a:1", "a:2", etc. "a:0" is set to the number of extra arguments (which | |
685 | 7234 can be 0). "a:000" is set to a |List| that contains these arguments. Note |
7235 that "a:1" is the same as "a:000[0]". | |
148 | 7236 *E742* |
7237 The a: scope and the variables in it cannot be changed, they are fixed. | |
1698 | 7238 However, if a |List| or |Dictionary| is used, you can change their contents. |
685 | 7239 Thus you can pass a |List| to a function and have the function add an item to |
7240 it. If you want to make sure the function cannot change a |List| or | |
7241 |Dictionary| use |:lockvar|. | |
133 | 7242 |
7243 When not using "...", the number of arguments in a function call must be equal | |
7244 to the number of named arguments. When using "...", the number of arguments | |
7245 may be larger. | |
7246 | |
7247 It is also possible to define a function without any arguments. You must | |
7248 still supply the () then. The body of the function follows in the next lines, | |
7249 until the matching |:endfunction|. It is allowed to define another function | |
7250 inside a function body. | |
7251 | |
7252 *local-variables* | |
7 | 7253 Inside a function variables can be used. These are local variables, which |
7254 will disappear when the function returns. Global variables need to be | |
7255 accessed with "g:". | |
7256 | |
7257 Example: > | |
7258 :function Table(title, ...) | |
7259 : echohl Title | |
7260 : echo a:title | |
7261 : echohl None | |
140 | 7262 : echo a:0 . " items:" |
7263 : for s in a:000 | |
7264 : echon ' ' . s | |
7265 : endfor | |
7 | 7266 :endfunction |
7267 | |
7268 This function can then be called with: > | |
140 | 7269 call Table("Table", "line1", "line2") |
7270 call Table("Empty Table") | |
7 | 7271 |
1156 | 7272 To return more than one value, return a |List|: > |
7273 :function Compute(n1, n2) | |
7 | 7274 : if a:n2 == 0 |
1156 | 7275 : return ["fail", 0] |
7 | 7276 : endif |
1156 | 7277 : return ["ok", a:n1 / a:n2] |
7 | 7278 :endfunction |
7279 | |
7280 This function can then be called with: > | |
1156 | 7281 :let [success, div] = Compute(102, 6) |
7 | 7282 :if success == "ok" |
7283 : echo div | |
7284 :endif | |
1156 | 7285 < |
786 | 7286 *:cal* *:call* *E107* *E117* |
7 | 7287 :[range]cal[l] {name}([arguments]) |
7288 Call a function. The name of the function and its arguments | |
7289 are as specified with |:function|. Up to 20 arguments can be | |
1156 | 7290 used. The returned value is discarded. |
7 | 7291 Without a range and for functions that accept a range, the |
7292 function is called once. When a range is given the cursor is | |
7293 positioned at the start of the first line before executing the | |
7294 function. | |
7295 When a range is given and the function doesn't handle it | |
7296 itself, the function is executed for each line in the range, | |
7297 with the cursor in the first column of that line. The cursor | |
7298 is left at the last line (possibly moved by the last function | |
1621 | 7299 call). The arguments are re-evaluated for each line. Thus |
7 | 7300 this works: |
7301 *function-range-example* > | |
7302 :function Mynumber(arg) | |
7303 : echo line(".") . " " . a:arg | |
7304 :endfunction | |
7305 :1,5call Mynumber(getline(".")) | |
7306 < | |
7307 The "a:firstline" and "a:lastline" are defined anyway, they | |
7308 can be used to do something different at the start or end of | |
7309 the range. | |
7310 | |
7311 Example of a function that handles the range itself: > | |
7312 | |
7313 :function Cont() range | |
7314 : execute (a:firstline + 1) . "," . a:lastline . 's/^/\t\\ ' | |
7315 :endfunction | |
7316 :4,8call Cont() | |
7317 < | |
7318 This function inserts the continuation character "\" in front | |
7319 of all the lines in the range, except the first one. | |
7320 | |
1156 | 7321 When the function returns a composite value it can be further |
7322 dereferenced, but the range will not be used then. Example: > | |
7323 :4,8call GetDict().method() | |
7324 < Here GetDict() gets the range but method() does not. | |
7325 | |
7 | 7326 *E132* |
7327 The recursiveness of user functions is restricted with the |'maxfuncdepth'| | |
7328 option. | |
7329 | |
161 | 7330 |
7331 AUTOMATICALLY LOADING FUNCTIONS ~ | |
7 | 7332 *autoload-functions* |
7333 When using many or large functions, it's possible to automatically define them | |
161 | 7334 only when they are used. There are two methods: with an autocommand and with |
7335 the "autoload" directory in 'runtimepath'. | |
7336 | |
7337 | |
7338 Using an autocommand ~ | |
7339 | |
170 | 7340 This is introduced in the user manual, section |41.14|. |
7341 | |
161 | 7342 The autocommand is useful if you have a plugin that is a long Vim script file. |
7343 You can define the autocommand and quickly quit the script with |:finish|. | |
1621 | 7344 That makes Vim startup faster. The autocommand should then load the same file |
161 | 7345 again, setting a variable to skip the |:finish| command. |
7346 | |
7347 Use the FuncUndefined autocommand event with a pattern that matches the | |
7348 function(s) to be defined. Example: > | |
7 | 7349 |
7350 :au FuncUndefined BufNet* source ~/vim/bufnetfuncs.vim | |
7351 | |
7352 The file "~/vim/bufnetfuncs.vim" should then define functions that start with | |
7353 "BufNet". Also see |FuncUndefined|. | |
7354 | |
161 | 7355 |
7356 Using an autoload script ~ | |
168 | 7357 *autoload* *E746* |
170 | 7358 This is introduced in the user manual, section |41.15|. |
7359 | |
161 | 7360 Using a script in the "autoload" directory is simpler, but requires using |
7361 exactly the right file name. A function that can be autoloaded has a name | |
7362 like this: > | |
7363 | |
270 | 7364 :call filename#funcname() |
161 | 7365 |
7366 When such a function is called, and it is not defined yet, Vim will search the | |
7367 "autoload" directories in 'runtimepath' for a script file called | |
7368 "filename.vim". For example "~/.vim/autoload/filename.vim". That file should | |
7369 then define the function like this: > | |
7370 | |
270 | 7371 function filename#funcname() |
161 | 7372 echo "Done!" |
7373 endfunction | |
7374 | |
530 | 7375 The file name and the name used before the # in the function must match |
161 | 7376 exactly, and the defined function must have the name exactly as it will be |
7377 called. | |
7378 | |
270 | 7379 It is possible to use subdirectories. Every # in the function name works like |
7380 a path separator. Thus when calling a function: > | |
7381 | |
7382 :call foo#bar#func() | |
161 | 7383 |
7384 Vim will look for the file "autoload/foo/bar.vim" in 'runtimepath'. | |
7385 | |
168 | 7386 This also works when reading a variable that has not been set yet: > |
7387 | |
270 | 7388 :let l = foo#bar#lvar |
168 | 7389 |
557 | 7390 However, when the autoload script was already loaded it won't be loaded again |
7391 for an unknown variable. | |
7392 | |
168 | 7393 When assigning a value to such a variable nothing special happens. This can |
7394 be used to pass settings to the autoload script before it's loaded: > | |
7395 | |
270 | 7396 :let foo#bar#toggle = 1 |
7397 :call foo#bar#func() | |
168 | 7398 |
164 | 7399 Note that when you make a mistake and call a function that is supposed to be |
7400 defined in an autoload script, but the script doesn't actually define the | |
7401 function, the script will be sourced every time you try to call the function. | |
168 | 7402 And you will get an error message every time. |
7403 | |
7404 Also note that if you have two script files, and one calls a function in the | |
1621 | 7405 other and vice versa, before the used function is defined, it won't work. |
168 | 7406 Avoid using the autoload functionality at the toplevel. |
161 | 7407 |
794 | 7408 Hint: If you distribute a bunch of scripts you can pack them together with the |
7409 |vimball| utility. Also read the user manual |distribute-script|. | |
7410 | |
7 | 7411 ============================================================================== |
7412 6. Curly braces names *curly-braces-names* | |
7413 | |
3410
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
7414 In most places where you can use a variable, you can use a "curly braces name" |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
7415 variable. This is a regular variable name with one or more expressions |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
7416 wrapped in braces {} like this: > |
7 | 7417 my_{adjective}_variable |
7418 | |
7419 When Vim encounters this, it evaluates the expression inside the braces, puts | |
7420 that in place of the expression, and re-interprets the whole as a variable | |
7421 name. So in the above example, if the variable "adjective" was set to | |
7422 "noisy", then the reference would be to "my_noisy_variable", whereas if | |
7423 "adjective" was set to "quiet", then it would be to "my_quiet_variable". | |
7424 | |
7425 One application for this is to create a set of variables governed by an option | |
1621 | 7426 value. For example, the statement > |
7 | 7427 echo my_{&background}_message |
7428 | |
7429 would output the contents of "my_dark_message" or "my_light_message" depending | |
7430 on the current value of 'background'. | |
7431 | |
7432 You can use multiple brace pairs: > | |
7433 echo my_{adverb}_{adjective}_message | |
7434 ..or even nest them: > | |
7435 echo my_{ad{end_of_word}}_message | |
7436 where "end_of_word" is either "verb" or "jective". | |
7437 | |
7438 However, the expression inside the braces must evaluate to a valid single | |
236 | 7439 variable name, e.g. this is invalid: > |
7 | 7440 :let foo='a + b' |
7441 :echo c{foo}d | |
7442 .. since the result of expansion is "ca + bd", which is not a variable name. | |
7443 | |
7444 *curly-braces-function-names* | |
7445 You can call and define functions by an evaluated name in a similar way. | |
7446 Example: > | |
7447 :let func_end='whizz' | |
7448 :call my_func_{func_end}(parameter) | |
7449 | |
7450 This would call the function "my_func_whizz(parameter)". | |
7451 | |
3410
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
7452 This does NOT work: > |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
7453 :let i = 3 |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
7454 :let @{i} = '' " error |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
7455 :echo @{i} " error |
94601b379f38
Updated runtime files. Add Dutch translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3398
diff
changeset
|
7456 |
7 | 7457 ============================================================================== |
7458 7. Commands *expression-commands* | |
7459 | |
7460 :let {var-name} = {expr1} *:let* *E18* | |
7461 Set internal variable {var-name} to the result of the | |
7462 expression {expr1}. The variable will get the type | |
7463 from the {expr}. If {var-name} didn't exist yet, it | |
7464 is created. | |
7465 | |
85 | 7466 :let {var-name}[{idx}] = {expr1} *E689* |
7467 Set a list item to the result of the expression | |
7468 {expr1}. {var-name} must refer to a list and {idx} | |
7469 must be a valid index in that list. For nested list | |
7470 the index can be repeated. | |
1621 | 7471 This cannot be used to add an item to a |List|. |
7472 This cannot be used to set a byte in a String. You | |
7473 can do that like this: > | |
7474 :let var = var[0:2] . 'X' . var[4:] | |
7475 < | |
114 | 7476 *E711* *E719* |
7477 :let {var-name}[{idx1}:{idx2}] = {expr1} *E708* *E709* *E710* | |
685 | 7478 Set a sequence of items in a |List| to the result of |
7479 the expression {expr1}, which must be a list with the | |
87 | 7480 correct number of items. |
7481 {idx1} can be omitted, zero is used instead. | |
7482 {idx2} can be omitted, meaning the end of the list. | |
7483 When the selected range of items is partly past the | |
7484 end of the list, items will be added. | |
7485 | |
153 | 7486 *:let+=* *:let-=* *:let.=* *E734* |
114 | 7487 :let {var} += {expr1} Like ":let {var} = {var} + {expr1}". |
7488 :let {var} -= {expr1} Like ":let {var} = {var} - {expr1}". | |
7489 :let {var} .= {expr1} Like ":let {var} = {var} . {expr1}". | |
7490 These fail if {var} was not set yet and when the type | |
7491 of {var} and {expr1} don't fit the operator. | |
7492 | |
7493 | |
7 | 7494 :let ${env-name} = {expr1} *:let-environment* *:let-$* |
7495 Set environment variable {env-name} to the result of | |
7496 the expression {expr1}. The type is always String. | |
114 | 7497 :let ${env-name} .= {expr1} |
7498 Append {expr1} to the environment variable {env-name}. | |
7499 If the environment variable didn't exist yet this | |
7500 works like "=". | |
7 | 7501 |
7502 :let @{reg-name} = {expr1} *:let-register* *:let-@* | |
7503 Write the result of the expression {expr1} in register | |
7504 {reg-name}. {reg-name} must be a single letter, and | |
7505 must be the name of a writable register (see | |
7506 |registers|). "@@" can be used for the unnamed | |
7507 register, "@/" for the search pattern. | |
7508 If the result of {expr1} ends in a <CR> or <NL>, the | |
7509 register will be linewise, otherwise it will be set to | |
7510 characterwise. | |
7511 This can be used to clear the last search pattern: > | |
7512 :let @/ = "" | |
7513 < This is different from searching for an empty string, | |
7514 that would match everywhere. | |
7515 | |
114 | 7516 :let @{reg-name} .= {expr1} |
1621 | 7517 Append {expr1} to register {reg-name}. If the |
114 | 7518 register was empty it's like setting it to {expr1}. |
7519 | |
1156 | 7520 :let &{option-name} = {expr1} *:let-option* *:let-&* |
7 | 7521 Set option {option-name} to the result of the |
68 | 7522 expression {expr1}. A String or Number value is |
7523 always converted to the type of the option. | |
7 | 7524 For an option local to a window or buffer the effect |
7525 is just like using the |:set| command: both the local | |
555 | 7526 value and the global value are changed. |
68 | 7527 Example: > |
7528 :let &path = &path . ',/usr/local/include' | |
7 | 7529 |
114 | 7530 :let &{option-name} .= {expr1} |
7531 For a string option: Append {expr1} to the value. | |
7532 Does not insert a comma like |:set+=|. | |
7533 | |
7534 :let &{option-name} += {expr1} | |
7535 :let &{option-name} -= {expr1} | |
7536 For a number or boolean option: Add or subtract | |
7537 {expr1}. | |
7538 | |
7 | 7539 :let &l:{option-name} = {expr1} |
114 | 7540 :let &l:{option-name} .= {expr1} |
7541 :let &l:{option-name} += {expr1} | |
7542 :let &l:{option-name} -= {expr1} | |
7 | 7543 Like above, but only set the local value of an option |
7544 (if there is one). Works like |:setlocal|. | |
7545 | |
7546 :let &g:{option-name} = {expr1} | |
114 | 7547 :let &g:{option-name} .= {expr1} |
7548 :let &g:{option-name} += {expr1} | |
7549 :let &g:{option-name} -= {expr1} | |
7 | 7550 Like above, but only set the global value of an option |
7551 (if there is one). Works like |:setglobal|. | |
7552 | |
85 | 7553 :let [{name1}, {name2}, ...] = {expr1} *:let-unpack* *E687* *E688* |
685 | 7554 {expr1} must evaluate to a |List|. The first item in |
68 | 7555 the list is assigned to {name1}, the second item to |
7556 {name2}, etc. | |
7557 The number of names must match the number of items in | |
685 | 7558 the |List|. |
68 | 7559 Each name can be one of the items of the ":let" |
7560 command as mentioned above. | |
7561 Example: > | |
7562 :let [s, item] = GetItem(s) | |
114 | 7563 < Detail: {expr1} is evaluated first, then the |
7564 assignments are done in sequence. This matters if | |
7565 {name2} depends on {name1}. Example: > | |
7566 :let x = [0, 1] | |
7567 :let i = 0 | |
7568 :let [i, x[i]] = [1, 2] | |
7569 :echo x | |
7570 < The result is [0, 2]. | |
7571 | |
7572 :let [{name1}, {name2}, ...] .= {expr1} | |
7573 :let [{name1}, {name2}, ...] += {expr1} | |
7574 :let [{name1}, {name2}, ...] -= {expr1} | |
7575 Like above, but append/add/subtract the value for each | |
685 | 7576 |List| item. |
68 | 7577 |
7578 :let [{name}, ..., ; {lastname}] = {expr1} | |
685 | 7579 Like |:let-unpack| above, but the |List| may have more |
114 | 7580 items than there are names. A list of the remaining |
7581 items is assigned to {lastname}. If there are no | |
7582 remaining items {lastname} is set to an empty list. | |
68 | 7583 Example: > |
7584 :let [a, b; rest] = ["aval", "bval", 3, 4] | |
7585 < | |
114 | 7586 :let [{name}, ..., ; {lastname}] .= {expr1} |
7587 :let [{name}, ..., ; {lastname}] += {expr1} | |
7588 :let [{name}, ..., ; {lastname}] -= {expr1} | |
7589 Like above, but append/add/subtract the value for each | |
685 | 7590 |List| item. |
2596 | 7591 |
7592 *E121* | |
1621 | 7593 :let {var-name} .. List the value of variable {var-name}. Multiple |
123 | 7594 variable names may be given. Special names recognized |
7595 here: *E738* | |
777 | 7596 g: global variables |
7597 b: local buffer variables | |
7598 w: local window variables | |
819 | 7599 t: local tab page variables |
777 | 7600 s: script-local variables |
7601 l: local function variables | |
123 | 7602 v: Vim variables. |
7 | 7603 |
55 | 7604 :let List the values of all variables. The type of the |
7605 variable is indicated before the value: | |
7606 <nothing> String | |
7607 # Number | |
856 | 7608 * Funcref |
7 | 7609 |
148 | 7610 |
1156 | 7611 :unl[et][!] {name} ... *:unlet* *:unl* *E108* *E795* |
148 | 7612 Remove the internal variable {name}. Several variable |
7613 names can be given, they are all removed. The name | |
685 | 7614 may also be a |List| or |Dictionary| item. |
7 | 7615 With [!] no error message is given for non-existing |
7616 variables. | |
685 | 7617 One or more items from a |List| can be removed: > |
108 | 7618 :unlet list[3] " remove fourth item |
7619 :unlet list[3:] " remove fourth item to last | |
685 | 7620 < One item from a |Dictionary| can be removed at a time: > |
108 | 7621 :unlet dict['two'] |
7622 :unlet dict.two | |
1668 | 7623 < This is especially useful to clean up used global |
7624 variables and script-local variables (these are not | |
7625 deleted when the script ends). Function-local | |
7626 variables are automatically deleted when the function | |
7627 ends. | |
7 | 7628 |
148 | 7629 :lockv[ar][!] [depth] {name} ... *:lockvar* *:lockv* |
7630 Lock the internal variable {name}. Locking means that | |
7631 it can no longer be changed (until it is unlocked). | |
7632 A locked variable can be deleted: > | |
7633 :lockvar v | |
7634 :let v = 'asdf' " fails! | |
7635 :unlet v | |
7636 < *E741* | |
7637 If you try to change a locked variable you get an | |
6530 | 7638 error message: "E741: Value is locked: {name}" |
148 | 7639 |
685 | 7640 [depth] is relevant when locking a |List| or |
7641 |Dictionary|. It specifies how deep the locking goes: | |
7642 1 Lock the |List| or |Dictionary| itself, | |
148 | 7643 cannot add or remove items, but can |
7644 still change their values. | |
7645 2 Also lock the values, cannot change | |
685 | 7646 the items. If an item is a |List| or |
7647 |Dictionary|, cannot add or remove | |
148 | 7648 items, but can still change the |
7649 values. | |
685 | 7650 3 Like 2 but for the |List| / |
7651 |Dictionary| in the |List| / | |
7652 |Dictionary|, one level deeper. | |
7653 The default [depth] is 2, thus when {name} is a |List| | |
7654 or |Dictionary| the values cannot be changed. | |
148 | 7655 *E743* |
7656 For unlimited depth use [!] and omit [depth]. | |
7657 However, there is a maximum depth of 100 to catch | |
7658 loops. | |
7659 | |
685 | 7660 Note that when two variables refer to the same |List| |
7661 and you lock one of them, the |List| will also be | |
819 | 7662 locked when used through the other variable. |
7663 Example: > | |
148 | 7664 :let l = [0, 1, 2, 3] |
7665 :let cl = l | |
7666 :lockvar l | |
7667 :let cl[1] = 99 " won't work! | |
7668 < You may want to make a copy of a list to avoid this. | |
7669 See |deepcopy()|. | |
7670 | |
7671 | |
7672 :unlo[ckvar][!] [depth] {name} ... *:unlockvar* *:unlo* | |
7673 Unlock the internal variable {name}. Does the | |
7674 opposite of |:lockvar|. | |
7675 | |
7676 | |
7 | 7677 :if {expr1} *:if* *:endif* *:en* *E171* *E579* *E580* |
7678 :en[dif] Execute the commands until the next matching ":else" | |
7679 or ":endif" if {expr1} evaluates to non-zero. | |
7680 | |
7681 From Vim version 4.5 until 5.0, every Ex command in | |
7682 between the ":if" and ":endif" is ignored. These two | |
7683 commands were just to allow for future expansions in a | |
7659
07f11de5efca
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/85084ef1e999dcf50e8d466106a33bac24a0febb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7653
diff
changeset
|
7684 backward compatible way. Nesting was allowed. Note |
7 | 7685 that any ":else" or ":elseif" was ignored, the "else" |
7686 part was not executed either. | |
7687 | |
7688 You can use this to remain compatible with older | |
7689 versions: > | |
7690 :if version >= 500 | |
7691 : version-5-specific-commands | |
7692 :endif | |
7693 < The commands still need to be parsed to find the | |
7694 "endif". Sometimes an older Vim has a problem with a | |
7695 new command. For example, ":silent" is recognized as | |
7696 a ":substitute" command. In that case ":execute" can | |
7697 avoid problems: > | |
7698 :if version >= 600 | |
7699 : execute "silent 1,$delete" | |
7700 :endif | |
7701 < | |
7702 NOTE: The ":append" and ":insert" commands don't work | |
7703 properly in between ":if" and ":endif". | |
7704 | |
7705 *:else* *:el* *E581* *E583* | |
7706 :el[se] Execute the commands until the next matching ":else" | |
7707 or ":endif" if they previously were not being | |
7708 executed. | |
7709 | |
7710 *:elseif* *:elsei* *E582* *E584* | |
7711 :elsei[f] {expr1} Short for ":else" ":if", with the addition that there | |
7712 is no extra ":endif". | |
7713 | |
7714 :wh[ile] {expr1} *:while* *:endwhile* *:wh* *:endw* | |
114 | 7715 *E170* *E585* *E588* *E733* |
7 | 7716 :endw[hile] Repeat the commands between ":while" and ":endwhile", |
7717 as long as {expr1} evaluates to non-zero. | |
7718 When an error is detected from a command inside the | |
7719 loop, execution continues after the "endwhile". | |
75 | 7720 Example: > |
7721 :let lnum = 1 | |
7722 :while lnum <= line("$") | |
7723 :call FixLine(lnum) | |
7724 :let lnum = lnum + 1 | |
7725 :endwhile | |
7726 < | |
7 | 7727 NOTE: The ":append" and ":insert" commands don't work |
99 | 7728 properly inside a ":while" and ":for" loop. |
75 | 7729 |
114 | 7730 :for {var} in {list} *:for* *E690* *E732* |
75 | 7731 :endfo[r] *:endfo* *:endfor* |
7732 Repeat the commands between ":for" and ":endfor" for | |
158 | 7733 each item in {list}. Variable {var} is set to the |
79 | 7734 value of each item. |
7735 When an error is detected for a command inside the | |
75 | 7736 loop, execution continues after the "endfor". |
464 | 7737 Changing {list} inside the loop affects what items are |
7738 used. Make a copy if this is unwanted: > | |
79 | 7739 :for item in copy(mylist) |
7740 < When not making a copy, Vim stores a reference to the | |
7741 next item in the list, before executing the commands | |
1621 | 7742 with the current item. Thus the current item can be |
79 | 7743 removed without effect. Removing any later item means |
7744 it will not be found. Thus the following example | |
7745 works (an inefficient way to make a list empty): > | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
7746 for item in mylist |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
7747 call remove(mylist, 0) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
7748 endfor |
87 | 7749 < Note that reordering the list (e.g., with sort() or |
7750 reverse()) may have unexpected effects. | |
7751 Note that the type of each list item should be | |
75 | 7752 identical to avoid errors for the type of {var} |
7753 changing. Unlet the variable at the end of the loop | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
7754 to allow multiple item types: > |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
7755 for item in ["foo", ["bar"]] |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
7756 echo item |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
7757 unlet item " E706 without this |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
7758 endfor |
75 | 7759 |
7760 :for [{var1}, {var2}, ...] in {listlist} | |
7761 :endfo[r] | |
7762 Like ":for" above, but each item in {listlist} must be | |
7763 a list, of which each item is assigned to {var1}, | |
7764 {var2}, etc. Example: > | |
7765 :for [lnum, col] in [[1, 3], [2, 5], [3, 8]] | |
7766 :echo getline(lnum)[col] | |
7767 :endfor | |
7768 < | |
7 | 7769 *:continue* *:con* *E586* |
75 | 7770 :con[tinue] When used inside a ":while" or ":for" loop, jumps back |
7771 to the start of the loop. | |
7772 If it is used after a |:try| inside the loop but | |
7773 before the matching |:finally| (if present), the | |
7774 commands following the ":finally" up to the matching | |
7775 |:endtry| are executed first. This process applies to | |
7776 all nested ":try"s inside the loop. The outermost | |
7777 ":endtry" then jumps back to the start of the loop. | |
7 | 7778 |
7779 *:break* *:brea* *E587* | |
75 | 7780 :brea[k] When used inside a ":while" or ":for" loop, skips to |
7781 the command after the matching ":endwhile" or | |
7782 ":endfor". | |
7783 If it is used after a |:try| inside the loop but | |
7784 before the matching |:finally| (if present), the | |
7785 commands following the ":finally" up to the matching | |
7786 |:endtry| are executed first. This process applies to | |
7787 all nested ":try"s inside the loop. The outermost | |
7788 ":endtry" then jumps to the command after the loop. | |
7 | 7789 |
7790 :try *:try* *:endt* *:endtry* *E600* *E601* *E602* | |
7791 :endt[ry] Change the error handling for the commands between | |
7792 ":try" and ":endtry" including everything being | |
7793 executed across ":source" commands, function calls, | |
7794 or autocommand invocations. | |
7795 | |
7796 When an error or interrupt is detected and there is | |
7797 a |:finally| command following, execution continues | |
7798 after the ":finally". Otherwise, or when the | |
7799 ":endtry" is reached thereafter, the next | |
7800 (dynamically) surrounding ":try" is checked for | |
7801 a corresponding ":finally" etc. Then the script | |
7802 processing is terminated. (Whether a function | |
7803 definition has an "abort" argument does not matter.) | |
7804 Example: > | |
7805 :try | edit too much | finally | echo "cleanup" | endtry | |
7806 :echo "impossible" " not reached, script terminated above | |
7807 < | |
7808 Moreover, an error or interrupt (dynamically) inside | |
7809 ":try" and ":endtry" is converted to an exception. It | |
7810 can be caught as if it were thrown by a |:throw| | |
7811 command (see |:catch|). In this case, the script | |
7812 processing is not terminated. | |
7813 | |
7814 The value "Vim:Interrupt" is used for an interrupt | |
7815 exception. An error in a Vim command is converted | |
7816 to a value of the form "Vim({command}):{errmsg}", | |
7817 other errors are converted to a value of the form | |
7818 "Vim:{errmsg}". {command} is the full command name, | |
7819 and {errmsg} is the message that is displayed if the | |
7820 error exception is not caught, always beginning with | |
7821 the error number. | |
7822 Examples: > | |
7823 :try | sleep 100 | catch /^Vim:Interrupt$/ | endtry | |
7824 :try | edit | catch /^Vim(edit):E\d\+/ | echo "error" | endtry | |
7825 < | |
7826 *:cat* *:catch* *E603* *E604* *E605* | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
7827 :cat[ch] /{pattern}/ The following commands until the next |:catch|, |
7 | 7828 |:finally|, or |:endtry| that belongs to the same |
7829 |:try| as the ":catch" are executed when an exception | |
7830 matching {pattern} is being thrown and has not yet | |
7831 been caught by a previous ":catch". Otherwise, these | |
7832 commands are skipped. | |
7833 When {pattern} is omitted all errors are caught. | |
7834 Examples: > | |
7835 :catch /^Vim:Interrupt$/ " catch interrupts (CTRL-C) | |
7836 :catch /^Vim\%((\a\+)\)\=:E/ " catch all Vim errors | |
7837 :catch /^Vim\%((\a\+)\)\=:/ " catch errors and interrupts | |
7838 :catch /^Vim(write):/ " catch all errors in :write | |
7839 :catch /^Vim\%((\a\+)\)\=:E123/ " catch error E123 | |
7840 :catch /my-exception/ " catch user exception | |
7841 :catch /.*/ " catch everything | |
7842 :catch " same as /.*/ | |
7843 < | |
7844 Another character can be used instead of / around the | |
7845 {pattern}, so long as it does not have a special | |
7846 meaning (e.g., '|' or '"') and doesn't occur inside | |
7847 {pattern}. | |
5814 | 7848 Information about the exception is available in |
7849 |v:exception|. Also see |throw-variables|. | |
7 | 7850 NOTE: It is not reliable to ":catch" the TEXT of |
7851 an error message because it may vary in different | |
7852 locales. | |
7853 | |
7854 *:fina* *:finally* *E606* *E607* | |
7855 :fina[lly] The following commands until the matching |:endtry| | |
7856 are executed whenever the part between the matching | |
7857 |:try| and the ":finally" is left: either by falling | |
7858 through to the ":finally" or by a |:continue|, | |
7859 |:break|, |:finish|, or |:return|, or by an error or | |
7860 interrupt or exception (see |:throw|). | |
7861 | |
7862 *:th* *:throw* *E608* | |
7863 :th[row] {expr1} The {expr1} is evaluated and thrown as an exception. | |
7864 If the ":throw" is used after a |:try| but before the | |
7865 first corresponding |:catch|, commands are skipped | |
7866 until the first ":catch" matching {expr1} is reached. | |
7867 If there is no such ":catch" or if the ":throw" is | |
7868 used after a ":catch" but before the |:finally|, the | |
7869 commands following the ":finally" (if present) up to | |
7870 the matching |:endtry| are executed. If the ":throw" | |
7871 is after the ":finally", commands up to the ":endtry" | |
7872 are skipped. At the ":endtry", this process applies | |
7873 again for the next dynamically surrounding ":try" | |
7874 (which may be found in a calling function or sourcing | |
7875 script), until a matching ":catch" has been found. | |
7876 If the exception is not caught, the command processing | |
7877 is terminated. | |
7878 Example: > | |
7879 :try | throw "oops" | catch /^oo/ | echo "caught" | endtry | |
2725 | 7880 < Note that "catch" may need to be on a separate line |
7881 for when an error causes the parsing to skip the whole | |
7882 line and not see the "|" that separates the commands. | |
7 | 7883 |
7884 *:ec* *:echo* | |
7885 :ec[ho] {expr1} .. Echoes each {expr1}, with a space in between. The | |
7886 first {expr1} starts on a new line. | |
7887 Also see |:comment|. | |
7888 Use "\n" to start a new line. Use "\r" to move the | |
7889 cursor to the first column. | |
7890 Uses the highlighting set by the |:echohl| command. | |
7891 Cannot be followed by a comment. | |
7892 Example: > | |
7893 :echo "the value of 'shell' is" &shell | |
1156 | 7894 < *:echo-redraw* |
7895 A later redraw may make the message disappear again. | |
7896 And since Vim mostly postpones redrawing until it's | |
7897 finished with a sequence of commands this happens | |
7898 quite often. To avoid that a command from before the | |
7899 ":echo" causes a redraw afterwards (redraws are often | |
7900 postponed until you type something), force a redraw | |
7901 with the |:redraw| command. Example: > | |
7 | 7902 :new | redraw | echo "there is a new window" |
7903 < | |
7904 *:echon* | |
7905 :echon {expr1} .. Echoes each {expr1}, without anything added. Also see | |
7906 |:comment|. | |
7907 Uses the highlighting set by the |:echohl| command. | |
7908 Cannot be followed by a comment. | |
7909 Example: > | |
7910 :echon "the value of 'shell' is " &shell | |
7911 < | |
7912 Note the difference between using ":echo", which is a | |
7913 Vim command, and ":!echo", which is an external shell | |
7914 command: > | |
7915 :!echo % --> filename | |
7916 < The arguments of ":!" are expanded, see |:_%|. > | |
7917 :!echo "%" --> filename or "filename" | |
7918 < Like the previous example. Whether you see the double | |
7919 quotes or not depends on your 'shell'. > | |
7920 :echo % --> nothing | |
7921 < The '%' is an illegal character in an expression. > | |
7922 :echo "%" --> % | |
7923 < This just echoes the '%' character. > | |
7924 :echo expand("%") --> filename | |
7925 < This calls the expand() function to expand the '%'. | |
7926 | |
7927 *:echoh* *:echohl* | |
7928 :echoh[l] {name} Use the highlight group {name} for the following | |
7929 |:echo|, |:echon| and |:echomsg| commands. Also used | |
7930 for the |input()| prompt. Example: > | |
7931 :echohl WarningMsg | echo "Don't panic!" | echohl None | |
7932 < Don't forget to set the group back to "None", | |
7933 otherwise all following echo's will be highlighted. | |
7934 | |
7935 *:echom* *:echomsg* | |
7936 :echom[sg] {expr1} .. Echo the expression(s) as a true message, saving the | |
7937 message in the |message-history|. | |
7938 Spaces are placed between the arguments as with the | |
7939 |:echo| command. But unprintable characters are | |
7940 displayed, not interpreted. | |
1156 | 7941 The parsing works slightly different from |:echo|, |
7942 more like |:execute|. All the expressions are first | |
7943 evaluated and concatenated before echoing anything. | |
7944 The expressions must evaluate to a Number or String, a | |
7945 Dictionary or List causes an error. | |
7 | 7946 Uses the highlighting set by the |:echohl| command. |
7947 Example: > | |
7948 :echomsg "It's a Zizzer Zazzer Zuzz, as you can plainly see." | |
1156 | 7949 < See |:echo-redraw| to avoid the message disappearing |
7950 when the screen is redrawn. | |
7 | 7951 *:echoe* *:echoerr* |
7952 :echoe[rr] {expr1} .. Echo the expression(s) as an error message, saving the | |
7953 message in the |message-history|. When used in a | |
7954 script or function the line number will be added. | |
7955 Spaces are placed between the arguments as with the | |
1621 | 7956 :echo command. When used inside a try conditional, |
7 | 7957 the message is raised as an error exception instead |
7958 (see |try-echoerr|). | |
7959 Example: > | |
7960 :echoerr "This script just failed!" | |
7961 < If you just want a highlighted message use |:echohl|. | |
7962 And to get a beep: > | |
7963 :exe "normal \<Esc>" | |
7964 < | |
7965 *:exe* *:execute* | |
7966 :exe[cute] {expr1} .. Executes the string that results from the evaluation | |
2152 | 7967 of {expr1} as an Ex command. |
7968 Multiple arguments are concatenated, with a space in | |
7969 between. To avoid the extra space use the "." | |
7970 operator to concatenate strings into one argument. | |
7971 {expr1} is used as the processed command, command line | |
7972 editing keys are not recognized. | |
7 | 7973 Cannot be followed by a comment. |
7974 Examples: > | |
2152 | 7975 :execute "buffer" nextbuf |
7976 :execute "normal" count . "w" | |
7 | 7977 < |
7978 ":execute" can be used to append a command to commands | |
7979 that don't accept a '|'. Example: > | |
7980 :execute '!ls' | echo "theend" | |
7981 | |
7982 < ":execute" is also a nice way to avoid having to type | |
7983 control characters in a Vim script for a ":normal" | |
7984 command: > | |
7985 :execute "normal ixxx\<Esc>" | |
7986 < This has an <Esc> character, see |expr-string|. | |
7987 | |
1621 | 7988 Be careful to correctly escape special characters in |
7989 file names. The |fnameescape()| function can be used | |
1661 | 7990 for Vim commands, |shellescape()| for |:!| commands. |
7991 Examples: > | |
1621 | 7992 :execute "e " . fnameescape(filename) |
5692
80e5f9584b02
Update runtime files. Add Euphoria syntax files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5690
diff
changeset
|
7993 :execute "!ls " . shellescape(filename, 1) |
1621 | 7994 < |
7 | 7995 Note: The executed string may be any command-line, but |
5763 | 7996 starting or ending "if", "while" and "for" does not |
7997 always work, because when commands are skipped the | |
7998 ":execute" is not evaluated and Vim loses track of | |
7999 where blocks start and end. Also "break" and | |
8000 "continue" should not be inside ":execute". | |
8001 This example does not work, because the ":execute" is | |
8002 not evaluated and Vim does not see the "while", and | |
8003 gives an error for finding an ":endwhile": > | |
8004 :if 0 | |
8005 : execute 'while i > 5' | |
8006 : echo "test" | |
8007 : endwhile | |
8008 :endif | |
7 | 8009 < |
8010 It is allowed to have a "while" or "if" command | |
8011 completely in the executed string: > | |
8012 :execute 'while i < 5 | echo i | let i = i + 1 | endwhile' | |
8013 < | |
8014 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
8015 *:exe-comment* |
7 | 8016 ":execute", ":echo" and ":echon" cannot be followed by |
8017 a comment directly, because they see the '"' as the | |
8018 start of a string. But, you can use '|' followed by a | |
8019 comment. Example: > | |
8020 :echo "foo" | "this is a comment | |
8021 | |
8022 ============================================================================== | |
8023 8. Exception handling *exception-handling* | |
8024 | |
8025 The Vim script language comprises an exception handling feature. This section | |
8026 explains how it can be used in a Vim script. | |
8027 | |
8028 Exceptions may be raised by Vim on an error or on interrupt, see | |
8029 |catch-errors| and |catch-interrupt|. You can also explicitly throw an | |
8030 exception by using the ":throw" command, see |throw-catch|. | |
8031 | |
8032 | |
8033 TRY CONDITIONALS *try-conditionals* | |
8034 | |
8035 Exceptions can be caught or can cause cleanup code to be executed. You can | |
8036 use a try conditional to specify catch clauses (that catch exceptions) and/or | |
8037 a finally clause (to be executed for cleanup). | |
8038 A try conditional begins with a |:try| command and ends at the matching | |
8039 |:endtry| command. In between, you can use a |:catch| command to start | |
8040 a catch clause, or a |:finally| command to start a finally clause. There may | |
8041 be none or multiple catch clauses, but there is at most one finally clause, | |
8042 which must not be followed by any catch clauses. The lines before the catch | |
8043 clauses and the finally clause is called a try block. > | |
8044 | |
8045 :try | |
1621 | 8046 : ... |
8047 : ... TRY BLOCK | |
8048 : ... | |
7 | 8049 :catch /{pattern}/ |
1621 | 8050 : ... |
8051 : ... CATCH CLAUSE | |
8052 : ... | |
7 | 8053 :catch /{pattern}/ |
1621 | 8054 : ... |
8055 : ... CATCH CLAUSE | |
8056 : ... | |
7 | 8057 :finally |
1621 | 8058 : ... |
8059 : ... FINALLY CLAUSE | |
8060 : ... | |
7 | 8061 :endtry |
8062 | |
8063 The try conditional allows to watch code for exceptions and to take the | |
8064 appropriate actions. Exceptions from the try block may be caught. Exceptions | |
8065 from the try block and also the catch clauses may cause cleanup actions. | |
8066 When no exception is thrown during execution of the try block, the control | |
8067 is transferred to the finally clause, if present. After its execution, the | |
8068 script continues with the line following the ":endtry". | |
8069 When an exception occurs during execution of the try block, the remaining | |
8070 lines in the try block are skipped. The exception is matched against the | |
8071 patterns specified as arguments to the ":catch" commands. The catch clause | |
8072 after the first matching ":catch" is taken, other catch clauses are not | |
8073 executed. The catch clause ends when the next ":catch", ":finally", or | |
8074 ":endtry" command is reached - whatever is first. Then, the finally clause | |
8075 (if present) is executed. When the ":endtry" is reached, the script execution | |
8076 continues in the following line as usual. | |
8077 When an exception that does not match any of the patterns specified by the | |
8078 ":catch" commands is thrown in the try block, the exception is not caught by | |
8079 that try conditional and none of the catch clauses is executed. Only the | |
8080 finally clause, if present, is taken. The exception pends during execution of | |
8081 the finally clause. It is resumed at the ":endtry", so that commands after | |
8082 the ":endtry" are not executed and the exception might be caught elsewhere, | |
8083 see |try-nesting|. | |
8084 When during execution of a catch clause another exception is thrown, the | |
1621 | 8085 remaining lines in that catch clause are not executed. The new exception is |
7 | 8086 not matched against the patterns in any of the ":catch" commands of the same |
8087 try conditional and none of its catch clauses is taken. If there is, however, | |
8088 a finally clause, it is executed, and the exception pends during its | |
8089 execution. The commands following the ":endtry" are not executed. The new | |
8090 exception might, however, be caught elsewhere, see |try-nesting|. | |
8091 When during execution of the finally clause (if present) an exception is | |
1621 | 8092 thrown, the remaining lines in the finally clause are skipped. If the finally |
7 | 8093 clause has been taken because of an exception from the try block or one of the |
8094 catch clauses, the original (pending) exception is discarded. The commands | |
8095 following the ":endtry" are not executed, and the exception from the finally | |
8096 clause is propagated and can be caught elsewhere, see |try-nesting|. | |
8097 | |
8098 The finally clause is also executed, when a ":break" or ":continue" for | |
8099 a ":while" loop enclosing the complete try conditional is executed from the | |
8100 try block or a catch clause. Or when a ":return" or ":finish" is executed | |
8101 from the try block or a catch clause of a try conditional in a function or | |
8102 sourced script, respectively. The ":break", ":continue", ":return", or | |
8103 ":finish" pends during execution of the finally clause and is resumed when the | |
8104 ":endtry" is reached. It is, however, discarded when an exception is thrown | |
8105 from the finally clause. | |
8106 When a ":break" or ":continue" for a ":while" loop enclosing the complete | |
8107 try conditional or when a ":return" or ":finish" is encountered in the finally | |
8108 clause, the rest of the finally clause is skipped, and the ":break", | |
8109 ":continue", ":return" or ":finish" is executed as usual. If the finally | |
8110 clause has been taken because of an exception or an earlier ":break", | |
8111 ":continue", ":return", or ":finish" from the try block or a catch clause, | |
8112 this pending exception or command is discarded. | |
8113 | |
8114 For examples see |throw-catch| and |try-finally|. | |
8115 | |
8116 | |
8117 NESTING OF TRY CONDITIONALS *try-nesting* | |
8118 | |
8119 Try conditionals can be nested arbitrarily. That is, a complete try | |
8120 conditional can be put into the try block, a catch clause, or the finally | |
8121 clause of another try conditional. If the inner try conditional does not | |
8122 catch an exception thrown in its try block or throws a new exception from one | |
8123 of its catch clauses or its finally clause, the outer try conditional is | |
8124 checked according to the rules above. If the inner try conditional is in the | |
8125 try block of the outer try conditional, its catch clauses are checked, but | |
1621 | 8126 otherwise only the finally clause is executed. It does not matter for |
7 | 8127 nesting, whether the inner try conditional is directly contained in the outer |
8128 one, or whether the outer one sources a script or calls a function containing | |
8129 the inner try conditional. | |
8130 | |
8131 When none of the active try conditionals catches an exception, just their | |
8132 finally clauses are executed. Thereafter, the script processing terminates. | |
8133 An error message is displayed in case of an uncaught exception explicitly | |
8134 thrown by a ":throw" command. For uncaught error and interrupt exceptions | |
8135 implicitly raised by Vim, the error message(s) or interrupt message are shown | |
8136 as usual. | |
8137 | |
8138 For examples see |throw-catch|. | |
8139 | |
8140 | |
8141 EXAMINING EXCEPTION HANDLING CODE *except-examine* | |
8142 | |
8143 Exception handling code can get tricky. If you are in doubt what happens, set | |
8144 'verbose' to 13 or use the ":13verbose" command modifier when sourcing your | |
8145 script file. Then you see when an exception is thrown, discarded, caught, or | |
8146 finished. When using a verbosity level of at least 14, things pending in | |
8147 a finally clause are also shown. This information is also given in debug mode | |
8148 (see |debug-scripts|). | |
8149 | |
8150 | |
8151 THROWING AND CATCHING EXCEPTIONS *throw-catch* | |
8152 | |
8153 You can throw any number or string as an exception. Use the |:throw| command | |
8154 and pass the value to be thrown as argument: > | |
8155 :throw 4711 | |
8156 :throw "string" | |
8157 < *throw-expression* | |
8158 You can also specify an expression argument. The expression is then evaluated | |
8159 first, and the result is thrown: > | |
8160 :throw 4705 + strlen("string") | |
8161 :throw strpart("strings", 0, 6) | |
8162 | |
8163 An exception might be thrown during evaluation of the argument of the ":throw" | |
8164 command. Unless it is caught there, the expression evaluation is abandoned. | |
8165 The ":throw" command then does not throw a new exception. | |
8166 Example: > | |
8167 | |
8168 :function! Foo(arg) | |
8169 : try | |
8170 : throw a:arg | |
8171 : catch /foo/ | |
8172 : endtry | |
8173 : return 1 | |
8174 :endfunction | |
8175 : | |
8176 :function! Bar() | |
8177 : echo "in Bar" | |
8178 : return 4710 | |
8179 :endfunction | |
8180 : | |
8181 :throw Foo("arrgh") + Bar() | |
8182 | |
8183 This throws "arrgh", and "in Bar" is not displayed since Bar() is not | |
8184 executed. > | |
8185 :throw Foo("foo") + Bar() | |
8186 however displays "in Bar" and throws 4711. | |
8187 | |
8188 Any other command that takes an expression as argument might also be | |
1621 | 8189 abandoned by an (uncaught) exception during the expression evaluation. The |
7 | 8190 exception is then propagated to the caller of the command. |
8191 Example: > | |
8192 | |
8193 :if Foo("arrgh") | |
8194 : echo "then" | |
8195 :else | |
8196 : echo "else" | |
8197 :endif | |
8198 | |
8199 Here neither of "then" or "else" is displayed. | |
8200 | |
8201 *catch-order* | |
8202 Exceptions can be caught by a try conditional with one or more |:catch| | |
8203 commands, see |try-conditionals|. The values to be caught by each ":catch" | |
8204 command can be specified as a pattern argument. The subsequent catch clause | |
8205 gets executed when a matching exception is caught. | |
8206 Example: > | |
8207 | |
8208 :function! Foo(value) | |
8209 : try | |
8210 : throw a:value | |
8211 : catch /^\d\+$/ | |
8212 : echo "Number thrown" | |
8213 : catch /.*/ | |
8214 : echo "String thrown" | |
8215 : endtry | |
8216 :endfunction | |
8217 : | |
8218 :call Foo(0x1267) | |
8219 :call Foo('string') | |
8220 | |
8221 The first call to Foo() displays "Number thrown", the second "String thrown". | |
8222 An exception is matched against the ":catch" commands in the order they are | |
8223 specified. Only the first match counts. So you should place the more | |
8224 specific ":catch" first. The following order does not make sense: > | |
8225 | |
8226 : catch /.*/ | |
8227 : echo "String thrown" | |
8228 : catch /^\d\+$/ | |
8229 : echo "Number thrown" | |
8230 | |
8231 The first ":catch" here matches always, so that the second catch clause is | |
8232 never taken. | |
8233 | |
8234 *throw-variables* | |
8235 If you catch an exception by a general pattern, you may access the exact value | |
8236 in the variable |v:exception|: > | |
8237 | |
8238 : catch /^\d\+$/ | |
8239 : echo "Number thrown. Value is" v:exception | |
8240 | |
8241 You may also be interested where an exception was thrown. This is stored in | |
8242 |v:throwpoint|. Note that "v:exception" and "v:throwpoint" are valid for the | |
8243 exception most recently caught as long it is not finished. | |
8244 Example: > | |
8245 | |
8246 :function! Caught() | |
8247 : if v:exception != "" | |
8248 : echo 'Caught "' . v:exception . '" in ' . v:throwpoint | |
8249 : else | |
8250 : echo 'Nothing caught' | |
8251 : endif | |
8252 :endfunction | |
8253 : | |
8254 :function! Foo() | |
8255 : try | |
8256 : try | |
8257 : try | |
8258 : throw 4711 | |
8259 : finally | |
8260 : call Caught() | |
8261 : endtry | |
8262 : catch /.*/ | |
8263 : call Caught() | |
8264 : throw "oops" | |
8265 : endtry | |
8266 : catch /.*/ | |
8267 : call Caught() | |
8268 : finally | |
8269 : call Caught() | |
8270 : endtry | |
8271 :endfunction | |
8272 : | |
8273 :call Foo() | |
8274 | |
8275 This displays > | |
8276 | |
8277 Nothing caught | |
8278 Caught "4711" in function Foo, line 4 | |
8279 Caught "oops" in function Foo, line 10 | |
8280 Nothing caught | |
8281 | |
8282 A practical example: The following command ":LineNumber" displays the line | |
8283 number in the script or function where it has been used: > | |
8284 | |
8285 :function! LineNumber() | |
8286 : return substitute(v:throwpoint, '.*\D\(\d\+\).*', '\1', "") | |
8287 :endfunction | |
8288 :command! LineNumber try | throw "" | catch | echo LineNumber() | endtry | |
8289 < | |
8290 *try-nested* | |
8291 An exception that is not caught by a try conditional can be caught by | |
8292 a surrounding try conditional: > | |
8293 | |
8294 :try | |
8295 : try | |
8296 : throw "foo" | |
8297 : catch /foobar/ | |
8298 : echo "foobar" | |
8299 : finally | |
8300 : echo "inner finally" | |
8301 : endtry | |
8302 :catch /foo/ | |
8303 : echo "foo" | |
8304 :endtry | |
8305 | |
8306 The inner try conditional does not catch the exception, just its finally | |
8307 clause is executed. The exception is then caught by the outer try | |
8308 conditional. The example displays "inner finally" and then "foo". | |
8309 | |
8310 *throw-from-catch* | |
8311 You can catch an exception and throw a new one to be caught elsewhere from the | |
8312 catch clause: > | |
8313 | |
8314 :function! Foo() | |
8315 : throw "foo" | |
8316 :endfunction | |
8317 : | |
8318 :function! Bar() | |
8319 : try | |
8320 : call Foo() | |
8321 : catch /foo/ | |
8322 : echo "Caught foo, throw bar" | |
8323 : throw "bar" | |
8324 : endtry | |
8325 :endfunction | |
8326 : | |
8327 :try | |
8328 : call Bar() | |
8329 :catch /.*/ | |
8330 : echo "Caught" v:exception | |
8331 :endtry | |
8332 | |
8333 This displays "Caught foo, throw bar" and then "Caught bar". | |
8334 | |
8335 *rethrow* | |
8336 There is no real rethrow in the Vim script language, but you may throw | |
8337 "v:exception" instead: > | |
8338 | |
8339 :function! Bar() | |
8340 : try | |
8341 : call Foo() | |
8342 : catch /.*/ | |
8343 : echo "Rethrow" v:exception | |
8344 : throw v:exception | |
8345 : endtry | |
8346 :endfunction | |
8347 < *try-echoerr* | |
8348 Note that this method cannot be used to "rethrow" Vim error or interrupt | |
8349 exceptions, because it is not possible to fake Vim internal exceptions. | |
8350 Trying so causes an error exception. You should throw your own exception | |
8351 denoting the situation. If you want to cause a Vim error exception containing | |
8352 the original error exception value, you can use the |:echoerr| command: > | |
8353 | |
8354 :try | |
8355 : try | |
8356 : asdf | |
8357 : catch /.*/ | |
8358 : echoerr v:exception | |
8359 : endtry | |
8360 :catch /.*/ | |
8361 : echo v:exception | |
8362 :endtry | |
8363 | |
8364 This code displays | |
8365 | |
1621 | 8366 Vim(echoerr):Vim:E492: Not an editor command: asdf ~ |
7 | 8367 |
8368 | |
8369 CLEANUP CODE *try-finally* | |
8370 | |
8371 Scripts often change global settings and restore them at their end. If the | |
8372 user however interrupts the script by pressing CTRL-C, the settings remain in | |
1621 | 8373 an inconsistent state. The same may happen to you in the development phase of |
7 | 8374 a script when an error occurs or you explicitly throw an exception without |
8375 catching it. You can solve these problems by using a try conditional with | |
8376 a finally clause for restoring the settings. Its execution is guaranteed on | |
8377 normal control flow, on error, on an explicit ":throw", and on interrupt. | |
8378 (Note that errors and interrupts from inside the try conditional are converted | |
1621 | 8379 to exceptions. When not caught, they terminate the script after the finally |
7 | 8380 clause has been executed.) |
8381 Example: > | |
8382 | |
8383 :try | |
8384 : let s:saved_ts = &ts | |
8385 : set ts=17 | |
8386 : | |
8387 : " Do the hard work here. | |
8388 : | |
8389 :finally | |
8390 : let &ts = s:saved_ts | |
8391 : unlet s:saved_ts | |
8392 :endtry | |
8393 | |
8394 This method should be used locally whenever a function or part of a script | |
8395 changes global settings which need to be restored on failure or normal exit of | |
8396 that function or script part. | |
8397 | |
8398 *break-finally* | |
8399 Cleanup code works also when the try block or a catch clause is left by | |
8400 a ":continue", ":break", ":return", or ":finish". | |
8401 Example: > | |
8402 | |
8403 :let first = 1 | |
8404 :while 1 | |
8405 : try | |
8406 : if first | |
8407 : echo "first" | |
8408 : let first = 0 | |
8409 : continue | |
8410 : else | |
8411 : throw "second" | |
8412 : endif | |
8413 : catch /.*/ | |
8414 : echo v:exception | |
8415 : break | |
8416 : finally | |
8417 : echo "cleanup" | |
8418 : endtry | |
8419 : echo "still in while" | |
8420 :endwhile | |
8421 :echo "end" | |
8422 | |
8423 This displays "first", "cleanup", "second", "cleanup", and "end". > | |
8424 | |
8425 :function! Foo() | |
8426 : try | |
8427 : return 4711 | |
8428 : finally | |
8429 : echo "cleanup\n" | |
8430 : endtry | |
8431 : echo "Foo still active" | |
8432 :endfunction | |
8433 : | |
8434 :echo Foo() "returned by Foo" | |
8435 | |
8436 This displays "cleanup" and "4711 returned by Foo". You don't need to add an | |
1621 | 8437 extra ":return" in the finally clause. (Above all, this would override the |
7 | 8438 return value.) |
8439 | |
8440 *except-from-finally* | |
8441 Using either of ":continue", ":break", ":return", ":finish", or ":throw" in | |
8442 a finally clause is possible, but not recommended since it abandons the | |
8443 cleanup actions for the try conditional. But, of course, interrupt and error | |
8444 exceptions might get raised from a finally clause. | |
8445 Example where an error in the finally clause stops an interrupt from | |
8446 working correctly: > | |
8447 | |
8448 :try | |
8449 : try | |
8450 : echo "Press CTRL-C for interrupt" | |
8451 : while 1 | |
8452 : endwhile | |
8453 : finally | |
8454 : unlet novar | |
8455 : endtry | |
8456 :catch /novar/ | |
8457 :endtry | |
8458 :echo "Script still running" | |
8459 :sleep 1 | |
8460 | |
8461 If you need to put commands that could fail into a finally clause, you should | |
8462 think about catching or ignoring the errors in these commands, see | |
8463 |catch-errors| and |ignore-errors|. | |
8464 | |
8465 | |
8466 CATCHING ERRORS *catch-errors* | |
8467 | |
8468 If you want to catch specific errors, you just have to put the code to be | |
8469 watched in a try block and add a catch clause for the error message. The | |
8470 presence of the try conditional causes all errors to be converted to an | |
8471 exception. No message is displayed and |v:errmsg| is not set then. To find | |
8472 the right pattern for the ":catch" command, you have to know how the format of | |
8473 the error exception is. | |
8474 Error exceptions have the following format: > | |
8475 | |
8476 Vim({cmdname}):{errmsg} | |
8477 or > | |
8478 Vim:{errmsg} | |
8479 | |
8480 {cmdname} is the name of the command that failed; the second form is used when | |
1621 | 8481 the command name is not known. {errmsg} is the error message usually produced |
7 | 8482 when the error occurs outside try conditionals. It always begins with |
8483 a capital "E", followed by a two or three-digit error number, a colon, and | |
8484 a space. | |
8485 | |
8486 Examples: | |
8487 | |
8488 The command > | |
8489 :unlet novar | |
8490 normally produces the error message > | |
8491 E108: No such variable: "novar" | |
8492 which is converted inside try conditionals to an exception > | |
8493 Vim(unlet):E108: No such variable: "novar" | |
8494 | |
8495 The command > | |
8496 :dwim | |
8497 normally produces the error message > | |
8498 E492: Not an editor command: dwim | |
8499 which is converted inside try conditionals to an exception > | |
8500 Vim:E492: Not an editor command: dwim | |
8501 | |
8502 You can catch all ":unlet" errors by a > | |
8503 :catch /^Vim(unlet):/ | |
8504 or all errors for misspelled command names by a > | |
8505 :catch /^Vim:E492:/ | |
8506 | |
8507 Some error messages may be produced by different commands: > | |
8508 :function nofunc | |
8509 and > | |
8510 :delfunction nofunc | |
8511 both produce the error message > | |
8512 E128: Function name must start with a capital: nofunc | |
8513 which is converted inside try conditionals to an exception > | |
8514 Vim(function):E128: Function name must start with a capital: nofunc | |
8515 or > | |
8516 Vim(delfunction):E128: Function name must start with a capital: nofunc | |
8517 respectively. You can catch the error by its number independently on the | |
8518 command that caused it if you use the following pattern: > | |
8519 :catch /^Vim(\a\+):E128:/ | |
8520 | |
8521 Some commands like > | |
8522 :let x = novar | |
8523 produce multiple error messages, here: > | |
8524 E121: Undefined variable: novar | |
8525 E15: Invalid expression: novar | |
8526 Only the first is used for the exception value, since it is the most specific | |
8527 one (see |except-several-errors|). So you can catch it by > | |
8528 :catch /^Vim(\a\+):E121:/ | |
8529 | |
8530 You can catch all errors related to the name "nofunc" by > | |
8531 :catch /\<nofunc\>/ | |
8532 | |
8533 You can catch all Vim errors in the ":write" and ":read" commands by > | |
8534 :catch /^Vim(\(write\|read\)):E\d\+:/ | |
8535 | |
8536 You can catch all Vim errors by the pattern > | |
8537 :catch /^Vim\((\a\+)\)\=:E\d\+:/ | |
8538 < | |
8539 *catch-text* | |
8540 NOTE: You should never catch the error message text itself: > | |
8541 :catch /No such variable/ | |
6647 | 8542 only works in the English locale, but not when the user has selected |
7 | 8543 a different language by the |:language| command. It is however helpful to |
8544 cite the message text in a comment: > | |
8545 :catch /^Vim(\a\+):E108:/ " No such variable | |
8546 | |
8547 | |
8548 IGNORING ERRORS *ignore-errors* | |
8549 | |
8550 You can ignore errors in a specific Vim command by catching them locally: > | |
8551 | |
8552 :try | |
8553 : write | |
8554 :catch | |
8555 :endtry | |
8556 | |
8557 But you are strongly recommended NOT to use this simple form, since it could | |
8558 catch more than you want. With the ":write" command, some autocommands could | |
8559 be executed and cause errors not related to writing, for instance: > | |
8560 | |
8561 :au BufWritePre * unlet novar | |
8562 | |
8563 There could even be such errors you are not responsible for as a script | |
8564 writer: a user of your script might have defined such autocommands. You would | |
8565 then hide the error from the user. | |
8566 It is much better to use > | |
8567 | |
8568 :try | |
8569 : write | |
8570 :catch /^Vim(write):/ | |
8571 :endtry | |
8572 | |
8573 which only catches real write errors. So catch only what you'd like to ignore | |
8574 intentionally. | |
8575 | |
8576 For a single command that does not cause execution of autocommands, you could | |
8577 even suppress the conversion of errors to exceptions by the ":silent!" | |
8578 command: > | |
8579 :silent! nunmap k | |
8580 This works also when a try conditional is active. | |
8581 | |
8582 | |
8583 CATCHING INTERRUPTS *catch-interrupt* | |
8584 | |
8585 When there are active try conditionals, an interrupt (CTRL-C) is converted to | |
1621 | 8586 the exception "Vim:Interrupt". You can catch it like every exception. The |
7 | 8587 script is not terminated, then. |
8588 Example: > | |
8589 | |
8590 :function! TASK1() | |
8591 : sleep 10 | |
8592 :endfunction | |
8593 | |
8594 :function! TASK2() | |
8595 : sleep 20 | |
8596 :endfunction | |
8597 | |
8598 :while 1 | |
8599 : let command = input("Type a command: ") | |
8600 : try | |
8601 : if command == "" | |
8602 : continue | |
8603 : elseif command == "END" | |
8604 : break | |
8605 : elseif command == "TASK1" | |
8606 : call TASK1() | |
8607 : elseif command == "TASK2" | |
8608 : call TASK2() | |
8609 : else | |
8610 : echo "\nIllegal command:" command | |
8611 : continue | |
8612 : endif | |
8613 : catch /^Vim:Interrupt$/ | |
8614 : echo "\nCommand interrupted" | |
8615 : " Caught the interrupt. Continue with next prompt. | |
8616 : endtry | |
8617 :endwhile | |
8618 | |
8619 You can interrupt a task here by pressing CTRL-C; the script then asks for | |
1621 | 8620 a new command. If you press CTRL-C at the prompt, the script is terminated. |
7 | 8621 |
8622 For testing what happens when CTRL-C would be pressed on a specific line in | |
8623 your script, use the debug mode and execute the |>quit| or |>interrupt| | |
8624 command on that line. See |debug-scripts|. | |
8625 | |
8626 | |
8627 CATCHING ALL *catch-all* | |
8628 | |
8629 The commands > | |
8630 | |
8631 :catch /.*/ | |
8632 :catch // | |
8633 :catch | |
8634 | |
8635 catch everything, error exceptions, interrupt exceptions and exceptions | |
8636 explicitly thrown by the |:throw| command. This is useful at the top level of | |
8637 a script in order to catch unexpected things. | |
8638 Example: > | |
8639 | |
8640 :try | |
8641 : | |
8642 : " do the hard work here | |
8643 : | |
8644 :catch /MyException/ | |
8645 : | |
8646 : " handle known problem | |
8647 : | |
8648 :catch /^Vim:Interrupt$/ | |
8649 : echo "Script interrupted" | |
8650 :catch /.*/ | |
8651 : echo "Internal error (" . v:exception . ")" | |
8652 : echo " - occurred at " . v:throwpoint | |
8653 :endtry | |
8654 :" end of script | |
8655 | |
8656 Note: Catching all might catch more things than you want. Thus, you are | |
8657 strongly encouraged to catch only for problems that you can really handle by | |
8658 specifying a pattern argument to the ":catch". | |
8659 Example: Catching all could make it nearly impossible to interrupt a script | |
8660 by pressing CTRL-C: > | |
8661 | |
8662 :while 1 | |
8663 : try | |
8664 : sleep 1 | |
8665 : catch | |
8666 : endtry | |
8667 :endwhile | |
8668 | |
8669 | |
8670 EXCEPTIONS AND AUTOCOMMANDS *except-autocmd* | |
8671 | |
8672 Exceptions may be used during execution of autocommands. Example: > | |
8673 | |
8674 :autocmd User x try | |
8675 :autocmd User x throw "Oops!" | |
8676 :autocmd User x catch | |
8677 :autocmd User x echo v:exception | |
8678 :autocmd User x endtry | |
8679 :autocmd User x throw "Arrgh!" | |
8680 :autocmd User x echo "Should not be displayed" | |
8681 : | |
8682 :try | |
8683 : doautocmd User x | |
8684 :catch | |
8685 : echo v:exception | |
8686 :endtry | |
8687 | |
8688 This displays "Oops!" and "Arrgh!". | |
8689 | |
8690 *except-autocmd-Pre* | |
8691 For some commands, autocommands get executed before the main action of the | |
8692 command takes place. If an exception is thrown and not caught in the sequence | |
8693 of autocommands, the sequence and the command that caused its execution are | |
8694 abandoned and the exception is propagated to the caller of the command. | |
8695 Example: > | |
8696 | |
8697 :autocmd BufWritePre * throw "FAIL" | |
8698 :autocmd BufWritePre * echo "Should not be displayed" | |
8699 : | |
8700 :try | |
8701 : write | |
8702 :catch | |
8703 : echo "Caught:" v:exception "from" v:throwpoint | |
8704 :endtry | |
8705 | |
8706 Here, the ":write" command does not write the file currently being edited (as | |
8707 you can see by checking 'modified'), since the exception from the BufWritePre | |
8708 autocommand abandons the ":write". The exception is then caught and the | |
8709 script displays: > | |
8710 | |
8711 Caught: FAIL from BufWrite Auto commands for "*" | |
8712 < | |
8713 *except-autocmd-Post* | |
8714 For some commands, autocommands get executed after the main action of the | |
8715 command has taken place. If this main action fails and the command is inside | |
8716 an active try conditional, the autocommands are skipped and an error exception | |
8717 is thrown that can be caught by the caller of the command. | |
8718 Example: > | |
8719 | |
8720 :autocmd BufWritePost * echo "File successfully written!" | |
8721 : | |
8722 :try | |
8723 : write /i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e | |
8724 :catch | |
8725 : echo v:exception | |
8726 :endtry | |
8727 | |
8728 This just displays: > | |
8729 | |
8730 Vim(write):E212: Can't open file for writing (/i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e) | |
8731 | |
8732 If you really need to execute the autocommands even when the main action | |
8733 fails, trigger the event from the catch clause. | |
8734 Example: > | |
8735 | |
8736 :autocmd BufWritePre * set noreadonly | |
8737 :autocmd BufWritePost * set readonly | |
8738 : | |
8739 :try | |
8740 : write /i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e | |
8741 :catch | |
8742 : doautocmd BufWritePost /i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e | |
8743 :endtry | |
8744 < | |
8745 You can also use ":silent!": > | |
8746 | |
8747 :let x = "ok" | |
8748 :let v:errmsg = "" | |
8749 :autocmd BufWritePost * if v:errmsg != "" | |
8750 :autocmd BufWritePost * let x = "after fail" | |
8751 :autocmd BufWritePost * endif | |
8752 :try | |
8753 : silent! write /i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e | |
8754 :catch | |
8755 :endtry | |
8756 :echo x | |
8757 | |
8758 This displays "after fail". | |
8759 | |
8760 If the main action of the command does not fail, exceptions from the | |
8761 autocommands will be catchable by the caller of the command: > | |
8762 | |
8763 :autocmd BufWritePost * throw ":-(" | |
8764 :autocmd BufWritePost * echo "Should not be displayed" | |
8765 : | |
8766 :try | |
8767 : write | |
8768 :catch | |
8769 : echo v:exception | |
8770 :endtry | |
8771 < | |
8772 *except-autocmd-Cmd* | |
8773 For some commands, the normal action can be replaced by a sequence of | |
8774 autocommands. Exceptions from that sequence will be catchable by the caller | |
8775 of the command. | |
8776 Example: For the ":write" command, the caller cannot know whether the file | |
1621 | 8777 had actually been written when the exception occurred. You need to tell it in |
7 | 8778 some way. > |
8779 | |
8780 :if !exists("cnt") | |
8781 : let cnt = 0 | |
8782 : | |
8783 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * if &modified | |
8784 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * let cnt = cnt + 1 | |
8785 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * if cnt % 3 == 2 | |
8786 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * throw "BufWriteCmdError" | |
8787 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * endif | |
8788 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * write | set nomodified | |
8789 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * if cnt % 3 == 0 | |
8790 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * throw "BufWriteCmdError" | |
8791 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * endif | |
8792 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * echo "File successfully written!" | |
8793 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * endif | |
8794 :endif | |
8795 : | |
8796 :try | |
8797 : write | |
8798 :catch /^BufWriteCmdError$/ | |
8799 : if &modified | |
8800 : echo "Error on writing (file contents not changed)" | |
8801 : else | |
8802 : echo "Error after writing" | |
8803 : endif | |
8804 :catch /^Vim(write):/ | |
8805 : echo "Error on writing" | |
8806 :endtry | |
8807 | |
8808 When this script is sourced several times after making changes, it displays | |
8809 first > | |
8810 File successfully written! | |
8811 then > | |
8812 Error on writing (file contents not changed) | |
8813 then > | |
8814 Error after writing | |
8815 etc. | |
8816 | |
8817 *except-autocmd-ill* | |
8818 You cannot spread a try conditional over autocommands for different events. | |
8819 The following code is ill-formed: > | |
8820 | |
8821 :autocmd BufWritePre * try | |
8822 : | |
8823 :autocmd BufWritePost * catch | |
8824 :autocmd BufWritePost * echo v:exception | |
8825 :autocmd BufWritePost * endtry | |
8826 : | |
8827 :write | |
8828 | |
8829 | |
8830 EXCEPTION HIERARCHIES AND PARAMETERIZED EXCEPTIONS *except-hier-param* | |
8831 | |
8832 Some programming languages allow to use hierarchies of exception classes or to | |
8833 pass additional information with the object of an exception class. You can do | |
8834 similar things in Vim. | |
8835 In order to throw an exception from a hierarchy, just throw the complete | |
8836 class name with the components separated by a colon, for instance throw the | |
8837 string "EXCEPT:MATHERR:OVERFLOW" for an overflow in a mathematical library. | |
8838 When you want to pass additional information with your exception class, add | |
8839 it in parentheses, for instance throw the string "EXCEPT:IO:WRITEERR(myfile)" | |
8840 for an error when writing "myfile". | |
8841 With the appropriate patterns in the ":catch" command, you can catch for | |
8842 base classes or derived classes of your hierarchy. Additional information in | |
8843 parentheses can be cut out from |v:exception| with the ":substitute" command. | |
8844 Example: > | |
8845 | |
8846 :function! CheckRange(a, func) | |
8847 : if a:a < 0 | |
8848 : throw "EXCEPT:MATHERR:RANGE(" . a:func . ")" | |
8849 : endif | |
8850 :endfunction | |
8851 : | |
8852 :function! Add(a, b) | |
8853 : call CheckRange(a:a, "Add") | |
8854 : call CheckRange(a:b, "Add") | |
8855 : let c = a:a + a:b | |
8856 : if c < 0 | |
8857 : throw "EXCEPT:MATHERR:OVERFLOW" | |
8858 : endif | |
8859 : return c | |
8860 :endfunction | |
8861 : | |
8862 :function! Div(a, b) | |
8863 : call CheckRange(a:a, "Div") | |
8864 : call CheckRange(a:b, "Div") | |
8865 : if (a:b == 0) | |
8866 : throw "EXCEPT:MATHERR:ZERODIV" | |
8867 : endif | |
8868 : return a:a / a:b | |
8869 :endfunction | |
8870 : | |
8871 :function! Write(file) | |
8872 : try | |
1621 | 8873 : execute "write" fnameescape(a:file) |
7 | 8874 : catch /^Vim(write):/ |
8875 : throw "EXCEPT:IO(" . getcwd() . ", " . a:file . "):WRITEERR" | |
8876 : endtry | |
8877 :endfunction | |
8878 : | |
8879 :try | |
8880 : | |
8881 : " something with arithmetics and I/O | |
8882 : | |
8883 :catch /^EXCEPT:MATHERR:RANGE/ | |
8884 : let function = substitute(v:exception, '.*(\(\a\+\)).*', '\1', "") | |
8885 : echo "Range error in" function | |
8886 : | |
8887 :catch /^EXCEPT:MATHERR/ " catches OVERFLOW and ZERODIV | |
8888 : echo "Math error" | |
8889 : | |
8890 :catch /^EXCEPT:IO/ | |
8891 : let dir = substitute(v:exception, '.*(\(.\+\),\s*.\+).*', '\1', "") | |
8892 : let file = substitute(v:exception, '.*(.\+,\s*\(.\+\)).*', '\1', "") | |
8893 : if file !~ '^/' | |
8894 : let file = dir . "/" . file | |
8895 : endif | |
8896 : echo 'I/O error for "' . file . '"' | |
8897 : | |
8898 :catch /^EXCEPT/ | |
8899 : echo "Unspecified error" | |
8900 : | |
8901 :endtry | |
8902 | |
8903 The exceptions raised by Vim itself (on error or when pressing CTRL-C) use | |
8904 a flat hierarchy: they are all in the "Vim" class. You cannot throw yourself | |
8905 exceptions with the "Vim" prefix; they are reserved for Vim. | |
8906 Vim error exceptions are parameterized with the name of the command that | |
8907 failed, if known. See |catch-errors|. | |
8908 | |
8909 | |
8910 PECULIARITIES | |
8911 *except-compat* | |
8912 The exception handling concept requires that the command sequence causing the | |
8913 exception is aborted immediately and control is transferred to finally clauses | |
8914 and/or a catch clause. | |
8915 | |
8916 In the Vim script language there are cases where scripts and functions | |
8917 continue after an error: in functions without the "abort" flag or in a command | |
8918 after ":silent!", control flow goes to the following line, and outside | |
8919 functions, control flow goes to the line following the outermost ":endwhile" | |
8920 or ":endif". On the other hand, errors should be catchable as exceptions | |
8921 (thus, requiring the immediate abortion). | |
8922 | |
8923 This problem has been solved by converting errors to exceptions and using | |
8924 immediate abortion (if not suppressed by ":silent!") only when a try | |
1621 | 8925 conditional is active. This is no restriction since an (error) exception can |
8926 be caught only from an active try conditional. If you want an immediate | |
7 | 8927 termination without catching the error, just use a try conditional without |
8928 catch clause. (You can cause cleanup code being executed before termination | |
8929 by specifying a finally clause.) | |
8930 | |
8931 When no try conditional is active, the usual abortion and continuation | |
8932 behavior is used instead of immediate abortion. This ensures compatibility of | |
8933 scripts written for Vim 6.1 and earlier. | |
8934 | |
8935 However, when sourcing an existing script that does not use exception handling | |
8936 commands (or when calling one of its functions) from inside an active try | |
8937 conditional of a new script, you might change the control flow of the existing | |
8938 script on error. You get the immediate abortion on error and can catch the | |
8939 error in the new script. If however the sourced script suppresses error | |
8940 messages by using the ":silent!" command (checking for errors by testing | |
1621 | 8941 |v:errmsg| if appropriate), its execution path is not changed. The error is |
8942 not converted to an exception. (See |:silent|.) So the only remaining cause | |
7 | 8943 where this happens is for scripts that don't care about errors and produce |
8944 error messages. You probably won't want to use such code from your new | |
8945 scripts. | |
8946 | |
8947 *except-syntax-err* | |
8948 Syntax errors in the exception handling commands are never caught by any of | |
8949 the ":catch" commands of the try conditional they belong to. Its finally | |
8950 clauses, however, is executed. | |
8951 Example: > | |
8952 | |
8953 :try | |
8954 : try | |
8955 : throw 4711 | |
8956 : catch /\(/ | |
8957 : echo "in catch with syntax error" | |
8958 : catch | |
8959 : echo "inner catch-all" | |
8960 : finally | |
8961 : echo "inner finally" | |
8962 : endtry | |
8963 :catch | |
8964 : echo 'outer catch-all caught "' . v:exception . '"' | |
8965 : finally | |
8966 : echo "outer finally" | |
8967 :endtry | |
8968 | |
8969 This displays: > | |
8970 inner finally | |
8971 outer catch-all caught "Vim(catch):E54: Unmatched \(" | |
8972 outer finally | |
8973 The original exception is discarded and an error exception is raised, instead. | |
8974 | |
8975 *except-single-line* | |
8976 The ":try", ":catch", ":finally", and ":endtry" commands can be put on | |
8977 a single line, but then syntax errors may make it difficult to recognize the | |
8978 "catch" line, thus you better avoid this. | |
8979 Example: > | |
8980 :try | unlet! foo # | catch | endtry | |
8981 raises an error exception for the trailing characters after the ":unlet!" | |
8982 argument, but does not see the ":catch" and ":endtry" commands, so that the | |
8983 error exception is discarded and the "E488: Trailing characters" message gets | |
8984 displayed. | |
8985 | |
8986 *except-several-errors* | |
8987 When several errors appear in a single command, the first error message is | |
8988 usually the most specific one and therefor converted to the error exception. | |
8989 Example: > | |
8990 echo novar | |
8991 causes > | |
8992 E121: Undefined variable: novar | |
8993 E15: Invalid expression: novar | |
8994 The value of the error exception inside try conditionals is: > | |
8995 Vim(echo):E121: Undefined variable: novar | |
8996 < *except-syntax-error* | |
8997 But when a syntax error is detected after a normal error in the same command, | |
8998 the syntax error is used for the exception being thrown. | |
8999 Example: > | |
9000 unlet novar # | |
9001 causes > | |
9002 E108: No such variable: "novar" | |
9003 E488: Trailing characters | |
9004 The value of the error exception inside try conditionals is: > | |
9005 Vim(unlet):E488: Trailing characters | |
9006 This is done because the syntax error might change the execution path in a way | |
9007 not intended by the user. Example: > | |
9008 try | |
9009 try | unlet novar # | catch | echo v:exception | endtry | |
9010 catch /.*/ | |
9011 echo "outer catch:" v:exception | |
9012 endtry | |
9013 This displays "outer catch: Vim(unlet):E488: Trailing characters", and then | |
9014 a "E600: Missing :endtry" error message is given, see |except-single-line|. | |
9015 | |
9016 ============================================================================== | |
9017 9. Examples *eval-examples* | |
9018 | |
1156 | 9019 Printing in Binary ~ |
7 | 9020 > |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1998
diff
changeset
|
9021 :" The function Nr2Bin() returns the binary string representation of a number. |
1156 | 9022 :func Nr2Bin(nr) |
7 | 9023 : let n = a:nr |
9024 : let r = "" | |
9025 : while n | |
1156 | 9026 : let r = '01'[n % 2] . r |
9027 : let n = n / 2 | |
7 | 9028 : endwhile |
9029 : return r | |
9030 :endfunc | |
9031 | |
1156 | 9032 :" The function String2Bin() converts each character in a string to a |
9033 :" binary string, separated with dashes. | |
9034 :func String2Bin(str) | |
7 | 9035 : let out = '' |
1156 | 9036 : for ix in range(strlen(a:str)) |
9037 : let out = out . '-' . Nr2Bin(char2nr(a:str[ix])) | |
9038 : endfor | |
9039 : return out[1:] | |
7 | 9040 :endfunc |
9041 | |
9042 Example of its use: > | |
1156 | 9043 :echo Nr2Bin(32) |
9044 result: "100000" > | |
9045 :echo String2Bin("32") | |
9046 result: "110011-110010" | |
9047 | |
9048 | |
9049 Sorting lines ~ | |
9050 | |
9051 This example sorts lines with a specific compare function. > | |
9052 | |
9053 :func SortBuffer() | |
9054 : let lines = getline(1, '$') | |
9055 : call sort(lines, function("Strcmp")) | |
9056 : call setline(1, lines) | |
7 | 9057 :endfunction |
9058 | |
1156 | 9059 As a one-liner: > |
9060 :call setline(1, sort(getline(1, '$'), function("Strcmp"))) | |
9061 | |
9062 | |
9063 scanf() replacement ~ | |
7 | 9064 *sscanf* |
9065 There is no sscanf() function in Vim. If you need to extract parts from a | |
9066 line, you can use matchstr() and substitute() to do it. This example shows | |
9067 how to get the file name, line number and column number out of a line like | |
9068 "foobar.txt, 123, 45". > | |
9069 :" Set up the match bit | |
9070 :let mx='\(\f\+\),\s*\(\d\+\),\s*\(\d\+\)' | |
9071 :"get the part matching the whole expression | |
9072 :let l = matchstr(line, mx) | |
9073 :"get each item out of the match | |
9074 :let file = substitute(l, mx, '\1', '') | |
9075 :let lnum = substitute(l, mx, '\2', '') | |
9076 :let col = substitute(l, mx, '\3', '') | |
9077 | |
9078 The input is in the variable "line", the results in the variables "file", | |
9079 "lnum" and "col". (idea from Michael Geddes) | |
9080 | |
1156 | 9081 |
9082 getting the scriptnames in a Dictionary ~ | |
9083 *scriptnames-dictionary* | |
9084 The |:scriptnames| command can be used to get a list of all script files that | |
9085 have been sourced. There is no equivalent function or variable for this | |
9086 (because it's rarely needed). In case you need to manipulate the list this | |
9087 code can be used: > | |
9088 " Get the output of ":scriptnames" in the scriptnames_output variable. | |
9089 let scriptnames_output = '' | |
9090 redir => scriptnames_output | |
9091 silent scriptnames | |
9092 redir END | |
9093 | |
1621 | 9094 " Split the output into lines and parse each line. Add an entry to the |
1156 | 9095 " "scripts" dictionary. |
9096 let scripts = {} | |
9097 for line in split(scriptnames_output, "\n") | |
9098 " Only do non-blank lines. | |
9099 if line =~ '\S' | |
9100 " Get the first number in the line. | |
1621 | 9101 let nr = matchstr(line, '\d\+') |
1156 | 9102 " Get the file name, remove the script number " 123: ". |
1621 | 9103 let name = substitute(line, '.\+:\s*', '', '') |
1156 | 9104 " Add an item to the Dictionary |
1621 | 9105 let scripts[nr] = name |
1156 | 9106 endif |
9107 endfor | |
9108 unlet scriptnames_output | |
9109 | |
7 | 9110 ============================================================================== |
9111 10. No +eval feature *no-eval-feature* | |
9112 | |
9113 When the |+eval| feature was disabled at compile time, none of the expression | |
9114 evaluation commands are available. To prevent this from causing Vim scripts | |
9115 to generate all kinds of errors, the ":if" and ":endif" commands are still | |
9116 recognized, though the argument of the ":if" and everything between the ":if" | |
9117 and the matching ":endif" is ignored. Nesting of ":if" blocks is allowed, but | |
9118 only if the commands are at the start of the line. The ":else" command is not | |
9119 recognized. | |
9120 | |
9121 Example of how to avoid executing commands when the |+eval| feature is | |
9122 missing: > | |
9123 | |
9124 :if 1 | |
9125 : echo "Expression evaluation is compiled in" | |
9126 :else | |
9127 : echo "You will _never_ see this message" | |
9128 :endif | |
9129 | |
9130 ============================================================================== | |
9131 11. The sandbox *eval-sandbox* *sandbox* *E48* | |
9132 | |
2350
06feaf4fe36a
Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2345
diff
changeset
|
9133 The 'foldexpr', 'formatexpr', 'includeexpr', 'indentexpr', 'statusline' and |
06feaf4fe36a
Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2345
diff
changeset
|
9134 'foldtext' options may be evaluated in a sandbox. This means that you are |
06feaf4fe36a
Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2345
diff
changeset
|
9135 protected from these expressions having nasty side effects. This gives some |
06feaf4fe36a
Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2345
diff
changeset
|
9136 safety for when these options are set from a modeline. It is also used when |
06feaf4fe36a
Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2345
diff
changeset
|
9137 the command from a tags file is executed and for CTRL-R = in the command line. |
29 | 9138 The sandbox is also used for the |:sandbox| command. |
7 | 9139 |
9140 These items are not allowed in the sandbox: | |
9141 - changing the buffer text | |
9142 - defining or changing mapping, autocommands, functions, user commands | |
9143 - setting certain options (see |option-summary|) | |
1156 | 9144 - setting certain v: variables (see |v:var|) *E794* |
7 | 9145 - executing a shell command |
9146 - reading or writing a file | |
9147 - jumping to another buffer or editing a file | |
625 | 9148 - executing Python, Perl, etc. commands |
29 | 9149 This is not guaranteed 100% secure, but it should block most attacks. |
9150 | |
9151 *:san* *:sandbox* | |
401 | 9152 :san[dbox] {cmd} Execute {cmd} in the sandbox. Useful to evaluate an |
29 | 9153 option that may have been set from a modeline, e.g. |
9154 'foldexpr'. | |
9155 | |
634 | 9156 *sandbox-option* |
9157 A few options contain an expression. When this expression is evaluated it may | |
790 | 9158 have to be done in the sandbox to avoid a security risk. But the sandbox is |
634 | 9159 restrictive, thus this only happens when the option was set from an insecure |
9160 location. Insecure in this context are: | |
843 | 9161 - sourcing a .vimrc or .exrc in the current directory |
634 | 9162 - while executing in the sandbox |
9163 - value coming from a modeline | |
9164 | |
9165 Note that when in the sandbox and saving an option value and restoring it, the | |
9166 option will still be marked as it was set in the sandbox. | |
9167 | |
9168 ============================================================================== | |
9169 12. Textlock *textlock* | |
9170 | |
9171 In a few situations it is not allowed to change the text in the buffer, jump | |
9172 to another window and some other things that might confuse or break what Vim | |
9173 is currently doing. This mostly applies to things that happen when Vim is | |
1621 | 9174 actually doing something else. For example, evaluating the 'balloonexpr' may |
634 | 9175 happen any moment the mouse cursor is resting at some position. |
9176 | |
9177 This is not allowed when the textlock is active: | |
9178 - changing the buffer text | |
9179 - jumping to another buffer or window | |
9180 - editing another file | |
9181 - closing a window or quitting Vim | |
9182 - etc. | |
9183 | |
7 | 9184 |
9185 vim:tw=78:ts=8:ft=help:norl: |